d44349c20092edf8000e26485b5eb1b4926f10c7
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.85"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. Exim used to
1989 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1990 withdrawn.
1991
1992
1993
1994 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1995 .cindex "lookup modules"
1996 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1997 .cindex ".so building"
1998 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1999 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2000 on demand.
2001 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2002 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2003 dependencies.
2004 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2005
2006 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2007 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2008 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2009 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2010 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2011 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2012
2013 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2014 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2015 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2016 on demand:
2017 .code
2018 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2019 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2020 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2021 .endd
2022
2023
2024 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2025 .cindex "build directory"
2026 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2027 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2028 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2029 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2030 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2031 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2032 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2033
2034 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2035 building process fails if it is set.
2036
2037 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2038 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2039 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2040 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2041 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2042 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2043 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2044 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2045
2046 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2047 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2048 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2049
2050
2051
2052 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2053 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2054 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2055 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2056 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2057 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2058 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2059 .code
2060 FULLECHO='' make -e
2061 .endd
2062 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2063 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2064 given in addition to the short output.
2065
2066
2067
2068 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2069 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2070 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2071 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2072 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2073 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2074 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2075 order:
2076 .display
2077 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2078 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile_&
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2084 .endd
2085 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2086 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2088 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2089 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2090 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2091 and are often not needed.
2092
2093 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2094 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2095 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2096 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2097 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2098 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2099 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2100 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2101 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2102
2103
2104 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2105 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2106 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2107 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2108 default values are.
2109
2110
2111 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2112 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2113 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2114 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2115 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2116 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2117 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2118 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2119 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2120 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2121 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2122 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2123 containing the lines
2124 .code
2125 CC=cc
2126 CFLAGS=-std1
2127 .endd
2128 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2129 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2130
2131 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2132 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2133 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2134
2135
2136 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2140 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2141 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2142 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2143 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2144 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2145 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2146 .code
2147 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2148 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2149 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2150 .endd
2151 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2152 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2153 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2154 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2155 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2156 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2157 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2158 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2159 errors.
2160
2161 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2163 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2164 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2165 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2166 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2167 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2168 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2169 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2170 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2171 syntax. For instance:
2172 .code
2173 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2174 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2175 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2176 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2177 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2179 .endd
2180
2181 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2182 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2183 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2184 .code
2185 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2186 .endd
2187 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2188 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2189
2190 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2191 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2192 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2193 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2194 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2195 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2196 .code
2197 X11=/usr/X11R6
2198 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2199 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2200 .endd
2201 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2202 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2203 .code
2204 X11=/usr/openwin
2205 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2206 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2207 .endd
2208 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2209 definition of all three of these variables into your
2210 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2211
2212 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2213 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2214 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2215 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2216 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2217
2218 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2219 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2220 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2221 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2222 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2223 libraries.
2224
2225 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2226 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2227 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2228 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2229 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2230
2231
2232 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2233 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2234 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2235 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2236 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2237 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2238 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2239 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2240
2241
2242
2243 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2244 .cindex "building Eximon"
2245 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2246 where the files that are involved are
2247 .display
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2254 .endd
2255 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2256 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2257 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2259 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2260 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2261 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2262 .ecindex IIDbuex
2263
2264
2265 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2266 .cindex "installing Exim"
2267 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2268 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2269 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2270 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2271 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2272 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2273 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2274 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2275 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2276 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2277 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2278 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2279
2280 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2281 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2282 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2283 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2284 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2285 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2286 alternative files, no default is installed.
2287
2288 .cindex "system aliases file"
2289 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2290 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2291 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2292 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2293 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2294 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2295 and outputs a comment to the user.
2296
2297 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2298 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2299 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2300 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2301 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2302
2303 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2304 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2305 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2306 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2307 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2308 over SMTP.
2309
2310 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2311 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2312 command such as
2313 .code
2314 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2315 .endd
2316 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2317 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2318 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2319 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2320 but this usage is deprecated.
2321
2322 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2323 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2324 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2325 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2326 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2327 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2328
2329 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2330 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2331 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2332 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2333 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2334 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2335 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2336
2337 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2338 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2339 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2340 command:
2341 .code
2342 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2343 .endd
2344 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2345 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2346 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2347 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2348 command:
2349 .code
2350 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2351 .endd
2352 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2353 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2354
2355 .ilist
2356 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2357 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2358 .next
2359 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2360 installed binary.
2361 .endlist
2362
2363 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2364 .code
2365 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2366 .endd
2367 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2368 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2369 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2370 .code
2371 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2372 .endd
2373
2374
2375
2376 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2377 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2378 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2379 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2380 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2381 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2382
2383 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2384 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2385 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2386
2387
2388
2389 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2390 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2391 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2392 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2393 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2394 necessary.
2395
2396
2397
2398
2399 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2400 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2401 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2402 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2403 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2404 .code
2405 exim -bV
2406 .endd
2407 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2408 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2409 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2410 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2411 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2412 example,
2413 .display
2414 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2415 .endd
2416 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2417 .display
2418 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2419 .endd
2420 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2421 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2422 user agent. For example:
2423 .code
2424 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 From: user@your.domain.example
2426 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2427 Subject: Testing Exim
2428
2429 This is a test message.
2430 ^D
2431 .endd
2432 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2433 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2434 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2435
2436 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2437 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2438 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2439 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2440 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2441 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2442 .display
2443 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2444 .endd
2445 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2446 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2447 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2448 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2449 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2450
2451 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2452 .cindex "lock files"
2453 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2454 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2455 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2456 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2457 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2458 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2459 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2460 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2461 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2462 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2463 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2464 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2465
2466 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2467 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2468 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2469 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2470 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2471 incoming SMTP mail.
2472
2473 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2474 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2475 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2476 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2477 production version.
2478
2479
2480 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2481 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2482 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2483 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2484 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2485 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2486 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2487 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2488 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2489 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2490 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2491 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2492 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2493
2494 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2495 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2496 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2497 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2498 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2499 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2500 as follows:
2501 .code
2502 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2503 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2505 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2506 .endd
2507 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2508 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2509 favourite user agent.
2510
2511 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2512 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2513 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2514 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2515 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2516 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2517
2518
2519
2520 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2521 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2522 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2523 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2524 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2525 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2526 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2527 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2528 configuration file.
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2534 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2535 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2536 .code
2537 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2538 .endd
2539 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2540 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2541 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2542 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2543 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2544 .code
2545 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2546 .endd
2547 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2548
2549 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2550 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2551 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2552
2553
2554
2555
2556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558
2559 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2560 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2561 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2562 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2563 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2564 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2565 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2566 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2567 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2568
2569
2570 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2571 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2573 were present before any other options.
2574 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2575 standard output.
2576 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2577 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2578 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2579
2580 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2581 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2582 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2583 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2584 format.
2585
2586 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2587 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2588 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2589 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2590
2591 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2592 .cindex "queue runner"
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2594 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2595 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2596
2597 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2598 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2599 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2600 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2601 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2602 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2603 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2604 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2605
2606
2607 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2608 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2609 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2610 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2611 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2612 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2613
2614 .ilist
2615 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2616 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2617 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2618 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2619 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2620 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2621
2622 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2623 .cindex "envelope sender"
2624 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2625 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2626 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2627 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2628 users to set envelope senders.
2629
2630 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2631 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2632 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2633 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2634 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2635
2636 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2637 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2638 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2639 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2640 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2641 that are available to trusted users.
2642 .next
2643 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2644 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2645 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2646 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2647 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2648
2649 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2650 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2651 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2652 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2653
2654 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2655 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2656 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2657 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2658
2659 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2660 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2661 false.
2662 .endlist
2663
2664
2665 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2666 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2667 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2668 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2674 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2675 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2676 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2677 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2678 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2679 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2680 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2681
2682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2683 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2684 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2685 . creates a man page for the options.
2686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2687
2688 .literal xml
2689 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2690 .literal off
2691
2692
2693 .vlist
2694 .vitem &%--%&
2695 .oindex "--"
2696 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2697 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2698 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2699 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2700
2701 .vitem &%--help%&
2702 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2703 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2704 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2705 no arguments.
2706
2707 .vitem &%--version%&
2708 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2709 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2710 displayed.
2711
2712 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2713 &%-Am%&
2714 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2715 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2716 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2717 ignored by Exim.
2718
2719 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2720 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2721 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2722 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2723 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2724 clean; it ignores this option.
2725
2726 .vitem &%-bd%&
2727 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2728 .cindex "daemon"
2729 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2730 .cindex "queue runner"
2731 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2732 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2733 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2734
2735 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2736 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2737 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2738 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2739
2740 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2741 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2742 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2743 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2744
2745 When a listening daemon
2746 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2747 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2748 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2749 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2750 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2751 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2752 running as root.
2753
2754 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2755 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2756 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2757
2758 The SIGHUP signal
2759 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2760 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2761 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2762 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2763 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2764 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2765 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2766 because these are reread each time they are used.
2767
2768 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2769 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2770 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2771 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2772
2773 .vitem &%-be%&
2774 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2775 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2776 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2777 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2778 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2779 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2780 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2781
2782 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2783 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2784 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2785 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2786 test data. A line history is supported.
2787
2788 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2789 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2790 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2791 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2792 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2793 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2794 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2795
2796 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2797 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2798 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2799 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2800
2801 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2802 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2803 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2804 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2805 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2806 of a file. For example:
2807 .code
2808 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2809 .endd
2810 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2811 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2812 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2813 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2814 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2815 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2816 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2817 &%-be%&).
2818
2819 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2820 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2821 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2822 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2823 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2824 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2825 system filters are recognized.
2826
2827 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2828 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2829 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2831 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2832 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2833 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2834 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2835 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2836 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2837 supplied.
2838
2839 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2840 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2841 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2842 .code
2843 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2844 .endd
2845 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2846 variables that are used by the user filter.
2847
2848 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2849 .code
2850 # Exim filter
2851 # Sieve filter
2852 .endd
2853 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2854 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2855 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2856 redirection lists.
2857
2858 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2859 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2860 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2861 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2862
2863 When testing a filter file,
2864 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2865 .cindex "envelope sender"
2866 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2867 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2868 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2869 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2870 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2871 options).
2872
2873 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2874 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2875 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2876 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2877 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2878 &$qualify_domain$&.
2879
2880 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2881 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2882 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2883 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2884 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2885 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2886 actually being delivered.
2887
2888 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2889 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2890 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2891 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2892 prefix.
2893
2894 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2895 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2896 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2897 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2898 suffix.
2899
2900 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2901 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2902 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2903 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2904 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2905 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2906 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2907 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2908 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2909 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2910 after a full stop. For example:
2911 .code
2912 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2913 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2914 .endd
2915 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2916 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2917 conversion to the canonical form is
2918 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2919
2920 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2921 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2922 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2923 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2924 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2925
2926 &*Warning 1*&:
2927 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2928 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2929 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2930 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2931 connection.
2932
2933 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2934 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2935 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2936
2937 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2938 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2939 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2940 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2941 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2942 session were authenticated.
2943
2944 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2945 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2946 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2947
2948 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2949 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2950 specialized SMTP test program such as
2951 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2952
2953 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2954 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2955 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2956 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2957 updating the callout cache database.
2958
2959 .vitem &%-bi%&
2960 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2961 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2962 .cindex "building alias file"
2963 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2964 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2965 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2966 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2967 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2968 recognized.
2969
2970 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2971 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2972 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2973 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2974 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2975 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2976 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2977
2978 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2979 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2980 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2981 .cindex "querying exim information"
2982 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2983 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2984 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2985 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2986 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2987
2988 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2989 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2990 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2991 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2992 recognised DSCP names.
2993
2994 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2995 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2996 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2997 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2998 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2999 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3000 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3001 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3002 way to guarantee a correct response.
3003
3004 .vitem &%-bm%&
3005 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3006 .cindex "local message reception"
3007 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3008 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3009 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3010 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3011 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3012 if no other conflicting option is present.
3013
3014 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3015 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3016 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3017 suppressing this for special cases.
3018
3019 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3020 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3021
3022 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3023 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3024 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3025
3026 The format
3027 .cindex "message" "format"
3028 .cindex "format" "message"
3029 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3030 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3032 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3033 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3034 .code
3035 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3036 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3037 .endd
3038 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3039 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3040 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3041 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3042 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3043
3044 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3045 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3046 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3047 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3048 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3049
3050 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3051 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3052 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3053 .cindex "malware scan test"
3054 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3055 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3056 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3057 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3058 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3059 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3060
3061 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3062 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3063 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3064 This option requires admin privileges.
3065
3066 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3067 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3068 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3069
3070 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3071 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3072 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3073 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3074 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3075 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3076 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3077 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3078 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3079
3080 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3081 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3082 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3083 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3084 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3085
3086 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3087 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3088 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3089 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3090
3091
3092 .vitem &%-bP%&
3093 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3094 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3095 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3096 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3097 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3098 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3099 arguments, for example:
3100 .code
3101 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3102 .endd
3103 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3104 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3105 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3106 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3107 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3108 users, the output is as in this example:
3109 .code
3110 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3111 .endd
3112 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3113 configuration file is output.
3114 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3115 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3116
3117 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3118 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3119 name will not be output.
3120
3121 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3122 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3123 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3124 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3125 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3126 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3127 written directly into the spool directory.
3128
3129 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3130 .code
3131 exim -bP +local_domains
3132 .endd
3133 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3134 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3135
3136 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3137 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3139 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3140 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3141 that driver are output. For example:
3142 .code
3143 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3144 .endd
3145 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3146 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3147 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3148 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3149 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3150 &%authenticators%&.
3151
3152 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3153 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3154 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3155 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3156 The output format is one item per line.
3157
3158 .vitem &%-bp%&
3159 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3160 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3161 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3162 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3163 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3164 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3165 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3166 to allow any user to see the queue.
3167
3168 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3169 .code
3170 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3171 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3172 <other addresses>
3173 .endd
3174 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3175 .cindex "size" "of message"
3176 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3177 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3178 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3179 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3180 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3181 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3182 before the sender address.
3183
3184 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3185 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3186 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3187
3188 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3189 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3190 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3191 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3192 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3193 complete.
3194
3195
3196 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3197 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3198 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3199 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3200 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3201 of just &"D"&.
3202
3203
3204 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3205 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3206 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3207 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3208 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3209 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3210
3211
3212 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3213 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3214 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3215 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3216 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3217 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3218
3219 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3220 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3221 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3222
3223 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3224 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3225 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3226
3227
3228 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3229 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3230 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3231 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3232 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3233 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3234
3235
3236 .vitem &%-brt%&
3237 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3238 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3239 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3240 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3241 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3242 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3243 .code
3244 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3245 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3246 .endd
3247 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3248 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3249 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3250 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3251 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3252 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3253 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3254 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3255 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3256 .code
3257 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3258 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3259 .endd
3260
3261 .vitem &%-brw%&
3262 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3263 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3264 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3265 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3266 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3267 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3268 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3269 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3270
3271 .vitem &%-bS%&
3272 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3273 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3274 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3275 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3276 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3277 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3278 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3279 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3280 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3281 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3282
3283 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3284 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3285 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3286
3287 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3288 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3289 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3290 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3291
3292 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3293 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3294 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3295
3296 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3297 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3298 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3299 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3300 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3301
3302 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3303 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3304
3305 .vitem &%-bs%&
3306 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3307 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3308 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3309 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3310 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3311 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3312 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3313 messages to the MTA.
3314
3315 In
3316 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3317 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3318 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3319 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3320 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3321 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3322 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3323
3324 .cindex "inetd"
3325 The
3326 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3327 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3328 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3329 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3330 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3331 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3332 the listening daemon.
3333
3334 .vitem &%-bt%&
3335 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3336 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3337 .cindex "address" "testing"
3338 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3339 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3340 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3341 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3342 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3343
3344 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3345 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3346
3347 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3348 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3349 security issues.
3350
3351 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3352 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3353 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3354 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3355 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3356 program.
3357
3358 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3359 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3360 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3361 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3362
3363 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3364 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3365 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3366 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3367 always shown.
3368
3369 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3370 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3371 message,
3372 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3373 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3374 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3375 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3376 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3377 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3378 doing such tests.
3379
3380 .vitem &%-bV%&
3381 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3382 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3383 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3384 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3385 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3386 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3387 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3388
3389 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3390 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3391 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3392 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3393 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3394 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3395 dynamic testing facilities.
3396
3397 .vitem &%-bv%&
3398 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3399 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "address" "verification"
3401 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3402 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3403 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3404 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3405 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3406 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3407
3408 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3409 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3410 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3411
3412 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3413 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3414
3415 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3416 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3417 security issues.
3418
3419 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3420 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3421 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3422 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3423 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3424
3425 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3426 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3427 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3428 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3429 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3430 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3431 to succeed.
3432
3433 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3434 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3435 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3436
3437 The
3438 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3439 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3440 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3441 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3442
3443 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3444 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3445 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3446 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3447
3448 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3449 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3450 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3451 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3452 might happen.
3453
3454 .vitem &%-bw%&
3455 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3456 .cindex "daemon"
3457 .cindex "inetd"
3458 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3459 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3460 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3461 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3462
3463 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3464 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3465 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3466 each port only when the first connection is received.
3467
3468 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3469 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3470
3471 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3472 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3473 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3474 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3475 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3476 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3477 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3478 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3479 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3480 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3481 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3482
3483 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3484 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3485 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3486 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3487 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3488 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3489 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3490 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3491 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3492
3493 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3494 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3495 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3496 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3497 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3498 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3499 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3500
3501 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3502 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3503 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3504 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3505 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3506 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3507 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3508
3509 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3510 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3511 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3512 configuration file.
3513
3514 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3515 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3516 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3517 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3518 specified by this option.
3519
3520
3521 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3522 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3523 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3524 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3525 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3526 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3527 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3528 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3529
3530 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3531 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3532 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3533 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3534 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3535 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3536 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3537
3538 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3539 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3540 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3541 synonymous:
3542 .code
3543 exim -DABC ...
3544 exim -DABC= ...
3545 .endd
3546 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3547 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3548 example:
3549 .code
3550 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3551 .endd
3552 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3553
3554
3555 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3556 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3557 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3559 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3560 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3561 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3562 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3563 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3564 return code.
3565
3566 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3567 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3568 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3569 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3570 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3571 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3572 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3573 are:
3574 .display
3575 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3576 &`auth `& authenticators
3577 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3578 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3579 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3580 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3581 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3582 &`filter `& filter handling
3583 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3584 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3585 &`ident `& ident lookup
3586 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3587 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3588 &`load `& system load checks
3589 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3590 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3591 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3592 &`memory `& memory handling
3593 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3594 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3595 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3596 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3597 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3598 &`retry `& retry handling
3599 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3600 &`route `& address routing
3601 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3602 &`tls `& TLS logic
3603 &`transport `& transports
3604 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3605 &`verify `& address verification logic
3606 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3607 .endd
3608 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3609 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3610 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3611 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3612 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3613 turn everything off.
3614
3615 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3616 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3617 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3618 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3619 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3620 rather than stderr.
3621
3622 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3623 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3624 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3625 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3626 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3627 run in parallel.
3628
3629 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3630 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3631 in processing.
3632
3633 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3634 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3635
3636 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3637 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3638 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3639 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3640 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3641 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3642
3643 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3644 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3645 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3646 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3647 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3648
3649 .vitem &%-E%&
3650 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3651 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3652 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3653 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3654 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3655 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3656 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3657 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3658 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3659
3660 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3661 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3662 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3663 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3664 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3665 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3666
3667 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3668 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3669 .cindex "sender" "name"
3670 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3671 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3672 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3673 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3674 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3675 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3676
3677 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3678 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3679 .cindex "sender" "address"
3680 .cindex "address" "sender"
3681 .cindex "trusted users"
3682 .cindex "envelope sender"
3683 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3684 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3685 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3686 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3687 users to use it.
3688
3689 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3690 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3691 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3692 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3693 domain.
3694
3695 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3696 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3697 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3698 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3699 examples of shell commands:
3700 .code
3701 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3702 exim -f "" user@domain
3703 .endd
3704 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3705 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3706 &%-bv%& options.
3707
3708 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3709 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3710 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3711 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3712
3713 White
3714 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3715 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3716 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3717 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3718 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3719 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3720
3721 .vitem &%-G%&
3722 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3723 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3724 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3725 .code
3726 control = suppress_local_fixups
3727 .endd
3728 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3729 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3730 in future.
3731
3732 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3733 this option.
3734
3735 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3736 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3737 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3738 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3739 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3740 headers.)
3741
3742 .vitem &%-i%&
3743 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3744 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3745 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3746 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3747 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3748 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3749 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3750
3751 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3752 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3753 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3754 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3755 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3756 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3757 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3758 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3759
3760 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3761
3762 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3763 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3764 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3765 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3766 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3767 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3768 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3769 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3770 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3771
3772 Retry
3773 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3774 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3775 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3776 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3777 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3778 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3779
3780 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3781 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3782 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3783 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3784
3785 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3786 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3787 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3788 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3789 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3790 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3791 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3792 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3793 can be used only by an admin user.
3794
3795 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3796 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3797 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3798 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3800 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3801 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3802 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3803 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3804 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3805 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3806
3807 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3808 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3809 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3810 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3811 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3812
3813 .new
3814 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3815 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3818 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3819 .wen
3820
3821 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3822 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3823 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3824 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3825 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3826
3827 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3828 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3829 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3830 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3831 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3832 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3833 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3834 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3835
3836 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3837 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3838 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3841 connection.
3842
3843 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3844 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3845 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3847 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3848
3849 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3850 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3851 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3852 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3853 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3854 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3855 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3856 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3857 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3858 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3859 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3860 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3861 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3862 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3863 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3864
3865 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3866 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3867 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3868 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3869 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3870 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3871 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3872 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3873 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3874 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3875
3876 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3877 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3878 .cindex "freezing messages"
3879 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3880 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3881 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3882 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3883 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3884 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3885 user.
3886
3887 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3888 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3889 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3890 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3891 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3892 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3893 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3894 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3895 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3896 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3897 user.
3898
3899 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3900 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3901 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3902 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3903 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3904 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3905 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3906
3907 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3908 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3909 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3910 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3911 .cindex "removing recipients"
3912 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3913 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3914 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3915 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3916 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3917 can be used only by an admin user.
3918
3919 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3920 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3921 .cindex "removing messages"
3922 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3923 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3924 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3925 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3926 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3927 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3928 placed on the queue.
3929
3930 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3931 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3932 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3933 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3934 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3935 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3936 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3937 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3938 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3939 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3940 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3941
3942 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3943 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3944 .cindex "thawing messages"
3945 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3946 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3947 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3948 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3949 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3950 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3951 by an admin user.
3952
3953 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3954 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3955 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3956 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3957 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3958 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3959
3960 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3961 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3962 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3963 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3964 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3965 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3966 only by an admin user.
3967
3968 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3969 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3970 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3971 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3973 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3974 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3975
3976 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3977 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3978 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3979 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3980 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3981 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3982
3983 .vitem &%-m%&
3984 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3985 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3986 treats it that way too.
3987
3988 .vitem &%-N%&
3989 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3990 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3991 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3992 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3993 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3994 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3995 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3996 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3997 than &"=>"&.
3998
3999 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4000 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4001 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4002 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4003 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4004 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4005 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4006 for that message.
4007
4008 .vitem &%-n%&
4009 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4010 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4011 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4012 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4013
4014 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4015 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4016 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4017 Exim.
4018
4019 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4020 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4021 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4022 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4023 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4024 description above.
4025
4026 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4027 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4028 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4029 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4030 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4031 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4032 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4033 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4034
4035 .vitem &%-odb%&
4036 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4037 .cindex "background delivery"
4038 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4039 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4040 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4041 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4042 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4043 processes to finish.
4044
4045 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4046 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4047 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4048 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4049
4050 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4051 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4052 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4053 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4054
4055 .vitem &%-odf%&
4056 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4057 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4058 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4059 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4060 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4061 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4062 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4063
4064 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4065 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4066 during deliveries.
4067
4068 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4069 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4070
4071 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4072 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4073 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4074 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4075
4076
4077 .vitem &%-odi%&
4078 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4079 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4080 Sendmail.
4081
4082 .vitem &%-odq%&
4083 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4084 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4085 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4086 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4087 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4088 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4089 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4090 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4091 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4092 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4093 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4094 forces queueing.
4095
4096 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4097 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4098 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4099 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4100 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4101 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4102 configuration file is in effect.
4103
4104 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4105 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4106 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4107 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4108 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4109 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4110 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4111 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4112 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4113 &%-qq%& option.
4114
4115 .vitem &%-oee%&
4116 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4117 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4118 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4119 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4120 message.
4121
4122 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4123 Provided
4124 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4125 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4126 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4127 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4128
4129 .vitem &%-oem%&
4130 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4131 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4132 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4133 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4134 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4135 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4136
4137 .vitem &%-oep%&
4138 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4139 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4140 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4141 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4142 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4143 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4144
4145 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4146 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4147 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4148 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4149 effect as &%-oep%&.
4150
4151 .vitem &%-oew%&
4152 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4153 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4154 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4155 effect as &%-oem%&.
4156
4157 .vitem &%-oi%&
4158 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4159 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4160 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4161 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4162 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4163 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4164 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4165
4166 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4167 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4168 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4169
4170 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4171 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4172 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4173 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4174 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4175 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4176 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4177 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4178
4179 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4180 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4181 .code
4182 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4183 .endd
4184 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4185 followed by a colon and the port number:
4186 .code
4187 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4188 .endd
4189 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4190 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4191 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4192 whichever one is last.
4193
4194 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4195 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4196 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4197 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4198 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4199 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4200 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4201 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4202
4203 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4204 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4205 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4206 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4207 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4208 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4209 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4210 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4211
4212 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4213 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4214 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4215 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4216 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4217 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4218 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4219 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4220 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4221 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4222
4223 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4224 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4225 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4226 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4227 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4228 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4229 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4230
4231 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4232 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4233 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4234 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4235 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4236 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4237 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4238 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4239 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4240
4241 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4242 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4243 is sending the bounce.
4244
4245 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4246 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4247 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4248 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4249 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4250 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4251 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4252 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4253 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4254 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4255 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4256 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4257
4258 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4259 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4260 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4261 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4262 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4263 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4264 uses the name it is given.
4265
4266 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4267 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4268 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4269 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4270 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4271 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4272 used, when there is no default.
4273
4274 .vitem &%-om%&
4275 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4276 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4277 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4278 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4279 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4280
4281 .vitem &%-oo%&
4282 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4283 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4284 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4285 whatever that means.
4286
4287 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4288 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4289 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4290 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4291 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4292 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4293 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4294 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4295 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4296
4297 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4298 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4299 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4300 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4301 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4302 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4303 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4304
4305 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4306 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4307 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4308 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4309 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4310 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4311 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4312 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4313
4314 .vitem &%-ov%&
4315 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4316 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4317
4318 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4319 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4320 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4321 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4322 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4323 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4324 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4325 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4326 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4327 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4328
4329 .vitem &%-pd%&
4330 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4331 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4332 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4333 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4334 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4335 needed.
4336
4337 .vitem &%-ps%&
4338 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4339 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4340 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4341 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4342 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4343 started.
4344
4345 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4346 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4347 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4348 .display
4349 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4350 .endd
4351 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4352 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4353 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4354 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4355 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4356
4357 .vitem &%-q%&
4358 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4359 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4360 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4361 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4362 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4363 and &%-S%& options).
4364
4365 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4366 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4367 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4368 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4369 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4370 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4371
4372 If
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4374 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4375 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4376 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4377 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4378 proceeding.
4379
4380 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4381 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4382 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4383 this to be repeated periodically.
4384
4385 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4386 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4387 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4388 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4389
4390 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4391 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4392 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4393
4394 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4395 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4396 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4397 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4398
4399 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4400 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4401 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4402 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4403 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4404 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4405 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4406 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4407 transports are run.
4408
4409 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4410 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4411 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4412 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4413 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4414 delivered down a single SMTP
4415 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4416 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4417 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4418 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4419 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4420 intermittently.
4421
4422 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4423 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4424 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4425 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4426 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4427 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4428 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4429
4430 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4431 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4432 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4433 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4434 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4435 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4436 their retry times are tried.
4437
4438 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4439 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4440 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4441 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4442 frozen or not.
4443
4444 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4445 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4446 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4447 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4448 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4449 for later delivery.
4450
4451 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4452 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4453 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4454 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4455 starting message id. For example:
4456 .code
4457 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4458 .endd
4459 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4460 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4461 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4462 .code
4463 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4464 .endd
4465 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4466 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4467 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4468 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4469 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4470 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4471
4472 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4473 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4474 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4475 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4476 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4477 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4478 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4479 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4480 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4481 .code
4482 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4483 .endd
4484 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4485 process every 30 minutes.
4486
4487 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4488 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4489
4490 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4491 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4492 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4493 compatibility.
4494
4495 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4496 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4497 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4498
4499 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4500 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4501 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4502 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4503 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4504 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4505 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4506 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4507 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4508
4509 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4510 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4511 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4512 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4513 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4514 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4515
4516 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4517 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4518 .code
4519 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4520 .endd
4521 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4522 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4523 applied to each queue run.
4524
4525 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4526 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4527 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4528 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4529 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4530 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4531 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4532 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4533 address will be skipped.
4534
4535 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4536 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4537 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4538 &'ff'& is present.
4539
4540 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4541 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4542 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4543 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4544 an arbitrary command instead.
4545
4546 .vitem &%-r%&
4547 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4548 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4549
4550 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4551 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4552 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4553 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4554 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4555 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4556 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4557 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4558
4559 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4560 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4561 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4562 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4563 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4564
4565 .vitem &%-t%&
4566 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4567 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4568 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4569 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4570 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4571 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4572 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4573 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4574 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4575 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4576
4577 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4578 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4579 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4580 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4581 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4582 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4583 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4584 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4585 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4586 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4587 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4588
4589 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4590 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4591 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4592 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4593 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4594 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4595
4596 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4597 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4598 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4599 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4600 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4601 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4602 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4603 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4604 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4605
4606 .vitem &%-ti%&
4607 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4608 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4609 compatibility with Sendmail.
4610
4611 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4612 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4613 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4614 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4615 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4616 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4617 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4618 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4619
4620
4621 .vitem &%-U%&
4622 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4623 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4624 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4625 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4626 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4627 set. Exim ignores this option.
4628
4629 .vitem &%-v%&
4630 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4631 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4632 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4633 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4634 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4635 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4636 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4637 unconditional.
4638
4639 .vitem &%-x%&
4640 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4641 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4642 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4643 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4644 this option.
4645
4646 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4647 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4648 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4649 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4650
4651 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4652 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4653 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4654 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4655 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4656 under most shells.
4657 .endlist
4658
4659 .ecindex IIDclo1
4660 .ecindex IIDclo2
4661
4662
4663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4665 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4666 . creates a man page for the options.
4667 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4668
4669 .literal xml
4670 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4671 .literal off
4672
4673
4674
4675
4676
4677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4679
4680
4681 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4682 "The runtime configuration file"
4683
4684 .cindex "run time configuration"
4685 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4686 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4687 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4688 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4689 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4690 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4691 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4692 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4693 control.
4694
4695 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4696 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4697 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4698 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4699 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4700 actually alter the string.
4701
4702 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4703 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4704 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4705 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4706 existing file in the list.
4707
4708 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4709 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4710 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4711 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4712 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4713 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4714 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4715 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4716 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4717 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4718 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4719
4720 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4721 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4722 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4723 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4724 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4725
4726 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4727 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4728 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4729 compromise the Exim user account.
4730
4731 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4732 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4733 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4734 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4735 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4736 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4737 configuration.
4738
4739
4740
4741 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4742 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4743 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4744 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4745 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4746 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4747 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4748 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4749 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4750 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4751 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4752
4753 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4754 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4755 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4756 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4757 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4758 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4759 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4760 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4761 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4762 &%-M%&).
4763
4764 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4765 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4766 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4767 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4768 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4769
4770 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4771 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4772 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4773 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4774 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4775 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4776
4777 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4778 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4779 necessarily be discarded.
4780 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4781 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4782 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4783 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4784 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4785 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4786
4787 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4788 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4789 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4790 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4791 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4792 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4793 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4794
4795 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4796 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4797 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4798
4799
4800
4801 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4802 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4803 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4804 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4805 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4806 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4807 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4808 optional parts are:
4809
4810 .ilist
4811 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4812 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4813 .next
4814 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4815 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4816 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4817 .next
4818 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4819 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4820 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4821 .next
4822 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4823 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4824 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4825 .next
4826 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4827 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4828 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4829 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4830 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4831 .next
4832 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4833 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4834 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4835 .next
4836 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4837 want to use this feature, you must set
4838 .code
4839 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4840 .endd
4841 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4842 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4843 .endlist
4844
4845 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4846 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4847 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4848 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4849
4850 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4851 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4852 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4853 and does not introduce a comment.
4854
4855 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4856 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4857 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4858 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4859 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4860
4861 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4862 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4863 change settings as required.
4864
4865 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4866 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4867 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4868 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4869 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4870 described.
4871
4872
4873
4874 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4875 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4876 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4877 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4878 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4879 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4880 using this syntax:
4881 .display
4882 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4883 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4884 .endd
4885 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4886 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4887 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4888 name is required.
4889
4890 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4891 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4892 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4893 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4894
4895 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4896 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4897 for example:
4898 .code
4899 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4900 .include /some/file
4901 .endd
4902 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4903 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4904 inclusion appears.
4905
4906
4907
4908 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4909 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4910 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4911 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4912 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4913 definition, and must be of the form
4914 .display
4915 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4916 .endd
4917 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4918 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4919 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4920 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4921 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4922
4923 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4924 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4925 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4926
4927 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4928 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4929 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4930 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4931 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4932 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4933 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4934 define
4935 .display
4936 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4937 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4938 .endd
4939 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4940 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4941 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4942 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4943 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4944 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4945
4946
4947 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4948 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4949 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4950 &'='&. For example:
4951 .code
4952 MAC = initial value
4953 ...
4954 MAC == updated value
4955 .endd
4956 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4957 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4958 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4959 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4960 .code
4961 MAC = initial value
4962 ...
4963 MAC == MAC and something added
4964 .endd
4965 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4966 from a number of other files.
4967
4968 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4969 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4970 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4971 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4972 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4973 file to be ignored.
4974
4975
4976
4977 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4978 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4979 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4980 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4981 .code
4982 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4983 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4984 .endd
4985 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4986 .code
4987 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4988 .endd
4989 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4990 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4991 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4992
4993
4994 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4995 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4996 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4997 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4998 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4999 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5000 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5001
5002 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5003 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5004 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5005 line. Thus:
5006 .code
5007 .ifdef AAA
5008 message_size_limit = 50M
5009 .else
5010 message_size_limit = 100M
5011 .endif
5012 .endd
5013 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
5014 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5015 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5016 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5017
5018 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5019 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5020 in this line"& will always be true.
5021
5022 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5023 to clarify complicated nestings.
5024
5025
5026
5027 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5028 .cindex "common option syntax"
5029 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5030 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5031 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5032 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5033 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5034 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5035 space) and then the value. For example:
5036 .code
5037 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5038 .endd
5039 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5040 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5041 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5042 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5043 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5044 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5045 word &"hide"&. For example:
5046 .code
5047 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5048 .endd
5049 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5050 .code
5051 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5052 .endd
5053 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5054 all instances of the same driver.
5055
5056 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5057 that are found in option settings.
5058
5059
5060 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5061 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5062 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5063 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5064 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5065 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5066 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5067 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5068 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5069 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5070 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5071 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5072 .code
5073 queue_only
5074 queue_only = true
5075 .endd
5076 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5077 .code
5078 no_queue_only
5079 queue_only = false
5080 .endd
5081 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5082
5083
5084
5085
5086 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5087 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5088 .cindex "format" "integer"
5089 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5090 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5091 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5092 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5093 hexadecimal number.
5094
5095 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5096 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5097 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5098 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5099 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5100 used.
5101
5102
5103 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5104 .cindex "integer format"
5105 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5106 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5107 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5108 Such options are always output in octal.
5109
5110
5111 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5112 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5113 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5114 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5115 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5116
5117
5118
5119 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5120 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5121 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5122 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5123 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5124
5125 .table2 30pt
5126 .irow &%s%& seconds
5127 .irow &%m%& minutes
5128 .irow &%h%& hours
5129 .irow &%d%& days
5130 .irow &%w%& weeks
5131 .endtable
5132
5133 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5134 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5135 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5136
5137
5138
5139 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5140 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5141 .cindex "format" "string"
5142 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5143 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5144 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5145 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5146 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5147 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5148 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5149 therefore equivalent:
5150 .code
5151 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5152 trusted_users = uucp:\
5153 # This comment line is ignored
5154 mail
5155 .endd
5156 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5157 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5158 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5159 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5160 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5161
5162 .table2 100pt
5163 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5164 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5165 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5166 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5167 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5168 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5169 character"
5170 .endtable
5171
5172 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5173 character, that character replaces the pair.
5174
5175 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5176 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5177 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5178 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5179 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5180 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5181
5182
5183 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5184 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5185 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5186 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5187 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5188 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5189 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5190 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5191 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5192 within a quoted configuration string.
5193
5194
5195 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5196 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5197 .cindex "format" "user name"
5198 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5199 .cindex "format" "group name"
5200 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5201 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5202 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5203 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5204
5205
5206 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5207 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5208 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5209 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5210 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5211 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5212 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5213 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5214 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5215 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5216 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5217
5218 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5219 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5220 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5221 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5222 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5223 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5224 example, the list
5225 .code
5226 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5227 .endd
5228 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5229
5230 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5231 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5232 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5233 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5234
5235 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5236 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5237 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5238 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5239 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5240 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5241 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5242 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5243 .code
5244 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5245 .endd
5246 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5247 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5248 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5249
5250 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5251 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5252 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5253 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5254 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5255 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5256 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5257 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5258 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5259 .code
5260 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5261 .endd
5262 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5263 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5264 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5265 the value in quotes. For example:
5266 .code
5267 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5268 .endd
5269 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5270 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5271 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5272 enclosing an empty list item.
5273
5274
5275
5276 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5277 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5278 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5279 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5280 .code
5281 senders = user@domain :
5282 .endd
5283 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5284 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5285 items, the second of which is empty:
5286 .code
5287 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5288 .endd
5289 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5290 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5291 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5292 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5293 .code
5294 senders = :
5295 .endd
5296 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5297 is at the end of the list.
5298
5299
5300
5301
5302 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5303 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5304 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5305 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5306 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5307 a sequence of lines like this:
5308 .display
5309 <&'instance name'&>:
5310 <&'option'&>
5311 ...
5312 <&'option'&>
5313 .endd
5314 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5315 followed by three options settings:
5316 .code
5317 localuser:
5318 driver = accept
5319 check_local_user
5320 transport = local_delivery
5321 .endd
5322 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5323 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5324 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5325 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5326 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5327 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5328
5329 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5330 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5331
5332 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5333 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5334 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5335 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5336 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5337 server.
5338
5339 .cindex "generic options"
5340 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5341 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5342 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5343 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5344 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5345 .cindex "private options"
5346 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5347 they all have default values.
5348
5349 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5350 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5351 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5352
5353 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5354 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5355 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5356 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5357 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5358 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5359 configuration lines:
5360 .code
5361 remote_smtp:
5362 driver = smtp
5363 .endd
5364 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5365 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5366 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5367 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5368 thus:
5369 .code
5370 special_smtp:
5371 driver = smtp
5372 port = 1234
5373 command_timeout = 10s
5374 .endd
5375 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5376 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5377 lines.
5378
5379 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5380 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5381 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5382 option.
5383
5384
5385
5386
5387
5388
5389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5390 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5391
5392 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5393 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5394 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5395 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5396 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5397 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5398 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5399 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5400 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5401 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5402 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5403
5404
5405
5406 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5407 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5408 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5409 the line
5410 .code
5411 # primary_hostname =
5412 .endd
5413 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5414 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5415 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5416 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5417
5418 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5419 .code
5420 domainlist local_domains = @
5421 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5422 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5423 .endd
5424 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5425 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5426 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5427 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5428
5429 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5430 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5431 on the local host.
5432
5433 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5434 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5435 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5436 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5437 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5438 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5439
5440 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5441 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5442 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5443 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5444 domain is permitted.
5445
5446 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5447 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5448 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5449 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5450 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5451 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5452
5453 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5454 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5455 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5456
5457 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5458 .code
5459 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5460 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5461 .endd
5462 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5463 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5464 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5465 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5466 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5467 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5468 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5469 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5470 contents of a message to be checked.
5471
5472 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5473 .code
5474 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5475 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5476 .endd
5477 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5478 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5479 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5480 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5481
5482 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5483 .code
5484 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5485 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5486 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5487 .endd
5488 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5489 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5490 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5491 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5492 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5493 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5494 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5495
5496 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5497 .code
5498 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5499 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5500 .endd
5501 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5502 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5503 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5504 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5505 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5506 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5507 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5508 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5509 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5510 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5511 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5512 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5513 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5514 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5515 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5516 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5517
5518 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5519 .code
5520 # qualify_domain =
5521 # qualify_recipient =
5522 .endd
5523 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5524 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5525 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5526 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5527 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5528 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5529
5530 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5531 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5532 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5533 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5534 .code
5535 # allow_domain_literals
5536 .endd
5537 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5538 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5539 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5540 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5541 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5542 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5543
5544 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5545 .code
5546 never_users = root
5547 .endd
5548 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5549 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5550 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5551 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5552 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5553 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5554 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5555 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5556
5557 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5558 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5559 line,
5560 .code
5561 host_lookup = *
5562 .endd
5563 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5564 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5565 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5566 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5567 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5568 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5569 unreachable.
5570
5571 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5572 1413 (hence their names):
5573 .code
5574 rfc1413_hosts = *
5575 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5576 .endd
5577 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5578 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5579 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5580 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5581 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5582 information, you can change this.
5583
5584 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5585 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5586 .code
5587 prdr_enable = true
5588 .endd
5589
5590 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5591 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5592 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5593 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5594 .code
5595 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5596 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5597 .endd
5598 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5599 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5600
5601 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5602 over the default:
5603 .code
5604 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5605 +tls_certificate_verified
5606 .endd
5607
5608 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5609 .code
5610 # percent_hack_domains =
5611 .endd
5612 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5613 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5614 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5615
5616 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5617 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5618 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5619 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5620 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5621 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5622 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5623 always bounce messages.
5624 .code
5625 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5626 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5627 .endd
5628 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5629 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5630 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5631 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5632 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5633
5634
5635
5636 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5637 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5638 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5639 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5640 It starts with the line
5641 .code
5642 begin acl
5643 .endd
5644 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5645 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5646 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5647
5648 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5649 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5650 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5651 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5652 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5653 result of the ACL processing.
5654 .code
5655 acl_check_rcpt:
5656 .endd
5657 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5658 ACL, and names it.
5659 .code
5660 accept hosts = :
5661 .endd
5662 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5663 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5664 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5665 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5666 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5667 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5668
5669 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5670 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5671 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5672 manner.
5673 .code
5674 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5675 domains = +local_domains
5676 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5677
5678 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5679 domains = !+local_domains
5680 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5681 .endd
5682 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5683 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5684 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5685 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5686 in Internet mail addresses.
5687
5688 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5689 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5690 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5691 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5692 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5693 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5694 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5695 policy of being as safe as possible.
5696
5697 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5698 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5699 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5700 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5701 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5702 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5703
5704 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5705 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5706 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5707 have to modify this rule.
5708
5709 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5710 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5711 common convention of local parts constructed as
5712 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5713 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5714 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5715 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5716 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5717 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5718
5719 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5720 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5721 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5722 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5723 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5724 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5725 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5726 .code
5727 accept local_parts = postmaster
5728 domains = +local_domains
5729 .endd
5730 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5731 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5732 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5733 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5734 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5735
5736 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5737 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5738 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5739 .code
5740 require verify = sender
5741 .endd
5742 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5743 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5744 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5745 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5746 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5747 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5748 discusses the details of address verification.
5749 .code
5750 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5751 control = submission
5752 .endd
5753 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5754 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5755 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5756 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5757 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5758 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5759 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5760 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5761 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5762 .code
5763 accept authenticated = *
5764 control = submission
5765 .endd
5766 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5767 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5768 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5769 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5770 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5771 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5772 .code
5773 require message = relay not permitted
5774 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5775 .endd
5776 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5777 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5778 .code
5779 require verify = recipient
5780 .endd
5781 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5782 fails, the address is rejected.
5783 .code
5784 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5785 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5786 # $dnslist_text
5787 # dnslists = black.list.example
5788 #
5789 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5790 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5791 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5792 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5793 .endd
5794 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5795 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5796 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5797 line.
5798 .code
5799 # require verify = csa
5800 .endd
5801 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5802 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5803 records.
5804 .code
5805 accept
5806 .endd
5807 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5808 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5809 .code
5810 acl_check_data:
5811 .endd
5812 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5813 of this ACL are commented out:
5814 .code
5815 # deny malware = *
5816 # message = This message contains a virus \
5817 # ($malware_name).
5818 .endd
5819 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5820 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5821 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5822 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5823 .code
5824 # warn spam = nobody
5825 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5826 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5827 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5828 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5829 .endd
5830 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5831 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5832 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5833 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5834 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5835 whatever the spam score.
5836 .code
5837 accept
5838 .endd
5839 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5840
5841
5842 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5843 .cindex "default" "routers"
5844 .cindex "routers" "default"
5845 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5846 by the line
5847 .code
5848 begin routers
5849 .endd
5850 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5851 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5852 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5853 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5854 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5855 .code
5856 # domain_literal:
5857 # driver = ipliteral
5858 # domains = !+local_domains
5859 # transport = remote_smtp
5860 .endd
5861 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5862 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5863 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5864 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5865 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5866 .code
5867 dnslookup:
5868 driver = dnslookup
5869 domains = ! +local_domains
5870 transport = remote_smtp
5871 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5872 no_more
5873 .endd
5874 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5875 domains. This is specified by the line
5876 .code
5877 domains = ! +local_domains
5878 .endd
5879 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5880 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5881 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5882 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5883 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5884 passed on to the following routers.
5885
5886 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5887 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5888 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5889 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5890 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5891
5892 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5893 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5894 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5895 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5896 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5897 the address fails and is bounced.
5898
5899 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5900 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5901 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5902 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5903 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5904 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5905 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5906 out.
5907 .code
5908 system_aliases:
5909 driver = redirect
5910 allow_fail
5911 allow_defer
5912 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5913 # user = exim
5914 file_transport = address_file
5915 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5916 .endd
5917 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5918 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5919 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5920 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5921 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5922 the next router.
5923
5924 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5925 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5926 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5927 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5928 .code
5929 userforward:
5930 driver = redirect
5931 check_local_user
5932 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5933 # local_part_suffix_optional
5934 file = $home/.forward
5935 # allow_filter
5936 no_verify
5937 no_expn
5938 check_ancestor
5939 file_transport = address_file
5940 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5941 reply_transport = address_reply
5942 .endd
5943 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5944 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5945 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5946 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5947 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5948 namely:
5949 .code
5950 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5951 # local_part_suffix_optional
5952 .endd
5953 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5954 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5955 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5956 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5957 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5958 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5959 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5960
5961 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5962 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5963 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5964 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5965
5966 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5967 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5968 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5969 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5970 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5971 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5972 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5973
5974 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5975 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5976 There are two reasons for doing this:
5977
5978 .olist
5979 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5980 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5981 unnecessary work.
5982 .next
5983 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5984 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5985 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5986 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5987 this time.
5988 .endlist
5989
5990 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5991 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5992 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5993 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5994
5995 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5996 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5997 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5998 .code
5999 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6000 .endd
6001 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6002 transport.
6003 .code
6004 localuser:
6005 driver = accept
6006 check_local_user
6007 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6008 # local_part_suffix_optional
6009 transport = local_delivery
6010 .endd
6011 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6012 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6013 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6014 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6015 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6016
6017
6018 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6019 .cindex "default" "transports"
6020 .cindex "transports" "default"
6021 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6022 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6023 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6024 .code
6025 begin transports
6026 .endd
6027 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6028 .code
6029 remote_smtp:
6030 driver = smtp
6031 hosts_try_prdr = *
6032 .endd
6033 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6034 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6035 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6036 It is negotiated between client and server
6037 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6038 All other options are defaulted.
6039 .code
6040 local_delivery:
6041 driver = appendfile
6042 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6043 delivery_date_add
6044 envelope_to_add
6045 return_path_add
6046 # group = mail
6047 # mode = 0660
6048 .endd
6049 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6050 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6051 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6052 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6053 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6054 show how this can be done.
6055
6056 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6057 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6058 similarly-named options above.
6059 .code
6060 address_pipe:
6061 driver = pipe
6062 return_output
6063 .endd
6064 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6065 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6066 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6067 sender.
6068 .code
6069 address_file:
6070 driver = appendfile
6071 delivery_date_add
6072 envelope_to_add
6073 return_path_add
6074 .endd
6075 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6076 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6077 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6078 .code
6079 address_reply:
6080 driver = autoreply
6081 .endd
6082 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6083 filter files.
6084
6085
6086
6087 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6088 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6089 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6090 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6091 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6092 introduced by the line
6093 .code
6094 begin retry
6095 .endd
6096 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6097 errors:
6098 .code
6099 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6100 .endd
6101 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6102 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6103 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6104 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6105
6106 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6107 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6108 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6109
6110
6111 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6112 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6113 .code
6114 begin rewrite
6115 .endd
6116 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6117 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6118
6119
6120
6121 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6122 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6123 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6124 .code
6125 begin authenticators
6126 .endd
6127 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6128 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6129 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6130 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6131 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6132 to support most MUA software.
6133
6134 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6135 .code
6136 #PLAIN:
6137 # driver = plaintext
6138 # server_set_id = $auth2
6139 # server_prompts = :
6140 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6141 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6142 .endd
6143 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6144 .code
6145 #LOGIN:
6146 # driver = plaintext
6147 # server_set_id = $auth1
6148 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6149 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6150 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6151 .endd
6152
6153 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6154 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6155 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6156 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6157 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6158 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6159 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6160 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6161
6162 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6163 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6164 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6165 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6166
6167 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6168 usercode and password are in different positions.
6169 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6170
6171 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6172
6173
6174
6175 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6177
6178 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6179
6180 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6181 .cindex "PCRE"
6182 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6183 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6184 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6185 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6186 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6187 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6188
6189 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6190 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6191 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6192 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6193 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6194 case-insensitive.
6195
6196 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6197 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6198 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6199 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6200 .code
6201 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6202 .endd
6203 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6204 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6205 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6206 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6207 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6208 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6209 matched.
6210
6211 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6212 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6213 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6214 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6215 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6216 match anywhere in the subject string.
6217
6218 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6219 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6220 .code
6221 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6222 .endd
6223 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6224 You need to use:
6225 .code
6226 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6227 .endd
6228 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6229 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6230
6231
6232
6233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6235
6236 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6237 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6238 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6239 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6240 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6241 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6242
6243 .olist
6244 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6245 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6246 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6247 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6248 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6249 .next
6250 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6251 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6252 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6253 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6254 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6255 .endlist
6256
6257 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6258 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6259 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6260 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6261 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6262 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6263
6264 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6265 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6266 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6267 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6268 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6269 .code
6270 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6271 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6272 .endd
6273 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6274 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6275 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6276 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6277 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6278 .code
6279 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6280 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6281 .endd
6282 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6283 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6284
6285 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6286 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6287 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6288 .code
6289 domain1:
6290 domain2:
6291 .endd
6292 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6293 matches the list item.
6294
6295 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6296 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6297 .code
6298 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6299 .endd
6300 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6301 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6302 causes a second lookup to occur.
6303
6304 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6305 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6306 lookup is permitted.
6307
6308
6309 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6310 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6311 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6312 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6313
6314 .ilist
6315 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6316 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6317 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6318 .next
6319 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6320 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6321 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6322 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6323 .endlist
6324
6325 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6326 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6327 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6328 .code
6329 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6330 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6331 .endd
6332 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6333 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6334 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6335
6336
6337
6338
6339 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6340 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6341 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6342 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6343
6344 .ilist
6345 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6346 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6347 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6348 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6349 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6350 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6351 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6352 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6353 be found in several places:
6354 .display
6355 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6356 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6357 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6358 .endd
6359 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6360 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6361 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6362 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6363 .next
6364 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6365 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6366 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6367 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6368 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6369 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6370 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6371
6372 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6373 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6374 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6375 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6376 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6377 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6378 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6379 .next
6380 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6381 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6382 .cindex "sasldb2"
6383 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6384 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6385 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6386 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6387 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6388 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6389 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6390 .next
6391 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6392 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6393 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6394 .cindex "Courier"
6395 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6396 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6397 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6398 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6399 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6400 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6401 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6402 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6403 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6404 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6405 .next
6406 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6407 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6408 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6409 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6410 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6411 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6412 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6413 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6414 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6415 .next
6416 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6417 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6418 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6419 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6420 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6421 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6422 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6423 .code
6424 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6425 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6426 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6427 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6428 .endd
6429 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6430 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6431 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6432 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6433 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6434
6435 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6436 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6437 lookup types support only literal keys.
6438
6439 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6440 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6441 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6442 .next
6443 .cindex "linear search"
6444 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6445 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6446 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6447 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6448 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6449 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6450 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6451 in the file is used.
6452
6453 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6454 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6455 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6456 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6457 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6458 colon, for example:
6459 .code
6460 baduser: :fail:
6461 .endd
6462 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6463 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6464 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6465 wildcarding of any kind.
6466
6467 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6468 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6469 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6470 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6471 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6472 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6473 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6474 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6475 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6476
6477 .next
6478 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6479 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6480 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6482 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6483 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6484 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6485 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6486
6487 .next
6488 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6489 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6490 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6491 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6492 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6493 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6494 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6495 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6496 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6497
6498 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6499 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6500 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6501 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6502
6503 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6504 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6505
6506 .olist
6507 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6508 .code
6509 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6510 *fish data for anythingfish
6511 .endd
6512 .next
6513 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6514 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6515 .code
6516 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6517 .endd
6518 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6519 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6520 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6521 .code
6522 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6523 .endd
6524 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6525 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6526 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6527 .code
6528 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6529 .endd
6530
6531 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6532 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6533 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6534 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6535 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6536
6537 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6538 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6539 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6540 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6541 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6542
6543 .next
6544 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6545 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6546 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6547 example:
6548 .code
6549 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6550 .endd
6551 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6552 .endlist olist
6553
6554 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6555 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6556 be followed by optional colons.
6557
6558 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6559 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6560 lookup types support only literal keys.
6561 .endlist ilist
6562
6563
6564 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6565 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6566 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6567 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6568 many of them are given in later sections.
6569
6570 .ilist
6571 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6572 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6573 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6574 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6575 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6576 .next
6577 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6579 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6580 .next
6581 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6582 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6583 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6584 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6585 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6586 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6587 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6588 .next
6589 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6590 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6591 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6592 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6593 .next
6594 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6595 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6596 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6597 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6598 .next
6599 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6600 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6601 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6602 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6603 .next
6604 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6605 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6606 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6607 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6608 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6609 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6610 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6611 password value. For example:
6612 .code
6613 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6614 .endd
6615 .next
6616 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6617 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6618 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6619 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6620
6621 .next
6622 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6624 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6625 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6626
6627 .next
6628 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6629 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6630 .next
6631 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6632 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6633 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6634 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6635 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6636 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6637 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6638 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6639 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6640 .code
6641 require condition = \
6642 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6643 .endd
6644 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6645 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6646 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6647 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6648 .endlist
6649
6650
6651
6652 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6653 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6654 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6655 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6656 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6657 options such as a list of local domains.
6658
6659 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6660 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6661 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6662 or may give up altogether.
6663
6664
6665
6666 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6667 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6668 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6670 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6671 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6672 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6673 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6674
6675 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6676 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6677 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6678
6679 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6680 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6681 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6682
6683 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6684 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6685 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6686 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6687 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6688 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6689 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6690 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6691 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6692 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6693 .code
6694 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6695 .endd
6696 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6697 looks up these keys, in this order:
6698 .code
6699 jane@eyre.example
6700 *@eyre.example
6701 *
6702 .endd
6703 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6704 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6705 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6706 Exim move on to try the next key.
6707
6708
6709
6710 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6711 .cindex "partial matching"
6712 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6713 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6714 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6715 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6716 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6717 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6718 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6719 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6720 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6721 a key in a DBM file is
6722 .code
6723 *.dates.fict.example
6724 .endd
6725 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6726 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6727 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6728 file.
6729
6730 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6731 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6732 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6733
6734 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6735 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6736 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6737 partial matching keys
6738 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6739 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6740 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6741
6742 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6743 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6744 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6745 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6746 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6747 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6748 remains.
6749
6750 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6751 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6752 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6753 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6754 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6755 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6756 .code
6757 2250.dates.fict.example
6758 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6759 *.dates.fict.example
6760 *.fict.example
6761 .endd
6762 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6763 finishes.
6764
6765 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6766 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6767 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6768 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6769 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6770 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6771 .code
6772 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6773 .endd
6774 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6775 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6776 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6777 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6778 .code
6779 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6780 .endd
6781 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6782 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6783
6784 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6785 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6786 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6787
6788 .ilist
6789 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6790 .next
6791 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6792 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6793 .next
6794 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6795 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6796 for &"*"& on its own.
6797 .next
6798 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6799 .endlist
6800
6801
6802 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6803 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6804 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6805 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6806 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6807 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6808 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6809
6810 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6811 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6812 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6813 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6814 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6815
6816
6817
6818
6819 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6820 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6821 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6822 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6823 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6824 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6825 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6826
6827 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6828 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6829 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6830 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6831 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6832 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6833
6834 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6835 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6836 complete.
6837
6838
6839
6840
6841 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6842 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6843 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6844 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6845 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6846 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6847 .code
6848 [name=$local_part]
6849 .endd
6850 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6851 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6852 .code
6853 [name="$local_part"]
6854 .endd
6855 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6856 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6857 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6858 of the following form is provided:
6859 .code
6860 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6861 .endd
6862 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6863 .code
6864 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6865 .endd
6866 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6867 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6868 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6869
6870
6871
6872
6873 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6874 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6875 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6876 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6877 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6878 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6879 an expansion string could contain:
6880 .code
6881 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6882 .endd
6883 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6884 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6885 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6886 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6887
6888 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6889 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6890 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6891
6892 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6893 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6894 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6895 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6896 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6897 .code
6898 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6899 .endd
6900 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6901 white space is ignored.
6902 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6903 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6904 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6905
6906 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6907 When the type is PTR,
6908 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6909 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6910 .code
6911 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6912 .endd
6913 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6914 altered and nothing is added.
6915
6916 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6917 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6918 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6919 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6920 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6921 The field separator can be modified as above.
6922
6923 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6924 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6925 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6926 unless a field separator is specified.
6927 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6928 For SPF records the
6929 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6930 .code
6931 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6932 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6933 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6934 .endd
6935 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6936 white space is ignored.
6937
6938 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6939 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6940 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6941 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6942 specified.
6943 .code
6944 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6945 .endd
6946
6947 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6948 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6949 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6950 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6951 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are givien by optional keywords,
6952 each followed by a comma,
6953 that may appear before the record type.
6954
6955 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6956 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6957 a defer-option modifier.
6958 The possible keywords are
6959 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6960 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6961 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6962 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6963 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6964 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6965 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6966 .code
6967 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6968 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6969 .endd
6970 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6971 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6972
6973 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6974 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6975 The possible keywords are
6976 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6977 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6978 with the lookup.
6979 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6980 is not labelled as authenticated data
6981 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6982 The default is &"never"&.
6983
6984 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6985
6986 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6987 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6988 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6989 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6990 (eg &"5s"&).
6991 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6992
6993 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
6994 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
6995 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
6996
6997
6998 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6999 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7000 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7001 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7002 the pseudo-type MXH:
7003 .code
7004 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7005 .endd
7006 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7007 returned.
7008
7009 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7010 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7011 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7012 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7013 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7014 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7015 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7016 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7017 .code
7018 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7019 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7020 .endd
7021 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7022 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7023 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7024
7025 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7026 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7027 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7028 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7029 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7030 such a list.
7031
7032 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7033 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7034 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7035 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7036 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7037 result of a successful lookup such as:
7038 .code
7039 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7040 .endd
7041 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7042 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7043 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7044
7045 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7046 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7047 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7048 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7049 .code
7050 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7051 .endd
7052
7053
7054 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7055 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7056 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7057 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7058 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7059 .code
7060 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7061 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7062 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7063 .endd
7064 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7065 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7066 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7067 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7068
7069 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7070 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7071 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7072
7073
7074
7075
7076 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7077 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7078 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7079 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7080 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7081 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7082 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7083 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7084 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7085 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7086 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7087 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7088 .code
7089 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7090 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7091 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7092 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7093 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7094 .endd
7095 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7096 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7097
7098 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7099 the way they handle the results of a query:
7100
7101 .ilist
7102 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7103 gives an error.
7104 .next
7105 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7106 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7107 .next
7108 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7109 from all of them are returned.
7110 .endlist
7111
7112
7113 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7114 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7115 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7116 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7117
7118
7119 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7120 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7121 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7122 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7123 .code
7124 data = ${lookup ldap \
7125 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7126 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7127 .endd
7128 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7129 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7130 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7131 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7132
7133 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7134 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7135 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7136
7137 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7138 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7139 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7140 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7141 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7142 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7143 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7144 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7145 &_exim.conf_&.
7146
7147
7148 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7149 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7150 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7151 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7152 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7153 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7154
7155 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7156 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7157 the string:
7158 .code
7159 * => \2A
7160 ( => \28
7161 ) => \29
7162 \ => \5C
7163 .endd
7164 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7165 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7166 .code
7167 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7168 .endd
7169 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7170 .code
7171 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7172 .endd
7173 yields
7174 .code
7175 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7176 .endd
7177 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7178 .code
7179 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7180 .endd
7181 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7182 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7183 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7184 .code
7185 , + " \ < > ;
7186 .endd
7187 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7188 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7189 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7190 .code
7191 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7192 .endd
7193 yields
7194 .code
7195 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7196 .endd
7197 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7198 .code
7199 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7200 .endd
7201 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7202 authentication below.
7203
7204
7205 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7206 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7207 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7208 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7209 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7210 by starting it with
7211 .code
7212 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7213 .endd
7214 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7215 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7216 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7217 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7218 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7219 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7220 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7221 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7222 failures, and timeouts.
7223
7224 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7225 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7226 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7227 doubled. For example
7228 .code
7229 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7230 .endd
7231 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7232 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7233 the local host) is used.
7234
7235 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7236 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7237 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7238 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7239 not available.
7240
7241 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7242 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7243 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7244 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7245 .code
7246 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7247 .endd
7248 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7249 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7250 .code
7251 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7252 .endd
7253 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7254 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7255 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7256 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7257 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7258 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7259 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7260 backup host.
7261
7262 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7263 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7264 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7265
7266 .ilist
7267 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7268 interface.
7269 .next
7270 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7271 .endlist
7272
7273
7274 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7275 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7276
7277
7278
7279 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7280 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7281 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7282 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7283 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7284 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7285 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7286 them. The following names are recognized:
7287 .display
7288 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7289 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7290 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7291 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7292 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7293 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7294 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7295 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7296 .endd
7297 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7298 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7299 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7300 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7301
7302 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7303 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7304 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7305 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7306 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7307 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7308 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7309 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7310 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7311
7312 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7313 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7314
7315 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7316 to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7317 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7318 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7319 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7320 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7321 alternate list (colon-separated).
7322
7323 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7324 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7325 .code
7326 ${lookup ldap
7327 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7328 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7329 {$value}fail}
7330 .endd
7331 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7332 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7333 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7334 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7335
7336 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7337 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7338 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7339
7340 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7341 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7342 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7343 quoting has two advantages:
7344
7345 .ilist
7346 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7347 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7348 .next
7349 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7350 .endlist
7351
7352 For example, a setting such as
7353 .code
7354 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7355 .endd
7356 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7357
7358 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7359 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7360 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7361 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7362 .code
7363 PASS=${quote:$3}
7364 .endd
7365 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7366 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7367 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7368
7369
7370
7371 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7372 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7373 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7374 as a sequence of values, for example
7375 .code
7376 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7377 .endd
7378 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7379 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7380 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7381 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7382 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7383 directory.
7384
7385 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7386 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7387 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7388
7389 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7390 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7391 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7392 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7393 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7394 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7395 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7396 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7397 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7398
7399 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7400 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7401 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7402 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7403 .code
7404 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7405 value1.1,value1,,2
7406
7407 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7408 value two
7409
7410 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7411 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7412
7413 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7414 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7415 .endd
7416 You can
7417 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7418 results of LDAP lookups.
7419 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7420 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7421 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7422 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7423 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7424 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7425
7426
7427
7428
7429 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7430 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7431 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7432 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7433 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7434 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7435 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7436 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7437 .code
7438 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7439 .endd
7440 might return the string
7441 .code
7442 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7443 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7444 .endd
7445 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7446 .code
7447 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7448 .endd
7449 would just return
7450 .code
7451 Martin Guerre
7452 .endd
7453 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7454 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7455 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7456
7457
7458
7459 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7460 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7461 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7462 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7463 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7464 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7465 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7466 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7467 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7468 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7469 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7470 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7471 might be
7472 .code
7473 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7474 {$value}fail}
7475 .endd
7476 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7477 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7478 .code
7479 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7480 {$value}}
7481 .endd
7482 might be
7483 .code
7484 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7485 .endd
7486 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7487 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7488 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7489 .code
7490 Mister X
7491 .endd
7492 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7493 with a newline between the data for each row.
7494
7495
7496 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7497 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7498 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7499 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7500 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7501 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7502 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7503 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7504 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7505 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7506 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7507 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7508 information.
7509 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7510 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7511 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7512 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7513 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7514 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7515 .code
7516 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7517 .endd
7518 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7519 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7520 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7521 .code
7522 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7523 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7524 .endd
7525 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7526 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7527 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7528 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7529 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7530 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7531
7532 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7533 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7534 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7535 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7536 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7537 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7538 characters are not special.
7539
7540 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7541 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7542 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7543 done by starting the query with
7544 .display
7545 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7546 .endd
7547 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7548 .olist
7549 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7550 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7551 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7552 taken from there.
7553 .next
7554 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7555 .endlist
7556 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7557 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7558 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7559
7560 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7561 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7562 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7563 like this:
7564 .code
7565 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7566 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7567 master/db/name/pw
7568 .endd
7569 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7570 .code
7571 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7572 .endd
7573 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7574 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7575 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7576 .code
7577 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7578 .endd
7579
7580
7581 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7582 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7583 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7584 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7585 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7586 .display
7587 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7588 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7589 .endd
7590 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7591 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7592
7593 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7594 the queries.
7595
7596 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7597 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7598
7599 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7600 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7601 is zero because no rows are affected.
7602
7603
7604 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7605 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7606 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7607 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7608 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7609 looks like this:
7610 .code
7611 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7612 .endd
7613 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7614 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7615 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7616
7617 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7618 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7619 affected.
7620
7621 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7622 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7623 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7624 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7625 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7626 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7627 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7628 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7629 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7630 .code
7631 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7632 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7633 .endd
7634 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7635 .code
7636 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7637 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7638 .endd
7639 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7640 quote, which it doubles.
7641
7642 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7643 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7644 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7645 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7646 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7647 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7648 option.
7649 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7650 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7651
7652
7653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7654 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7655
7656 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7657 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7658 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7659 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7660 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7661 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7662 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7663 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7664 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7665
7666 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7667 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7668 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7669 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7670
7671
7672
7673 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7674 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7675 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7676 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7677 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7678 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7679 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7680 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7681
7682
7683 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7684 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7685 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7686
7687 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7688 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7689 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7690 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7691 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7692 .code
7693 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7694 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7695 .endd
7696 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7697 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7698 senders based on the receiving domain.
7699
7700
7701
7702
7703 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7704 .cindex "list" "negation"
7705 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7706 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7707 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7708 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7709 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7710 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7711
7712 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7713 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7714 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7715 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7716 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7717 .code
7718 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7719 .endd
7720 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7721 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7722 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7723 .code
7724 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7725 .endd
7726 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7727 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7728 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7729
7730 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7731 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7732 item.
7733
7734
7735
7736 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7737 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7738 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7739 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7740 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7741 file names are not allowed,
7742 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7743 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7744 lines:
7745
7746 .ilist
7747 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7748 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7749 .next
7750 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7751 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7752 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7753 .code
7754 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7755 .endd
7756 .endlist
7757
7758 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7759 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7760 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7761 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7762
7763 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7764 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7765 .code
7766 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7767 .endd
7768 and the file contains the lines
7769 .code
7770 !a.b.c
7771 *.b.c
7772 .endd
7773 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7774 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7775
7776
7777
7778 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7779 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7780 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7781 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7782 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7783 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7784 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7785 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7786
7787 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7788 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7789 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7790 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7791
7792
7793
7794
7795 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7796 .cindex "named lists"
7797 .cindex "list" "named"
7798 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7799 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7800 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7801 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7802 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7803 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7804 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7805 .code
7806 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7807 .endd
7808 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7809 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7810 configured with the line
7811 .code
7812 domains = +local_domains
7813 .endd
7814 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7815 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7816 .code
7817 dnslookup:
7818 driver = dnslookup
7819 domains = ! +local_domains
7820 transport = remote_smtp
7821 no_more
7822 .endd
7823 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7824 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7825 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7826 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7827 .code
7828 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7829 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7830 .endd
7831 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7832 .code
7833 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7834 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7835 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7836 .endd
7837 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7838 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7839 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7840 .code
7841 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7842 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7843 .endd
7844 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7845 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7846 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7847 .code
7848 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7849 .endd
7850 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7851 referenced lists if you can.
7852
7853 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7854 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7855 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7856 .code
7857 domains = +local_domains
7858 .endd
7859 on several of your routers
7860 or in several ACL statements,
7861 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7862 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7863 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7864 the same each time they are referenced.
7865
7866 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7867 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7868 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7869 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7870
7871
7872
7873 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7874 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7875 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7876 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7877 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7878 write
7879 .code
7880 ALIST = host1 : host2
7881 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7882 .endd
7883 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7884 .code
7885 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7886 .endd
7887 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7888 list, and write
7889 .code
7890 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7891 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7892 .endd
7893 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7894 .code
7895 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7896 .endd
7897
7898
7899 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7900 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7901 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7902 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7903 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7904 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7905 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7906 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7907 message. For example:
7908 .code
7909 domainlist special_domains = \
7910 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7911 .endd
7912 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7913 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7914 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7915 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7916 same list each time.
7917
7918 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7919 cache the result anyway. For example:
7920 .code
7921 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7922 .endd
7923 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7924 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7925
7926
7927
7928 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7929 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7930 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7931 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7932 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7933
7934 .ilist
7935 .cindex "primary host name"
7936 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7937 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7938 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7939 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7940 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7941 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7942 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7943 differ only in their names.
7944 .next
7945 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7946 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7947 .cindex "domain literal"
7948 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7949 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7950 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7951 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7952 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7953 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7954 .next
7955 .cindex "@mx_any"
7956 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7957 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7958 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7959 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7960 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7961 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7962 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7963 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7964 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7965 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7966 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7967
7968 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7969 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7970 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7971 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7972 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7973
7974 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7975 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7976 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7977 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7978 on a router). For example:
7979 .code
7980 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7981 .endd
7982 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7983 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7984
7985 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7986 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7987 contain negative items.
7988
7989 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7990 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7991 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7992 .code
7993 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7994 an.other.domain : ...
7995 .endd
7996 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7997 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7998 .code
7999 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8000 an.other.domain ? ...
8001 .endd
8002 .next
8003 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8004 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8005 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8006 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8007 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8008 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8009 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8010 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8011 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8012 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8013
8014 .next
8015 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8016 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8017 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8018 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8019 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8020 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8021 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8022 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8023 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8024
8025 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8026 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8027 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8028 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8029 expression by expansion, of course).
8030 .next
8031 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8032 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8033 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8034 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8035 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8036 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8037 .code
8038 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8039 .endd
8040 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8041 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8042 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8043 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8044 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8045 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8046 other statements in the same ACL.
8047
8048 .next
8049 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8050 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8051 .code
8052 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8053 .endd
8054 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8055 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8056
8057 .next
8058 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8059 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8060 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8061 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8062 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8063 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8064 expansion variable.
8065 .next
8066 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8067 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8068 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8069 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8070 .code
8071 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8072 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8073 .endd
8074 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8075 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8076 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8077 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8078 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8079 .next
8080 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8081 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8082 between the pattern and the domain.
8083 .endlist
8084
8085 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8086 .code
8087 domainlist funny_domains = \
8088 @ : \
8089 lib.unseen.edu : \
8090 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8091 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8092 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8093 nis;domains.byname : \
8094 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8095 .endd
8096 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8097 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8098 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8099 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8100 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8101 patterns earlier.
8102
8103
8104
8105 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8106 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8107 .cindex "list" "host list"
8108 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8109 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8110 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8111 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8112 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8113 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8114 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8115
8116
8117 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8118 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8119 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8120 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8121 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8122 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8123 not used.
8124
8125 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8126 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8127 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8128
8129
8130
8131 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8132 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8133 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8134 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8135 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8136 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8137 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8138 concerns.)
8139
8140 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8141 inspecting its IP address:
8142
8143 .ilist
8144 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8145 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8146 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8147 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8148 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8149 with the IP address of the subject host.
8150
8151 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8152 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8153 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8154 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8155 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8156
8157 .next
8158 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8159 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8160 domain name, as just described.
8161
8162 .next
8163 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8164 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8165 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8166 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8167 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8168 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8169 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8170 that can never match a client host.
8171
8172 .next
8173 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8174 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8175 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8176 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8177 .code
8178 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8179 accept hosts = @[]
8180 .endd
8181 .next
8182 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8183 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8184 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8185 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8186 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8187 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8188 significant end of the address.
8189
8190 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8191 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8192 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8193 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8194 .code
8195 192.168.23.236/31
8196 .endd
8197 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8198 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8199 matches.
8200
8201 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8202 .code
8203 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8204 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8205 .endd
8206 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8207 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8208 For example:
8209 .code
8210 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8211 .endd
8212 could make use of a file containing
8213 .code
8214 172.16.0.0/12
8215 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8216 .endd
8217 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8218 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8219 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8220 .code
8221 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8222 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8223 .endd
8224 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8225 list.
8226 .endlist
8227
8228
8229
8230 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8231 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8232 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8233 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8234 address, the pattern takes this form:
8235 .display
8236 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8237 .endd
8238 For example:
8239 .code
8240 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8241 .endd
8242 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8243 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8244 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8245 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8246 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8247 returned by the lookup is not used.
8248
8249 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8250 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8251 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8252 patterns of this form:
8253 .display
8254 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8255 .endd
8256 For example:
8257 .code
8258 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8259 .endd
8260 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8261 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8262 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8263 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8264 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8265
8266 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8267 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8268 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8269 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8270 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8271 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8272 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8273 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8274 addresses are always used.
8275
8276 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8277 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8278 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8279 configurations.
8280
8281 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8282 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8283 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8284 case the IP address is used on its own.
8285
8286
8287
8288 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8289 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8290 .cindex "unknown host name"
8291 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8292 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8293 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8294 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8295 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8296 above.)
8297
8298 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8299 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8300 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8301 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8302 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8303 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8304 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8305
8306 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8307 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8308
8309 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8310 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8311 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8312 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8313 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8314 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8315 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8316 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8317 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8318
8319 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8320 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8321
8322 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8323 .cindex "alias for host"
8324 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8325 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8326
8327 .ilist
8328 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8329 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8330 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8331 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8332 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8333 expression.
8334 .next
8335 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8336 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8337 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8338 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8339 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8340 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8341 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8342 example,
8343 .code
8344 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8345 .endd
8346 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8347 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8348 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8349 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8350 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8351 .code
8352 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8353 .endd
8354 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8355 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8356 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8357 required.
8358 .endlist
8359
8360
8361
8362
8363 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8364 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8365 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8366 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8367 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8368 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8369
8370 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8371 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8372
8373 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8374 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8375 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8376 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8377 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8378 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8379 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8380 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8381 not recognized in an indirected file).
8382
8383 .ilist
8384 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8385 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8386 .code
8387 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8388 .endd
8389 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8390 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8391
8392 .next
8393 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8394 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8395 example:
8396 .code
8397 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8398 192.168.4.5
8399 .endd
8400 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8401 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8402 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8403 .endlist
8404
8405 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8406 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8407 list.
8408
8409 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8410 "SECTmixwilhos"
8411 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8412
8413 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8414 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8415 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8416
8417 .ilist
8418 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8419 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8420 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8421 .code
8422 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8423 .endd
8424 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8425 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8426 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8427 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8428 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8429 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8430 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8431
8432 .next
8433 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8434 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8435 .code
8436 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8437 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8438 .endd
8439 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8440 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8441 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8442 this section.
8443 .endlist
8444
8445
8446 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8447 "SECTtemdnserr"
8448 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8449 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8450 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8451 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8452 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8453 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8454 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8455 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8456 host lists such as whitelists.
8457
8458
8459
8460 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8461 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8462 .cindex "unknown host name"
8463 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8464 If a pattern is of the form
8465 .display
8466 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8467 .endd
8468 for example
8469 .code
8470 dbm;/host/accept/list
8471 .endd
8472 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8473 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8474 is not used.
8475
8476 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8477 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8478 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8479 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8480 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8481 lookup, both using the same file.
8482
8483
8484
8485 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8486 If a pattern is of the form
8487 .display
8488 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8489 .endd
8490 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8491 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8492 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8493 .code
8494 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8495 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8496 .endd
8497 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8498 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8499 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8500 operator.
8501
8502 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8503 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8504 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8505
8506 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8507 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8508 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8509 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8510 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8511 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8512
8513
8514
8515
8516
8517 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8518 .cindex "list" "address list"
8519 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8520 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8521 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8522 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8523 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8524 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8525 using this option setting:
8526 .code
8527 senders = :
8528 .endd
8529 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8530 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8531 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8532 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8533
8534 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8535 example:
8536 .code
8537 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8538 .endd
8539 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8540 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8541 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8542 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8543 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8544 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8545 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8546 .code
8547 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8548 *@+hostile_domains:\
8549 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8550 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8551 .endd
8552 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8553 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8554 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8555 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8556 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8557
8558 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8559 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8560 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8561 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8562 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8563 .code
8564 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8565 .endd
8566
8567 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8568 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8569 senders:
8570
8571 .ilist
8572 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8573 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8574 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8575 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8576 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8577 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8578 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8579 .code
8580 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8581 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8582 .endd
8583 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8584 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8585
8586 .next
8587 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8588 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8589 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8590 example:
8591 .code
8592 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8593 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8594 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8595 .endd
8596 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8597 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8598 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8599 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8600
8601 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8602 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8603 panic log.
8604 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8605 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8606 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8607 default. For example, with this lookup:
8608 .code
8609 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8610 .endd
8611 the file could contains lines like this:
8612 .code
8613 user1@domain1.example
8614 *@domain2.example
8615 .endd
8616 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8617 that are tried is:
8618 .code
8619 nimrod@jaeger.example
8620 *@jaeger.example
8621 *
8622 .endd
8623 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8624 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8625
8626 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8627 .code
8628 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8629 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8630 .endd
8631 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8632 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8633 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8634 .endlist
8635
8636
8637 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8638 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8639 always fails.
8640
8641
8642 .ilist
8643 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8644 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8645 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8646 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8647 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8648 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8649 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8650 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8651 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8652
8653 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8654 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8655 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8656 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8657 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8658 with
8659 .code
8660 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8661 .endd
8662 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8663 .code
8664 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8665 .endd
8666 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8667
8668 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8669 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8670 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8671 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8672 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8673 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8674 .code
8675 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8676 spammer3 : spammer4
8677 .endd
8678 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8679 doubling.
8680
8681 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8682 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8683 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8684 might have entries like
8685 .code
8686 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8687 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8688 *: ^\d{8}$
8689 .endd
8690 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8691 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8692 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8693 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8694
8695 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8696 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8697 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8698
8699 .next
8700 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8701 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8702 can only return a single list of local parts.
8703 .endlist
8704
8705 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8706 in these two examples:
8707 .code
8708 senders = +my_list
8709 senders = *@+my_list
8710 .endd
8711 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8712 example it is a named domain list.
8713
8714
8715
8716
8717 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8718 .cindex "case of local parts"
8719 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8720 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8721 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8722 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8723 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8724 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8725 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8726 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8727 default.
8728
8729 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8730 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8731 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8732 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8733 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8734 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8735 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8736 case-independent.
8737
8738 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8739 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8740 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8741 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8742 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8743 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8744 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8745 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8746
8747
8748
8749 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8750 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8751 .cindex "local part" "list"
8752 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8753 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8754 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8755 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8756 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8757 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8758 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8759 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8760
8761 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8762 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8763 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8764 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8765 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8766 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8767 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8768 types.
8769 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8770
8771
8772
8773
8774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8776
8777 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8778 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8779 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8780 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8781
8782 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8783 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8784 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8785 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8786 escape character, as described in the following section.
8787
8788 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8789 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8790 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8791 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8792 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8793 reasons.
8794
8795
8796
8797 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8798 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8799 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8800 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8801 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8802 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8803 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8804 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8805
8806 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8807 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8808 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8809 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8810 .code
8811 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8812 .endd
8813 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8814 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8815 string.
8816
8817
8818
8819 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8820 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8821 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8822 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8823 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8824 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8825 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8826 encoding.
8827
8828 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8829 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8830 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8831
8832
8833 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8834 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8835 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8836 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8837 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8838 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8839 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8840 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8841 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8842 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8843 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8844 and &%nhash%&.
8845
8846 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8847 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8848 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8849
8850 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8851 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8852 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8853 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8854 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8855 .code
8856 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8857 .endd
8858 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8859 Exim message identifier. For example:
8860 .code
8861 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8862 .endd
8863 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8864 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8865
8866
8867 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8868 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8869 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8870 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8871 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8872 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8873 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8874 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8875 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8876 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8877 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8878 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8879 being expanded.
8880
8881
8882
8883
8884 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8885 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8886 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8887 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8888 white space is significant.
8889
8890 .vlist
8891 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8892 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8893 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8894 .code
8895 $local_part
8896 ${domain}
8897 .endd
8898 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8899 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8900 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8901 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8902 given, the expansion fails.
8903
8904 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8905 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8906 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8907 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8908 .code
8909 ${lc:$local_part}
8910 .endd
8911 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8912 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8913 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8914 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8915 string easier to understand.
8916
8917 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8918 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8919 expansion item below.
8920
8921
8922 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8923 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8924 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8925 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8926 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8927 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8928 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8929 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8930 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8931 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8932 the result of the expansion.
8933 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8934 the expansion result is an empty string.
8935 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8936
8937
8938 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8939 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8940 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8941 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8942 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8943 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8944 The field name is expanded and used to retrive the relevant field from
8945 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8946 .display
8947 &`version `&
8948 &`serial_number `&
8949 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8950 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8951 &`notbefore `& time
8952 &`notafter `& time
8953 &`sig_algorithm `&
8954 &`signature `&
8955 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8956 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8957 &`crl_uri `& list
8958 .endd
8959 If the field is found,
8960 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8961 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8962 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8963 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8964
8965 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8966 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8967 extracted is used.
8968
8969 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8970
8971 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8972 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8973 not quite
8974 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8975 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8976 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8977 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8978 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8979 The separator may be changed by another modifer of
8980 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8981 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8982
8983 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8984 take an optional modifier of "int"
8985 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
8986 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
8987 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
8988
8989 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
8990 newline-separated by default,
8991 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
8992 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
8993 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8994
8995 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
8996 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
8997 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
8998 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
8999 if so the elenment tags are omitted.
9000
9001 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9002
9003 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9004 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9005 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9006 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9007 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9008 .code
9009 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9010 .endd
9011 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9012 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9013 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9014
9015 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9016 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9017 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9018 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9019 must have the following type:
9020 .code
9021 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9022 .endd
9023 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9024 function should return one of the following values:
9025
9026 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9027 into the expanded string that is being built.
9028
9029 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9030 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9031
9032 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9033 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9034
9035 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9036
9037 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9038 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9039 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9040
9041
9042 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9043 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9044 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9045 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9046 removed.
9047 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9048 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9049 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9050
9051 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9052 appear, for example:
9053 .code
9054 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9055 .endd
9056 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9057 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9058
9059 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9060 search failure.
9061 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9062 search success.
9063
9064
9065 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9066 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9067 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9068 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9069 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9070 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9071 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9072 form:
9073 .display
9074 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9075 .endd
9076 .vindex "&$value$&"
9077 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9078 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9079 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9080 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9081 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9082 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9083 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9084 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9085 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9086
9087 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9088 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9089 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9090 yield &"2001"&:
9091 .code
9092 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9093 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9094 .endd
9095 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9096 appear, for example:
9097 .code
9098 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9099 .endd
9100 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9101 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9102
9103
9104 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9105 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9106 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9107 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9108 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9109 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9110 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9111 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9112 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9113 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9114 <&'string3'&> as before.
9115
9116 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9117 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9118 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9119 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9120 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9121 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9122 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9123 provided. For example:
9124 .code
9125 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9126 .endd
9127 yields &"42"&, and
9128 .code
9129 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9130 .endd
9131 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9132 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9133
9134
9135 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9136 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9137 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9138 .vindex "&$item$&"
9139 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9140 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9141 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9142 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9143 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9144 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9145 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9146 .code
9147 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9148 .endd
9149 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9150 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9151
9152
9153 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9154 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9155 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9156 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9157 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9158 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9159
9160 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9161 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9162 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9163 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9164 .code
9165 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9166 .endd
9167 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9168 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9169 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9170 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9171 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9172 .code
9173 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9174 .endd
9175 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9176 letters appear. For example:
9177 .display
9178 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9179 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9180 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9181 .endd
9182
9183 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9184 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9185 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9186 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9187 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9188 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9189 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9190 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9191 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9192 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9193 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9194 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9195 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9196 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9197 .code
9198 $header_reply-to:
9199 .endd
9200 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9201 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9202 lines) may be present.
9203
9204 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9205 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9206
9207 .ilist
9208 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9209 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9210 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9211
9212 .next
9213 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9214 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9215 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9216 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9217 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9218 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9219 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9220 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9221
9222 .next
9223 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9224 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9225 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9226 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9227 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9228 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9229 .endlist ilist
9230
9231 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9232 command of the following form:
9233 .code
9234 headers charset "UTF-8"
9235 .endd
9236 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9237 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9238 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9239 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9240 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9241 ISO-8859-1.
9242
9243 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9244 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9245 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9246 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9247
9248 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9249 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9250 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9251 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9252 router or transport are not accessible.
9253
9254 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9255 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9256 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9257 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9258 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9259 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9260
9261 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9262 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9263 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9264 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9265 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9266 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9267 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9268
9269 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9270 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9271 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9272 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9273 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9274 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9275 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9276 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9277
9278
9279 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9280 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9281 .cindex &%hmac%&
9282 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9283 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9284 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9285 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9286 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9287 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9288 present. For example:
9289 .code
9290 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9291 .endd
9292 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9293 produces:
9294 .code
9295 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9296 .endd
9297 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9298 an Exim configuration:
9299 .code
9300 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9301 .endd
9302 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9303 .code
9304 headers_add = \
9305 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9306 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9307 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9308 .endd
9309 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9310 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9311 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9312 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9313 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9314 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9315
9316
9317 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9318 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9319 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9320 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9321 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9322 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9323 .code
9324 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9325 .endd
9326 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9327 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9328 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9329 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9330 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9331
9332 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9333 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9334 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9335 .code
9336 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9337 .endd
9338 you can use
9339 .code
9340 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9341 .endd
9342
9343 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9344 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9345 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9346 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9347 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9348 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9349 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9350 some of the braces:
9351 .code
9352 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9353 .endd
9354 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9355 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9356 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9357
9358
9359 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9360 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9361 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9362 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9363 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9364 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9365 apart from an optional leading minus,
9366 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9367
9368 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9369 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9370
9371 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9372 If the number is negative, the fields are
9373 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9374 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9375 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9376
9377 If the modulus of the
9378 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9379 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9380
9381 For example:
9382 .code
9383 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9384 .endd
9385 yields &"42"&, and
9386 .code
9387 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9388 .endd
9389 yields &"result: 99"&.
9390
9391 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9392 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9393 extracted is used.
9394 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9395
9396
9397 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9398 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9399 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9400 described in the next item.
9401
9402 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9403 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9404 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9405 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9406 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9407 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9408 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9409 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9410 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9411
9412 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9413 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9414 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9415 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9416 out by the system administrator.
9417
9418 .vindex "&$value$&"
9419 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9420 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9421 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9422 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9423 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9424 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9425 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9426 original lookup fails.
9427
9428 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9429 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9430 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9431 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9432 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9433 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9434 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9435 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9436
9437 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9438 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9439 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9440 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9441
9442 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9443 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9444 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9445 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9446
9447 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9448 .code
9449 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9450 .endd
9451 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9452 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9453 .code
9454 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9455 {$value}fail}
9456 .endd
9457
9458
9459 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9460 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9461 .vindex "&$item$&"
9462 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9463 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9464 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9465 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9466 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9467 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9468 .code
9469 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9470 .endd
9471 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9472 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9473 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9474
9475 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9476 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9477 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9478 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9479 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9480 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9481 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9482 .code
9483 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9484 .endd
9485 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9486 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9487 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9488 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9489 example,
9490 .code
9491 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9492 .endd
9493 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9494
9495
9496
9497 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9498 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9499 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9500 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9501 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9502 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9503 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9504 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9505
9506 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9507 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9508 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9509 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9510 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9511 not its contents.
9512
9513 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9514 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9515 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9516
9517 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9518 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9519
9520
9521 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9522 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9523 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9524 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9525 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9526 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9527 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9528 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9529
9530 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9531 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9532 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9533 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9534 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9535 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9536 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9537 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9538 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9539 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9540
9541 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9542 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9543 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9544 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9545
9546 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9547 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9548 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9549 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9550 is the expansion of the third argument.
9551
9552 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9553 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9554 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9555
9556 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9557 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9558 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9559 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9560 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9561 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9562 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9563 newlines are left in the string.
9564 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9565 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9566 the string expansion fails.
9567
9568 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9569 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9570
9571
9572
9573 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9574 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9575 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9576 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9577 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9578 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9579 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9580 examples:
9581 .code
9582 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9583 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9584 .endd
9585 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9586 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9587 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9588 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9589 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9590 example:
9591 .code
9592 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9593 .endd
9594 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9595 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9596 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9597 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9598 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9599 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9600 .code
9601 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9602 .endd
9603 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9604 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9605 turns them into spaces:
9606 .code
9607 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9608 .endd
9609 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9610 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9611 addition, the following errors can occur:
9612
9613 .ilist
9614 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9615 .next
9616 Failure to connect the socket;
9617 .next
9618 Failure to write the request string;
9619 .next
9620 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9621 .endlist
9622
9623 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9624 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9625 errors occurs. For example:
9626 .code
9627 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9628 {socket failure}}
9629 .endd
9630 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9631 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9632 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9633 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9634 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9635
9636 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9637 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9638
9639
9640 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9641 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9642 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9643 .vindex "&$value$&"
9644 .vindex "&$item$&"
9645 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9646 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9647 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9648 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9649 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9650 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9651 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9652 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9653 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9654 .code
9655 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9656 .endd
9657 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9658 can be found:
9659 .code
9660 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9661 .endd
9662 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9663 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9664 expansion items.
9665
9666 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9667 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9668 expansion item above.
9669
9670 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9671 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9672 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9673 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9674 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9675 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9676 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9677 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9678 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9679
9680 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9681 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9682 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9683 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9684 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9685 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9686 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9687 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9688 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9689 character.
9690
9691 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9692 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9693 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9694 .vindex "&$value$&"
9695 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9696 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9697 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9698 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9699 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9700 &$value$&.
9701
9702 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9703 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9704 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9705 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9706
9707 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9708 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9709 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9710 troubleshoot:
9711 .code
9712 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9713 log_message = Output of id: $value
9714 .endd
9715 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9716 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9717 .code
9718 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9719 .endd
9720
9721 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9722 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9723 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9724 .code
9725 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9726 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9727 ...
9728 endif
9729 .endd
9730 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9731 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9732 commands.
9733
9734 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9735 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9736 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9737 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9738
9739 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9740 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9741
9742
9743 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9744 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9745 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9746 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9747 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9748 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9749 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9750 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9751 .code
9752 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9753 .endd
9754 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9755 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9756 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9757 .code
9758 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9759 .endd
9760 yields &"defabc"&, and
9761 .code
9762 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9763 .endd
9764 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9765 the regular expression from string expansion.
9766
9767
9768
9769 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9770 .cindex sorting "a list"
9771 .cindex list sorting
9772 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9773 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9774 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9775 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9776 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9777 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9778 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9779 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9780 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9781 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9782 to give values for comparison.
9783
9784 The item result is a sorted list,
9785 with the original list separator,
9786 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9787
9788 Examples:
9789 .code
9790 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9791 .endd
9792 sorts a list of numbers, and
9793 .code
9794 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9795 .endd
9796 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9797
9798
9799 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9800 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9801 .cindex "substring extraction"
9802 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9803 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9804 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9805 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9806 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9807 .code
9808 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9809 .endd
9810 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9811 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9812 omitted.
9813
9814 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9815 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9816 length required. For example
9817 .code
9818 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9819 .endd
9820 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9821 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9822 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9823 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9824
9825 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9826 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9827 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9828 .code
9829 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9830 .endd
9831 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9832 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9833 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9834 .code
9835 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9836 .endd
9837 yields an empty string, but
9838 .code
9839 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9840 .endd
9841 yields &"1"&.
9842
9843 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9844 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9845 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9846 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9847 .code
9848 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9849 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9850 .endd
9851 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9852
9853
9854
9855 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9856 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9857 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9858 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9859 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9860 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9861 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9862 replacement list. For example
9863 .code
9864 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9865 .endd
9866 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9867 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9868 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9869 place.
9870 .endlist
9871
9872
9873
9874 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9875 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9876 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9877 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9878 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9879 following operations can be performed:
9880
9881 .vlist
9882 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9883 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9884 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9885 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9886 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9887 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9888
9889
9890 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9891 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9892 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9893 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9894 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9895 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9896 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9897 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9898 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9899
9900 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9901 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9902 character. For example:
9903 .code
9904 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9905 .endd
9906 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9907 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9908 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9909 processing lists.
9910
9911 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9912 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9913 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9914 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9915 .code
9916 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9917 .endd
9918 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9919 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9920 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9921 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9922 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9923 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9924 quoted.
9925 .code
9926 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9927 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9928 user@example.com
9929 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9930 Last:user@example.com
9931 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9932 user@example.com
9933 .endd
9934
9935 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9936 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9937 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9938 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9939 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9940 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9941 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9942 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9943 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9944
9945 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9946 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9947 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9948 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9949 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9950 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9951 string.
9952
9953
9954 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9955 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9956 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9957 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9958 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9959
9960
9961 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9962 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9963 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9964 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9965 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9966 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9967 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9968
9969
9970 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9971 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9972 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9973 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9974 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9975 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9976 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9977 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9978 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9979 C programming language):
9980 .table2 70pt 300pt
9981 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9982 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9983 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9984 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9985 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9986 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9987 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9988 .endtable
9989 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9990 space is permitted before or after operators.
9991
9992 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9993 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9994 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9995 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9996 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9997
9998 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9999 or 1024*1024*1024,
10000 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10001 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10002
10003 .display
10004 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10005 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10006 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10007 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10008 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10009 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10010 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10011 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10012 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10013 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10014 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10015 .endd
10016
10017 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10018 .code
10019 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10020 condition = \
10021 ${if and { \
10022 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10023 { \
10024 < \
10025 {$recipients_count} \
10026 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10027 } \
10028 }{yes}{no}}
10029 .endd
10030 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10031 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10032
10033
10034 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10035 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10036 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10037 example,
10038 .code
10039 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10040 .endd
10041 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10042 and then re-expands what it has found.
10043
10044
10045 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10046 .cindex "Unicode"
10047 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10048 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10049 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10050 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10051 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10052 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10053 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10054 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10055 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10056
10057 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10058 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10059 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10060 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10061 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10062 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10063 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10064
10065
10066 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10067 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10068 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10069 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10070 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10071 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10072 .code
10073 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10074 .endd
10075 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10076 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10077
10078
10079
10080 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10081 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10082 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10083 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10084 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10085 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10086
10087
10088
10089 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10090 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10091 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10092 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10093 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10094 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10095 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10096
10097
10098 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10099 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10100 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10101 .cindex "lower casing"
10102 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10103 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10104 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10105 .code
10106 ${lc:$local_part}
10107 .endd
10108
10109 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10110 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10111 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10112 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10113 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10114 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10115 .code
10116 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10117 .endd
10118 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10119 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10120 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10121
10122
10123 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10124 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10125 .cindex "list" "item count"
10126 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10127 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10128 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10129
10130
10131 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10132 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10133 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10134 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10135 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10136 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10137 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10138 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10139 matching list is returned.
10140
10141
10142 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10143 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10144 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10145 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10146 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10147 empty.
10148
10149
10150 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10151 .cindex "masked IP address"
10152 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10153 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10154 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10155 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10156 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10157 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10158 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10159 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10160 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10161 .code
10162 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10163 .endd
10164 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10165 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10166 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10167 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10168 .code
10169 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10170 .endd
10171 returns the string
10172 .code
10173 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10174 .endd
10175 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10176
10177
10178 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10179 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10180 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10181 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10182 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10183 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10184 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10185
10186
10187 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10188 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10189 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10190 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10191 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10192 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10193 .code
10194 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10195 .endd
10196 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10197
10198
10199 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10200 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10201 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10202 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10203 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10204 is an empty string or
10205 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10206 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10207 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10208 respectively For example,
10209 .code
10210 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10211 .endd
10212 becomes
10213 .code
10214 "ab\"*\"cd"
10215 .endd
10216 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10217 variable or a message header.
10218
10219 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10220 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10221 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10222 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10223 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10224 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10225 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10226
10227
10228 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10229 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10230 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10231 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10232 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10233 .code
10234 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10235 .endd
10236 returns
10237 .code
10238 two%20%5C2A%20two
10239 .endd
10240 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10241 yields an unchanged string.
10242
10243
10244 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10245 .cindex "random number"
10246 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10247 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10248 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10249 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10250 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10251 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10252 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10253 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10254 random().
10255
10256
10257 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10258 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10259 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10260 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10261 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10262 for DNS. For example,
10263 .code
10264 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10265 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10266 .endd
10267 returns
10268 .code
10269 4.2.0.192
10270 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10271 .endd
10272
10273
10274 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10275 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10276 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10277 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10278 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10279 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10280 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10281 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10282 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10283 characters
10284 .code
10285 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10286 .endd
10287 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10288 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10289 characters.
10290
10291
10292 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10293 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10294 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10295 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10296 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10297 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10298 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10299 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10300
10301 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10302 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10303 to use this operator as well.
10304
10305
10306
10307 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10308 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10309 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10310 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10311 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10312 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10313 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10314
10315
10316 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10317 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10318 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10319 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10320 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10321 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10322 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10323
10324
10325 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10326 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10327 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10328 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10329 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10330 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10331 certificate,
10332 and returns
10333 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10334 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10335
10336
10337 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10338 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10339 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10340 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10341 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10342 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10343 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10344 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10345 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10346 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10347 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10348 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10349 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10350
10351 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10352 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10353 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10354
10355 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10356 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10357 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10358 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10359 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10360
10361
10362
10363 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10364 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10365 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10366 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10367 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10368 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10369
10370
10371 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10372 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10373 .cindex "substring extraction"
10374 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10375 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10376 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10377 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10378 .code
10379 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10380 .endd
10381 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10382 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10383
10384 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10385 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10386 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10387 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10388 seconds.
10389
10390 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10391 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10392 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10393 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10394 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10395 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10396 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10397
10398 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10399 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10400 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10401 .cindex "upper casing"
10402 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10403 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10404 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10405
10406 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10407 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10408 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10409 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10410 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10411 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10412 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10413 .endlist
10414
10415
10416
10417
10418
10419
10420 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10421 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10422 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10423 while expanding strings:
10424
10425 .vlist
10426 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10427 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10428 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10429 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10430 condition.
10431
10432 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10434 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10435 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10436 are:
10437 .display
10438 &`= `& equal
10439 &`== `& equal
10440 &`> `& greater
10441 &`>= `& greater or equal
10442 &`< `& less
10443 &`<= `& less or equal
10444 .endd
10445 For example:
10446 .code
10447 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10448 .endd
10449 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10450 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10451 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10452 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10453 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10454 zero.
10455
10456 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10457 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10458 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10459
10460
10461 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10462 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10463 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10464 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10465 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10466 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10467 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10468 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10469 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10470 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10471 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10472 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10473 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10474 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10475
10476 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10477 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10478 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10479 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10480 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10481 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10482 false if zero.
10483 An empty string is treated as false.
10484 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10485 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10486 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10487
10488 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10489 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10490 For example:
10491 .code
10492 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10493 .endd
10494
10495
10496 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10497 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10498 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10499 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10500 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10501 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10502 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10503 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10504
10505 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10506
10507 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10508 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10509 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10510 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10511 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10512 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10513 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10514 included in the binary.
10515
10516 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10517 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10518 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10519 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10520 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10521 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10522 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10523 string in LDAP form is:
10524 .code
10525 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10526 .endd
10527 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10528 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10529 .code
10530 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10531 .endd
10532 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10533 supported:
10534
10535 .ilist
10536 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10537 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10538 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10539 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10540 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10541 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10542 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10543 comparison fails.
10544
10545 .next
10546 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10547 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10548 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10549 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10550 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10551 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10552
10553 .next
10554 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10555 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10556 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10557 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10558 whatever its length.
10559
10560 .next
10561 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10562 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10563 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10564 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10565 .endlist
10566 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10567 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10568 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10569 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10570 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10571 support &[crypt16()]&.
10572
10573 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10574 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10575 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10576 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10577 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10578
10579 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10580 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10581 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10582
10583 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10584 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10585 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10586 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10587 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10588
10589 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10590 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10591 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10592 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10593 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10594 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10595 .code
10596 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10597 .endd
10598 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10599 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10600
10601 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10602 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10603 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10604 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10605 exists in the message. For example,
10606 .code
10607 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10608 .endd
10609 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10610 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10611
10612 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10613 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10614 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10615 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10616 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10617 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10618 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10619 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10620 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10621
10622 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10623 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10624 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10625 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10626 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10627 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10628 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10629 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10630
10631 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10632 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10633 .cindex "first delivery"
10634 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10635 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10636 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10637 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10638
10639
10640 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10641 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10642 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10643 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10644 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10645 .vindex "&$item$&"
10646 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10647 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10648 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10649 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10650 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10651 .ilist
10652 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10653 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10654 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10655 .next
10656 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10657 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10658 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10659 .endlist
10660 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10661 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10662 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10663 list separator is changed to a comma:
10664 .code
10665 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10666 .endd
10667 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10668 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10669
10670 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10671
10672
10673 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10674 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10675 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10676 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10677 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10678 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10679 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10680 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10681 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10682 case-independent.
10683
10684 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10685 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10686 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10687 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10688 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10689 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10690 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10691 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10692 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10693 case-independent.
10694
10695 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10696 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10697 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10698 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10699 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10700 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10701 is true.
10702
10703 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10704 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10705 .code
10706 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10707 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10708 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10709 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10710 .endd
10711
10712 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10713 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10714 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10715 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10716 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10717 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10718 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10719 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10720 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10721 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10722 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10723
10724 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10725 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10726 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10727 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10728 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10729
10730 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10731 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10732 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10733 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10734 .code
10735 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10736 .endd
10737 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10738
10739 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10740 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10741 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10742 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10743 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10744 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10745 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10746 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10747 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10748 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10749 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10750 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10751 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10752 this can be used.
10753
10754
10755 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10756 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10757 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10758 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10759 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10760 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10761 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10762 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10763 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10764 case-independent.
10765
10766 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10767 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10768 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10769 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10770 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10771 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10772 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10773 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10774 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10775 case-independent.
10776
10777
10778 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10779 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10780 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10781 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10782 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10783 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10784 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10785 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10786 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10787 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10788 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10789 For example,
10790 .code
10791 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10792 .endd
10793 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10794 backslashes is also required.
10795
10796 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10797 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10798 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10799 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10800 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10801 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10802
10803 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10804 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10805 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10806 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10807 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10808 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10809 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10810 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10811
10812 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10813 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10814 See &*match_local_part*&.
10815
10816 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10817 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10818 See &*match_local_part*&.
10819
10820 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10821 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10822 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10823 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10824 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10825 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10826 .code
10827 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10828 .endd
10829 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10830
10831 .ilist
10832 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10833 .next
10834 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10835 .next
10836 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10837 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10838 in a single test such as
10839 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10840 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10841 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10842 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10843 .code
10844 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10845 .endd
10846 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10847 .next
10848 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10849 .next
10850 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10851 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10852 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10853 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10854 masks. For example:
10855 .code
10856 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10857 .endd
10858 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10859 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10860 address mask, for example:
10861 .code
10862 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10863 .endd
10864 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10865 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10866 .code
10867 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10868 .endd
10869 .endlist ilist
10870
10871 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10872 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10873
10874 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10875
10876 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10877 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10878 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10879 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10880 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10881 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10882 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10883 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10884 example is:
10885 .code
10886 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10887 .endd
10888 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10889 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10890 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10891 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10892 .code
10893 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10894 .endd
10895 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10896 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10897 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10898 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10899 caselessly.
10900
10901 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10902 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10903
10904 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10905 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10906 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10907 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10908
10909 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10910 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10911 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10912 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10913 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10914 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10915 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10916 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10917 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10918 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10919 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10920 .code
10921 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10922 .endd
10923 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10924 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10925
10926 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10927 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10928 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10929 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10930 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10931 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10932 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10933
10934 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10935 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10936 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10937 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10938 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10939 .code
10940 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10941 .endd
10942 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10943 .code
10944 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10945 .endd
10946 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10947 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10948 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10949 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10950 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10951 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10952 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10953 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10954
10955
10956 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10957 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10958 .cindex "Cyrus"
10959 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10960 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10961 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10962 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10963 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10964 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10965
10966 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10967 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10968 building Exim. For example:
10969 .code
10970 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10971 .endd
10972 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10973 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10974 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10975 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10976
10977 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10978 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10979 configuration, you might have this:
10980 .code
10981 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10982 .endd
10983 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10984 .code
10985 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10986 .endd
10987 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10988 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10989 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10990 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10991 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10992 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10993
10994
10995 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10996 .cindex "Radius"
10997 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10998 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10999 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11000 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11001 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11002 support.
11003
11004 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11005 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11006 this library, you need to set
11007 .code
11008 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11009 .endd
11010 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11011 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11012 .code
11013 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11014 .endd
11015 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11016 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11017 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11018
11019 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11020 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11021 the authentication is successful. For example:
11022 .code
11023 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11024 .endd
11025
11026
11027 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11028 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11029 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11030 .cindex "Cyrus"
11031 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11032 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11033 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11034 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11035 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11036 by a process that is not running as root.
11037
11038 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11039 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11040 building Exim. For example:
11041 .code
11042 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11043 .endd
11044 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11045 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11046 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11047
11048 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11049 two are mandatory. For example:
11050 .code
11051 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11052 .endd
11053 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11054 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11055 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11056 .endlist vlist
11057
11058
11059
11060 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11061 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11062 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11063 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11064 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11065 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11066 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11067
11068
11069 .vlist
11070 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11071 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11072 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11073 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11074 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11075 For example,
11076 .code
11077 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11078 .endd
11079 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11080 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11081 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11082
11083 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11084 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11085 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11086 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11087 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11088 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11089 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11090 parsed but not evaluated.
11091 .endlist
11092 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11093
11094
11095
11096
11097 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11098 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11099 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11100 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11101 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11102
11103 .vlist
11104 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11105 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11106 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11107 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11108 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11109 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11110 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11111 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11112 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11113 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11114 matching condition.
11115
11116 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11117 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11118 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11119 any unused variables being made empty.
11120
11121 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11122 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11123 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11124 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11125 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11126 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11127 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11128 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11129 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11130 during subsequent delivery.
11131
11132 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11133 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11134 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11135 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11136 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11137 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11138 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11139 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11140 delivery.
11141
11142 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11143 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11144 this variable has the number of arguments.
11145
11146 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11147 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11148 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11149 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11150 be preserved by coding like this:
11151 .code
11152 warn !verify = sender
11153 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11154 .endd
11155 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11156 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11157 failure.
11158
11159 .vitem &$address_data$&
11160 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11161 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11162 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11163 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11164 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11165 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11166 user filter files.
11167
11168 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11169 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11170 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11171 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11172 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11173 from the child's routing.
11174
11175 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11176 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11177 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11178 address.
11179
11180 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11181 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11182 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11183
11184 .vitem &$address_file$&
11185 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11186 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11187 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11188 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11189 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11190 .code
11191 /home/r2d2/savemail
11192 .endd
11193 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11194 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11195 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11196 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11197 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11198 to the relevant file.
11199
11200 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11201 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11202 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11203 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11204
11205 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11206 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11207 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11208 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11209
11210 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11211 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11212 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11213 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11214 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11215 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11216 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11217 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11218 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11219 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11220 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11221 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11222 command line option.
11223
11224 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11225 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11226 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11227 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11228 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11229 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11230 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11231 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11232 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11233 the ACL's as well.
11234
11235
11236 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11237 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11238 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11239 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11240 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11241 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11242 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11243 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11244 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11245 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11246 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11247
11248 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11249 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11250 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11251 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11252 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11253
11254
11255 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11256 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11257 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11258 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11259 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11260 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11261 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11262 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11263 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11264 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11265 an undefined mechanism.
11266
11267 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11268 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11269 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11270 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11271 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11272 the ACL malware condition.
11273
11274 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11275 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11276 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11277 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11278 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11279 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11280
11281 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11282 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11283 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11284 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11285 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11286 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11287 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11288
11289 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11290 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11291 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11292 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11293 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11294
11295 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11296 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11297 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11298 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11299 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11300
11301 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11302 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11303 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11304 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11305 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11306 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11307 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11308
11309 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11310 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11311 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11312 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11313 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11314 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11315 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11316
11317 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11318 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11319 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11320
11321 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11322 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11323 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11324 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11325 compilations of the same version of the program.
11326
11327 .new
11328 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11329 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11330 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11331 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11332 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11333 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11334
11335 .vitem &$config_file$&
11336 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11337 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11338 .wen
11339
11340 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11341 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11342 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11343 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11344 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11345
11346 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11347 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11348 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11349 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11350 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11351
11352 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11353 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11354 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11355 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11356 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11357 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11358 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11359 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11360 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11361 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11362 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11363 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11364 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11365 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11366 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11367 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11368 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11369 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11370 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11371 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11372 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11373
11374 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11375 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11376 When a message has been received this variable contains
11377 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11378 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11379
11380 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11381 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11382 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11383 &$dnslist_value$&
11384 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11385 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11386 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11387 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11388 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11389 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11390 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11391 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11392 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11393
11394 .vitem &$domain$&
11395 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11396 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11397 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11398 case for &$domain$&.
11399
11400 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11401 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11402 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11403 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11404
11405 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11406 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11407 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11408 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11409 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11410 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11411
11412 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11413 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11414 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11415
11416 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11417
11418 .ilist
11419 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11420 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11421 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11422 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11423 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11424 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11425 the &(smtp)& transport.
11426
11427 .next
11428 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11429 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11430 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11431 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11432
11433 .next
11434 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11435 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11436 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11437 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11438 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11439 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11440
11441 .next
11442 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11443 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11444 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11445 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11446 .endlist
11447
11448
11449 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11450 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11451 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11452 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11453 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11454 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11455 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11456 used.
11457
11458 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11459 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11460 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11461 to nothing.
11462
11463 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11464 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11465 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11466
11467 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11468 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11469 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11470
11471 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11472 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11473 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11474
11475 .new
11476 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11477 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11478 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11479 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11480 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11481 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11482 .wen
11483
11484 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11485 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11486 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11487 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11488 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11489
11490 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11491 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11492 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11493 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11494 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11495
11496 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11497 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11498 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11499 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11500 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11501
11502 .vitem &$home$&
11503 .vindex "&$home$&"
11504 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11505 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11506 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11507 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11508 by a setting on the transport itself.
11509
11510 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11511 of the environment variable HOME.
11512
11513 .vitem &$host$&
11514 .vindex "&$host$&"
11515 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11516 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11517 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11518 to local and remote transports.
11519
11520 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11521 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11522 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11523 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11524 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11525 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11526 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11527 is connected.
11528
11529 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11530 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11531 client is connected.
11532
11533
11534 .vitem &$host_address$&
11535 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11536 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11537 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11538 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11539
11540 .vitem &$host_data$&
11541 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11542 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11543 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11544 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11545 .code
11546 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11547 message = $host_data
11548 .endd
11549 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11550 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11551 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11552 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11553 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11554 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11555 variables is set to &"1"&.
11556
11557 .ilist
11558 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11559 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11560
11561 .next
11562 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11563 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11564 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11565 .endlist ilist
11566
11567 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11568 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11569 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11570 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11571 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11572 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11573 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11574 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11575 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11576 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11577
11578 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11579 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11580 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11581
11582 .vitem &$host_port$&
11583 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11584 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11585 for an outbound connection.
11586
11587
11588 .vitem &$inode$&
11589 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11590 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11591 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11592 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11593 a unique name for the file.
11594
11595 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11596 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11597 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11598
11599 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11600 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11601 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11602
11603 .vitem &$item$&
11604 .vindex "&$item$&"
11605 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11606 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11607 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11608 empty.
11609
11610 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11611 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11612 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11613 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11614 lookup.
11615
11616 .vitem &$load_average$&
11617 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11618 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11619 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11620 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11621
11622 .vitem &$local_part$&
11623 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11624 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11625 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11626 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11627 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11628
11629 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11630 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11631 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11632 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11633 once.
11634
11635 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11636 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11637 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11638 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11639 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11640 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11641
11642 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11643 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11644 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11645 &$address_pipe$&).
11646
11647 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11648 local part of the recipient address.
11649
11650 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11651 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11652 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11653
11654 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11655 the addresses
11656 .code
11657 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11658 abc\:xyz@test.example
11659 .endd
11660 the value of &$local_part$& is
11661 .code
11662 abc:xyz
11663 .endd
11664 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11665 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11666 have:
11667 .code
11668 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11669 .endd
11670 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11671 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11672 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11673
11674 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11675 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11676 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11677 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11678 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11679 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11680 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11681
11682 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11683 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11684 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11685 variable expands to nothing.
11686
11687 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11688 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11689 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11690 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11691 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11692
11693 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11694 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11695 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11696 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11697 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11698
11699 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11700 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11701 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11702 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11703
11704 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11705 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11706 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11707
11708 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11709 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11710 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11711 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11712 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11713 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11714 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11715 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11716
11717 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11718 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11719 This contains the expanded value of the
11720 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11721 been read.
11722
11723 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11724 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11725 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11726 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11727 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11728 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11729
11730 .vitem &$log_space$&
11731 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11732 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11733 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11734 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11735 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11736 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11737
11738
11739 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11740 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11741 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11742 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11743 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11744 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11745 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11746 and &"yes"& if it was.
11747
11748 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11749 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11750 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11751 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11752 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11753 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11754 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11755 variable is empty.
11756
11757 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11758 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11759 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11760 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11761 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11762
11763 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11764 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11765 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11766 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11767 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11768 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11769 character(s).
11770
11771 .vitem &$message_age$&
11772 .cindex "message" "age of"
11773 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11774 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11775 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11776 delivery attempt.
11777
11778 .vitem &$message_body$&
11779 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11780 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11781 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11782 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11783 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11784 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11785 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11786 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11787 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11788
11789 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11790 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11791 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11792 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11793 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11794
11795 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11796 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11797 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11798 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11799 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11800 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11801 &$message_body$&.
11802
11803 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11804 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11805 .cindex "message body" "size"
11806 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11807 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11808 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11809 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11810 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11811
11812 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11813 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11814 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11815 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11816 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11817 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11818 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11819 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11820
11821 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11822 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11823 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11824 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11825 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11826 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11827
11828 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11829 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11830 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11831 contents of header lines is done.
11832
11833 .vitem &$message_id$&
11834 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11835
11836 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11837 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11838 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11839 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11840 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11841 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11842 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11843 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11844 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11845 from the body is not counted.
11846
11847 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11848 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11849 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11850 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11851 header and the body).
11852
11853 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11854 .code
11855 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11856 condition = \
11857 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11858 .endd
11859 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11860 message has not yet been received.
11861
11862 .vitem &$message_size$&
11863 .cindex "size" "of message"
11864 .cindex "message" "size"
11865 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11866 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11867 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11868 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11869 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11870 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11871 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11872 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11873 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11874
11875 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11876 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11877 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11878 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11879
11880 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11881 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11882 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11883 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11884
11885 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11886 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11887 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11888
11889 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11890 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11891 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11892 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11893 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11894 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11895 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11896 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11897 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11898 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11899
11900 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11901 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11902 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11903
11904 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11905 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11906 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11907 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11908 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11909 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11910 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11911 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11912 the original address.
11913
11914 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11915 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11916 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11917 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11918 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11919
11920 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11921 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11922 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11923
11924 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11925 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11926 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11927 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11928 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11929 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11930 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11931 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11932 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11933
11934 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11935 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11936 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11937 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11938 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11939 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11940 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11941 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11942 user.
11943
11944 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11945 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11946 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11947 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11948
11949 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11950 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11951 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11952 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11953
11954 .vitem &$pid$&
11955 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11956 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11957 This variable contains the current process id.
11958
11959 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11960 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11961 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11962 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11963 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11964 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11965 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11966 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11967 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11968 variable"& error if encountered.
11969
11970 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11971 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11972 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11973 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11974 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11975 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11976 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11977
11978
11979 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11980 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11981 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11982 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11983
11984 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11985 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11986 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11987 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11988
11989 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11990 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11991 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11992 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11993
11994 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11995 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11996 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11997
11998 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11999 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12000 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12001 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12002
12003 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12004 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12005 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12006 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12007 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12008
12009 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12010 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12011 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12012 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12013 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12014 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12015
12016 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12017 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12018 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12019 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12020 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12021
12022 .vitem &$received_count$&
12023 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12024 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12025 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12026 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12027 delivering.
12028
12029 .vitem &$received_for$&
12030 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12031 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12032 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12033 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12034 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12035
12036 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12037 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12038 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12039 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12040 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12041 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12042 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12043 option.
12044
12045 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12046 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12047 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12048 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12049 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12050 time.
12051 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12052
12053 .vitem &$received_port$&
12054 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12055 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12056
12057 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12058 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12059 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12060 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12061 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12062 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12063 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12064 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12065 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12066
12067 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12068 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12069 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12070 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12071 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12072 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12073
12074 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12075 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12076 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12077
12078 .vitem &$received_time$&
12079 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12080 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12081 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12082
12083 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12084 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12085 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12086 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12087 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12088 .display
12089 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12090 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12091 .endd
12092 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12093 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12094 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12095 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12096
12097 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12098 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12099 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12100 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12101
12102 .ilist
12103 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12104 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12105
12106 .next
12107 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12108
12109 .next
12110 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12111 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12112 MAIL).
12113
12114 .next
12115 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12116 .next
12117
12118 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12119 .endlist
12120
12121 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12122 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12123
12124 .vitem &$recipients$&
12125 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12126 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12127 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12128 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12129 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12130 cases:
12131
12132 .olist
12133 In a system filter file.
12134 .next
12135 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12136 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12137 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12138 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12139 .next
12140 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12141 .endlist
12142
12143
12144 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12145 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12146 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12147 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12148 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12149 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12150
12151
12152 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12153 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12154 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12155 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12156
12157
12158 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12159 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12160 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12161 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12162 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12163 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12164 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12165
12166 .vitem &$return_path$&
12167 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12168 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12169 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12170 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12171 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12172 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12173 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12174 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12175 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12176 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12177 envelope sender.
12178
12179 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12180 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12181 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12182
12183 .vitem &$router_name$&
12184 .cindex "router" "name"
12185 .cindex "name" "of router"
12186 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12187 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12188
12189 .vitem &$runrc$&
12190 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12191 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12192 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12193 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12194 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12195 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12196 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12197 another.
12198
12199 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12200 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12201 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12202 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12203 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12204 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12205 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12206 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12207
12208 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12209 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12210 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12211 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12212 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12213 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12214
12215 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12216 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12217 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12218 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12219 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12220 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12221 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12222 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12223
12224 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12225 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12226 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12227
12228 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12229 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12230 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12231
12232 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12233 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12234 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12235 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12236 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12237 this:
12238 .display
12239 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12240 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12241 .endd
12242 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12243 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12244 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12245 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12246
12247 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12248 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12249 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12250 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12251 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12252 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12253 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12254 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12255 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12256 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12257 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12258 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12259 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12260
12261 .new
12262 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12263 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12264 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12265 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12266 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticatied data.
12267 .wen
12268
12269 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12270 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12271 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12272 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12273 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12274 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12275
12276 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12277 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12278 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12279 this variable contains that
12280 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12281
12282 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12283 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12284 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12285 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12286 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12287 &$authenticated_id$&.
12288
12289 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12290 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12291 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12292 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12293 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12294 resolver library states that both
12295 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12296 other times, this variable is false.
12297
12298 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12299 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12300 library, by setting:
12301 .code
12302 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12303 .endd
12304
12305 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12306 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12307
12308 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12309 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12310
12311
12312 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12313 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12314 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12315 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12316 other means, this variable is empty.
12317
12318 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12319 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12320 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12321 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12322 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12323 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12324 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12325
12326 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12327 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12328 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12329 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12330
12331 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12332 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12333 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12334 is set to &"1"&.
12335
12336 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12337 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12338 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12339 following are true:
12340
12341 .ilist
12342 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12343 .next
12344 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12345 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12346 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12347 .next
12348 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12349 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12350 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12351 .next
12352 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12353 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12354 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12355 .next
12356 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12357 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12358 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12359 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12360 .code
12361 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12362 .endd
12363 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12364 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12365 .endlist
12366
12367
12368 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12369 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12370 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12371 number that was used on the remote host.
12372
12373 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12374 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12375 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12376 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12377 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12378 called Exim.
12379
12380 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12381 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12382 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12383 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12384
12385 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12386 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12387 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12388 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12389 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12390 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12391 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12392 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12393 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12394 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12395 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12396 the parentheses.
12397
12398 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12399 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12400 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12401 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12402 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12403
12404 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12405 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12406 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12407 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12408 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12409
12410 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12411 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12412 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12413 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12414 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12415 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12416 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12417
12418 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12419 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12420 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12421 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12422 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12423
12424 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12425 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12426 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12427 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12428 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12429 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12430
12431 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12432 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12433 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12434 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12435 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12436 .code
12437 MAIL FROM:<>
12438 MAIL FROM: <>
12439 .endd
12440 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12441 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12442 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12443 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12444
12445 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12446 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12447 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12448 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12449 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12450 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12451 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12452
12453 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12454 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12455 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12456 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12457 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12458 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12459 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12460 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12461 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12462 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12463 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12464
12465 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12466 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12467 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12468 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12469 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12470 message is junk mail.
12471
12472 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12473 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12474 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12475 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12476
12477
12478 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12479 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12480 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12481
12482 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12483 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12484 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12485 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12486 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12487 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12488
12489 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12490 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12491 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12492 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12493 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12494 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12495 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12496 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12497 .code
12498 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12499 .endd
12500 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12501
12502
12503 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12504 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12505 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12506 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12507 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12508 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12509
12510 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12511 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12512 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12513 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12514 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12515 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12516 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12517 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12518
12519 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12520 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12521 the outbound.
12522
12523 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12524 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12525 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12526 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12527 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12528 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12529
12530 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12531 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12532 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12533 inbound connection when the message was received.
12534 It is only useful as the argument of a
12535 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12536 or a &%def%& condition.
12537
12538 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12539 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12540 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12541 inbound connection when the message was received.
12542 It is only useful as the argument of a
12543 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12544 or a &%def%& condition.
12545 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12546 which is not the leaf.
12547
12548 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12549 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12550 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12551 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12552 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12553 or a &%def%& condition.
12554
12555 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12556 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12557 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12558 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12559 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12560 or a &%def%& condition.
12561 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12562 which is not the leaf.
12563
12564 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12565 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12566 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12567 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12568
12569 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12570 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12571 the outbound.
12572
12573 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12574 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12575 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12576 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12577 and &"0"& otherwise.
12578
12579 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12580 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12581 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12582 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12583 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12584 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12585 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12586 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12587 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12588
12589 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12590 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12591 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12592
12593 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12594 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12595 This variable is
12596 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12597 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12598 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12599 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12600
12601 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12602 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12603 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12604 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12605 .code
12606 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12607 1 No response to request
12608 2 Response not verified
12609 3 Verification failed
12610 4 Verification succeeded
12611 .endd
12612
12613 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12614 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12615 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12616 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12617 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12618
12619 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12620 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12621 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12622 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12623 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12624 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12625 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12626 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12627 which is not the leaf.
12628
12629 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12630 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12631 the outbound.
12632
12633 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12634 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12635 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12636 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12637 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12638 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12639 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12640 which is not the leaf.
12641
12642 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12643 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12644 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12645 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12646 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12647 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12648 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12649 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12650 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12651 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12652 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12653
12654 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12655 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12656 the outbound.
12657
12658 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12659 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12660 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12661 During outbound
12662 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12663 the transport.
12664
12665 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12666 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12667 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12668 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12669
12670 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12671 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12672 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12673
12674 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12675 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12676 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12677
12678 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12679 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12680 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12681 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12682 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12683 values for those that are behind (west).
12684
12685 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12686 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12687 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12688 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12689
12690 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12691 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12692 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12693 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12694 flag.
12695
12696 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12697 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12698 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12699 -0500.
12700
12701 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12702 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12703 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12704 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12705
12706 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12707 .cindex "transport" "name"
12708 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12709 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12710 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12711
12712 .vitem &$value$&
12713 .vindex "&$value$&"
12714 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12715 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12716 &*reduce*& expansion.
12717
12718 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12719 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12720 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12721 or for cutthrough delivery,
12722 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12723 Otherwise, empty.
12724
12725 .vitem &$version_number$&
12726 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12727 The version number of Exim.
12728
12729 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12730 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12731 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12732 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12733
12734 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12735 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12736 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12737 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12738 .endlist
12739 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12740
12741
12742
12743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12745
12746 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12747 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12748 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12749 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12750 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12751 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12752 the line
12753 .code
12754 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12755 .endd
12756 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12757
12758
12759 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12760 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12761 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12762 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12763 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12764 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12765 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12766 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12767 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12768
12769 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12770 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12771 should usually be something like
12772 .code
12773 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12774 .endd
12775 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12776 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12777 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12778 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12779 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12780 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12781 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12782 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12783 two ways:
12784
12785 .ilist
12786 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12787 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12788 a startup when Exim is entered.
12789 .next
12790 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12791 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12792 .endlist
12793
12794 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12795 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12796
12797
12798 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12799 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12800 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12801 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12802 forms:
12803 .code
12804 ${perl{foo}}
12805 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12806 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12807 .endd
12808 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12809 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12810 with an error message of the form
12811 .code
12812 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12813 .endd
12814 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12815 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12816 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12817 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12818 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12819 that was passed to &%die%&.
12820
12821
12822 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12823 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12824 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12825 the Perl code
12826 .code
12827 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12828 .endd
12829 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12830 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12831 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12832
12833 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12834 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12835 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12836 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12837
12838 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12839 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12840 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12841 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12842 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12843 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12844 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12845
12846
12847 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12848 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12849 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12850 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12851 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12852 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12853 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12854 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12855 avoided, but the output is lost.
12856
12857 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12858 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12859 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12860 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12861 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12862 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12863 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12864 .code
12865 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12866 .endd
12867 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12868 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12869 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12870 as the first subroutine argument.
12871 .ecindex IIDperl
12872
12873
12874 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12875 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12876
12877 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12878 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12879 "Starting the daemon"
12880 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12881 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12882 .cindex "network interface"
12883 .cindex "interface" "network"
12884 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12885 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12886 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12887 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12888 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12889 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12890 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12891 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12892 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12893 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12894 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12895
12896 .olist
12897 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12898 and ports to listen on.
12899 .next
12900 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12901 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12902 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12903 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12904 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12905 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12906 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12907 as an error situation.
12908 .next
12909 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12910 for the outgoing connection.
12911 .endlist
12912
12913
12914 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12915 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12916 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12917 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12918 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12919
12920 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12921 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12922 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12923 chapter describes how they operate.
12924
12925 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12926 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12927
12928
12929
12930 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12931 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12932 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12933 following options:
12934
12935 .ilist
12936 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12937 or service names.
12938 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12939 .next
12940 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12941 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12942 .endlist
12943
12944 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12945 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12946 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12947 colons. For example:
12948 .code
12949 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12950 192.168.23.65 ; \
12951 ::1 ; \
12952 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12953 .endd
12954 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12955 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12956
12957 .olist
12958 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12959 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12960 .code
12961 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12962 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12963 .endd
12964 .next
12965 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12966 with a colon separator, for example:
12967 .code
12968 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12969 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12970 .endd
12971 .endlist
12972
12973 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12974 default setting contains just one port:
12975 .code
12976 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12977 .endd
12978 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12979 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12980 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12981 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12982 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12983
12984
12985
12986 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12987 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12988 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12989 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12990 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12991 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12992 .code
12993 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12994 .endd
12995 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12996 .code
12997 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12998 .endd
12999 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13000
13001
13002
13003 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13004 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13005 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13006 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13007 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13008 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13009 exim.
13010
13011 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13012 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13013 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13014 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13015 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13016 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13017 .code
13018 -oX 1225
13019 .endd
13020 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13021 whereas
13022 .code
13023 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13024 .endd
13025 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13026 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13027 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13028
13029
13030
13031 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13032 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13033 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13034 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13035 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13036 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13037 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13038 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13039 list of port numbers or service names,
13040 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13041 common use of this option is expected to be
13042 .code
13043 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13044 .endd
13045 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13046 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13047 this way when a daemon is started.
13048
13049 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13050 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13051 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13052 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13053 connections via the daemon.)
13054
13055
13056
13057
13058 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13059 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13060 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13061 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13062 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13063 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13064 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13065 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13066 .code
13067 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13068 .endd
13069 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13070 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13071 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13072 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13073 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13074 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13075 .code
13076 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13077 .endd
13078 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13079 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13080 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13081 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13082 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13083
13084 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13085 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13086 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13087 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13088 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13089 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13090 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13091 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13092 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13093 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13094 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13095 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13096
13097 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13098 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13099 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13100 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13101 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13102
13103
13104
13105 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13106 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13107 .code
13108 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13109 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13110 .endd
13111 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13112 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13113 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13114 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13115
13116 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13117 .code
13118 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13119 .endd
13120 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13121 .code
13122 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13123 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13124 .endd
13125 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13126 IPv4 loopback address only:
13127 .code
13128 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13129 .endd
13130 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13131 .code
13132 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13133 .endd
13134 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13135
13136
13137
13138 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13139 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13140 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13141 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13142 treated as local.
13143
13144 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13145 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13146 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13147 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13148
13149 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13150 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13151 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13152 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13153 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13154 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13155 used for listening. Consider this example:
13156 .code
13157 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13158 192.168.53.235 ; \
13159 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13160
13161 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13162 .endd
13163 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13164 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13165 Exim is routing.
13166
13167 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13168 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13169 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13170 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13171 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13172 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13173 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13174 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13175
13176
13177
13178 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13179 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13180 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13181 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13182 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13183 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13184 details.
13185
13186
13187
13188
13189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13191
13192 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13193 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13194 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13195 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13196
13197 .ilist
13198 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13199 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13200 .next
13201 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13202 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13203 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13204 .next
13205 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13206 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13207 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13208 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13209 settings.
13210 .endlist
13211
13212 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13213 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13214 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13215 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13216 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13217 listed in more than one group.
13218
13219 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13220 .table2
13221 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13222 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13223 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13224 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13225 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13226 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13227 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13228 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13229 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13230 .endtable
13231
13232
13233 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13234 .table2
13235 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13236 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13237 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13238 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13239 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13240 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13241 .endtable
13242
13243
13244
13245 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13246 .table2
13247 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13248 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13249 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13250 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13251 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13252 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13253 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13254 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13255 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13256 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13257 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13258 .endtable
13259
13260
13261
13262 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13263 .table2
13264 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13265 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13266 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13267 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13268 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13269 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13270 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13271 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13272 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13273 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13274 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13275 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13276 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13277 .endtable
13278
13279
13280
13281 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13282 .table2
13283 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13284 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13285 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13286 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13287 .endtable
13288
13289
13290
13291 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13292 .table2
13293 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13294 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13295 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13296 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13297 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13298 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13299 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13300 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13301 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13302 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13303 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13304 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13305 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13306 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13307 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13308 .endtable
13309
13310
13311
13312 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13313 .table2
13314 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13315 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13316 .endtable
13317
13318
13319
13320 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13321 .table2
13322 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13323 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13324 .endtable
13325
13326
13327
13328 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13329 .table2
13330 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13331 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13332 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13333 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13334 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13335 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13336 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13337 .endtable
13338
13339
13340
13341 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13342 .table2
13343 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13344 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13345 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13346 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13347 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13348 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13349 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13350 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13351 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13352 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13353 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13354 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13355 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13356 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13357 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13358 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13359 connection"
13360 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13361 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13362 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13363 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13364 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13365 .endtable
13366
13367
13368
13369 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13370 .table2
13371 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13372 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13373 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13374 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13375 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13376 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13377 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13378 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13379 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13380 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13381 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13382 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13383 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13384 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13385 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13386 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13387 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13388 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13389 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13390 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13391 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13392 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13393 words""&"
13394 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13395 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13396 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13397 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13398 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13399 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13400 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13401 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13402 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13403 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13404 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13405 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13406 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13407 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13408 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13409 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13410 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13411 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13412 .endtable
13413
13414
13415
13416 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13417 .table2
13418 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13419 item"
13420 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13421 item"
13422 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13423 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13424 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13425 .endtable
13426
13427
13428
13429 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13430 .table2
13431 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13432 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13433 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13434 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13435 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13436 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13437 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13438 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13439 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13440 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13441 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13442 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13443 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13444 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13445 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13446 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13447 .endtable
13448
13449
13450
13451 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13452 .table2
13453 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13454 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13455 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13456 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13457 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13458 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13459 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13460 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13461 .endtable
13462
13463
13464
13465 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13466 .table2
13467 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13468 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13469 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13470 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13471 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13472 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13473 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13474 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13475 .endtable
13476
13477
13478
13479
13480 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13481 .table2
13482 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13483 .endtable
13484
13485
13486
13487
13488
13489 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13490 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13491
13492 .table2
13493 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13494 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13495 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13496 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13497 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13498 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13499 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13500 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13501 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13502 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13503 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13504 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13505 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13506 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13507 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13508 connection"
13509 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13510 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13511 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13512 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13513 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13514 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13515 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13516 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13517 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13518 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13519 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13520 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13521 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13522 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13523 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13524 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13525 .endtable
13526
13527
13528
13529 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13530 .table2
13531 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13532 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13533 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13534 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13535 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13536 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13537 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13538 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13539 .endtable
13540
13541
13542
13543 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13544 .table2
13545 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13546 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13547 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13548 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13549 words""&"
13550 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13551 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13552 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13553 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13554 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13555 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13556 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13557 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13558 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13559 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13560 .endtable
13561
13562
13563
13564 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13565 .table2
13566 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13567 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13568 directory"
13569 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13570 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13571 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13572 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13573 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13574 .endtable
13575
13576
13577
13578 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13579 .table2
13580 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13581 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13582 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13583 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13584 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13585 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13586 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13587 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13588 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13589 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13590 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13591 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13592 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13593 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13594 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13595 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13596 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13597 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13598 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13599 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13600 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13601 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13602 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13603 .endtable
13604
13605
13606
13607 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13608 .table2
13609 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13610 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13611 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13612 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13613 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13614 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13615 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13616 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13617 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13618 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13619 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13620 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13621 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13622 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13623 .endtable
13624
13625
13626
13627 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13628 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13629 &dagger;.
13630
13631 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13632 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13633 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13634 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13635 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13636 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13637 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13638 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13639 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13640
13641 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13642 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13643 It now defaults to true.
13644 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13645 .display
13646 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13647 .endd
13648
13649 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13650 .code
13651 log_selector = +8bitmime
13652 .endd
13653
13654 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13655 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13656 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13657 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13658 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13659 further details.
13660
13661 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13662 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13663 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13664 SMTP messages.
13665
13666 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13667 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13668 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13669 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13670 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13671
13672 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13673 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13674 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13675 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13676 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13677
13678 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13679 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13680 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13681 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13682
13683 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13684 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13685 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13686 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13687 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13688
13689 .new
13690 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13691 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13692 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13693 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13694 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13695 .wen
13696 This option defines the ACL that,
13697 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13698 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13699 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13700 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13701
13702 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13703 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13704 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13705 of a received message.
13706 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13707
13708 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13709 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13710 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13711 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13712
13713 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13714 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13715 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13716 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13717
13718 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13719 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13720 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13721 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13722 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13723
13724
13725 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13726 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13727 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13728 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13729
13730 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13731 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13732 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13733 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13734 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13735
13736 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13737 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13738 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13739 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13740 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13741
13742 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13743 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13744 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13745 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13746 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13747
13748 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13749 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13750 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13751 further details.
13752
13753 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13754 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13755 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13756 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13757
13758 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13759 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13760 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13761 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13762
13763 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13764 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13765 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13766 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13767
13768 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13769 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13770 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13771 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13772
13773 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13774 .cindex "admin user"
13775 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13776 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13777 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13778 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13779 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13780 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13781 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13782
13783 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13784 .cindex "domain literal"
13785 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13786 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13787 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13788 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13789
13790 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13791 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13792 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13793 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13794 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13795 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13796 the local host's IP addresses.
13797
13798
13799 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13800 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13801 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13802 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13803 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13804 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13805 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13806 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13807 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13808
13809 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13810 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13811 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13812 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13813 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13814 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13815 experiment if they wish.
13816
13817 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13818 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13819 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13820 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13821 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13822 suitable setting is:
13823 .code
13824 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13825 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13826 .endd
13827 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13828 .code
13829 dns_check_names_pattern =
13830 .endd
13831 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13832
13833
13834 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13835 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13836 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13837 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13838 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13839 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13840 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13841 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13842 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13843 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13844 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13845
13846 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13847 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13848 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13849 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13850 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13851 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13852
13853 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13854 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13855 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13856 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13857 .code
13858 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13859 .endd
13860 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13861 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13862 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13863 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13864
13865
13866 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13867 .cindex "thawing messages"
13868 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13869 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13870 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13871 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13872 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13873 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13874
13875 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13876 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13877 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13878
13879
13880 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13881 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13882 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13883 .code
13884 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13885 .endd
13886 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13887 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13888
13889
13890 .option bi_command main string unset
13891 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13892 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13893 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13894 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13895 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13896
13897
13898 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13899 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13900 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13901 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13902 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13903 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13904
13905
13906 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13907 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13908 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13909 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13910
13911 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13912 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13913 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13914 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13915 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13916 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13917 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13918 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13919 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13920 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13921
13922 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13923 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13924 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13925 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13926
13927
13928 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13929 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13930 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13931 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13932 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13933 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13934 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13935 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13936 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13937
13938 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13939 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13940 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13941 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13942 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13943 messages.
13944
13945 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13946 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13947 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13948 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13949 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13950 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13951 connection. A typical setting might be:
13952 .code
13953 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13954 .endd
13955 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13956 .code
13957 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13958 .endd
13959 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13960 address.
13961
13962 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13963 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13964 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13965 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13966 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13967 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13968
13969
13970 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13971 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13972 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13973 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13974
13975
13976 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13977 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13978 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13979 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13980
13981
13982 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13983 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13984 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13985 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13986
13987
13988 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13989 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13990 callout verification. The default value is
13991 .code
13992 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13993 .endd
13994 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13995
13996
13997 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13998 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13999
14000
14001 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14002 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14003
14004 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14005 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14006 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14007 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14008 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14009 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14010 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14011 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14012 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14013 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14014
14015
14016 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14017 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14018
14019
14020 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14021 .cindex "checking disk space"
14022 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14023 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14024 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14025 message is accepted.
14026
14027 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14028 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14029 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14030 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14031 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14032 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14033 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14034 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14035
14036
14037 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14038 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14039 .code
14040 check_spool_space = 10M
14041 check_spool_inodes = 100
14042 .endd
14043 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14044 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14045 transit.
14046
14047 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14048 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14049 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14050
14051 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14052 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14053 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14054 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14055 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14056 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14057
14058 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14059 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14060
14061 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14062 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14063 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14064
14065 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14066 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14067 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14068 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14069 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14070 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14071
14072 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14073 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14074 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14075 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14076 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14077 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14078 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14079
14080 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14081 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14082
14083 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14084 .cindex "warning of delay"
14085 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14086 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14087 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14088 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14089 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14090 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14091 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14092 with
14093 .code
14094 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14095 .endd
14096 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14097 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14098 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14099 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14100 .code
14101 delay_warning = 6h
14102 .endd
14103 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14104 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14105 .code
14106 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14107 .endd
14108 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14109 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14110 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14111
14112 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14113 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14114 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14115 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14116 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14117 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14118 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14119 not sent. The default is:
14120 .code
14121 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14122 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14123 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14124 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14125 } {no}{yes}}
14126 .endd
14127 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14128 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14129 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14130 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14131
14132 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14133 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14134 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14135 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14136 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14137 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14138 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14139 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14140
14141 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14142 .cindex "load average"
14143 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14144 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14145 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14146 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14147 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14148
14149
14150 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14151 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14152 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14153 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14154 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14155 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14156 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14157 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14158
14159 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14160 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14161 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14162 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14163 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14164 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14165 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14166 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14167
14168 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14169 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14170 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14171 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14172
14173
14174 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14175 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14176 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14177 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14178 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14179 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14180 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14181
14182
14183 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14184 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14185 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14186 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14187 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14188 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14189
14190
14191 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14192 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14193 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14194 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14195 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14196 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14197 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14198 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14199 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14200 by a setting such as this:
14201 .code
14202 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14203 .endd
14204 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14205 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14206 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14207 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14208 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14209 options are applied after this global option.
14210
14211 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14212 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14213 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14214 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14215 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14216 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14217 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14218 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14219 value of this option. The default pattern is
14220 .code
14221 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14222 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14223 .endd
14224 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14225 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14226 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14227 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14228 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14229 empty string.
14230
14231 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14232 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14233 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14234
14235 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14236 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14237 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14238 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14239
14240
14241 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14242 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14243 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14244 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14245 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14246 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14247
14248 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14249
14250
14251 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14252 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14253 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14254 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14255 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14256 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14257 domain matches this list.
14258
14259 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14260 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14261 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14262
14263
14264 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14265 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14266 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14267 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14268 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14269 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14270 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14271 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14272 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14273 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14274 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14275 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14276 to set in them.
14277 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14278
14279
14280 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14281 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14282
14283
14284 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14285 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14286 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14287 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14288 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14289 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14290 on.
14291
14292 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14293
14294
14295 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14296 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14297 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14298 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14299
14300 .new
14301 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14302 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14303 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14304 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14305 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14306 and accepted from, these hosts.
14307 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14308 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14309 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14310 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14311 are sent.
14312 .wen
14313
14314 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14315 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14316 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14317 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14318 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14319 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14320 .code
14321 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14322 .endd
14323 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14324 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14325
14326 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14327 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14328 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14329 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14330 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14331 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14332 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14333 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14334 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14335
14336
14337 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14338 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14339 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14340 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14341 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14342 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14343 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14344 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14345 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14346
14347 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14348 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14349 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14350 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14351 are examined. For example:
14352 .code
14353 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14354 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14355 postmaster@mydomain.example
14356 .endd
14357 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14358 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14359 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14360 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14361 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14362 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14363 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14364
14365
14366 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14367 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14368 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14369 .display
14370 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14371 .endd
14372 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14373 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14374 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14375 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14376 overrides the default.
14377
14378 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14379 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14380 and warning messages. For example:
14381 .code
14382 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14383 .endd
14384 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14385 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14386 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14387 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14388 not used.
14389
14390
14391 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14392 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14393 .cindex "Exim group"
14394 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14395 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14396 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14397 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14398 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14399 security issues.
14400
14401
14402 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14403 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14404 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14405 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14406 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14407 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14408 other place.
14409 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14410 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14411 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14412 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14413
14414
14415 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14416 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14417 .cindex "Exim user"
14418 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14419 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14420 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14421 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14422
14423 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14424 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14425 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14426 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14427
14428
14429 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14430 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14431 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14432 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14433
14434
14435 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14436 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14437
14438 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14439 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14440 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14441 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14442 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14443 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14444 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14445 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14446 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14447 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14448 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14449 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14450 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14451 addresses.
14452
14453
14454 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14455 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14456 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14457 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14458 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14459 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14460 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14461 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14462 retries.
14463
14464 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14465 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14466 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14467 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14468
14469
14470
14471 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14472 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14473 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14474 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14475 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14476 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14477 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14478 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14479 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14480 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14481 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14482 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14483 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14484 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14485 logging that you require.
14486
14487
14488 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14489 .cindex "HP-UX"
14490 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14491 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14492 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14493 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14494 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14495 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14496 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14497 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14498
14499 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14500 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14501 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14502 user's name.
14503
14504 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14505 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14506 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14507 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14508 .code
14509 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14510 gecos_name = $1
14511 .endd
14512
14513 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14514 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14515
14516
14517 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14518 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14519 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14520 implementations of TLS.
14521
14522
14523 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14524 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14525 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14526
14527 See
14528 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14529 for documentation.
14530
14531
14532
14533 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14534 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14535 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14536 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14537 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14538 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14539
14540
14541
14542 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14543 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14544 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14545 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14546 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14547 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14548 sections are rejected.
14549
14550
14551 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14552 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14553 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14554 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14555 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14556 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14557 zero means &"no limit"&.
14558
14559
14560
14561
14562 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14563 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14564 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14565 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14566 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14567 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14568 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14569 if you want to do semantic checking.
14570 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14571 set.
14572
14573
14574 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14575 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14576 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14577 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14578 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14579 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14580 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14581 .code
14582 helo_allow_chars = _
14583 .endd
14584 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14585
14586
14587 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14588 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14589 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14590 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14591 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14592 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14593 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14594 do.
14595
14596
14597 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14598 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14599 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14600 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14601 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14602 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14603 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14604 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14605 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14606 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14607 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14608 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14609
14610 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14611 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14612 EHLO command either:
14613
14614 .ilist
14615 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14616 .next
14617 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14618 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14619 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14620 calling host address, or
14621 .next
14622 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14623 .endlist
14624
14625 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14626 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14627 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14628
14629 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14630 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14631 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14632
14633 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14634 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14635 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14636 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14637 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14638 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14639 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14640 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14641 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14642 error.
14643
14644 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14645 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14646 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14647 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14648 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14649 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14650 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14651 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14652 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14653
14654 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14655 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14656 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14657 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14658 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14659
14660 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14661 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14662 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14663 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14664
14665
14666 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14667 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14668 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14669 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14670 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14671 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14672 default configuration file contains
14673 .code
14674 host_lookup = *
14675 .endd
14676 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14677 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14678
14679 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14680 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14681 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14682
14683 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14684 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14685 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14686 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14687 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14688 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14689
14690
14691 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14692 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14693 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14694 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14695 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14696 if you want.
14697
14698 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14699 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14700 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14701 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14702
14703
14704
14705 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14706 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14707 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14708 as soon as the connection is made.
14709 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14710 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14711 connections immediately.
14712
14713 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14714 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14715 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14716 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14717 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14718
14719
14720 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14721 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14722 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14723 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14724 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14725 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14726 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14727 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14728 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14729 .code
14730 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14731 .endd
14732 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14733
14734
14735
14736 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14737 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14738 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14739 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14740 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14741 records
14742 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14743 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14744
14745 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14746 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14747 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14748 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14749 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14750 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14751 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14752
14753
14754 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14755 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14756 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14757 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14758 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14759
14760
14761
14762 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14763 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14764 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14765 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14766 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14767 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14768
14769 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14770 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14771 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14772 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14773 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14774 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14775 for frozen messages. For example,
14776 .code
14777 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14778 .endd
14779 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14780 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14781 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14782 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14783 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14784 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14785
14786
14787 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14788 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14789 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14790 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14791 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14792 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14793 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14794 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14795 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14796 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14797
14798
14799 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14800 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14801
14802
14803 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14804 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14805 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14806 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14807 logged.
14808
14809
14810 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14811 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14812 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14813 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14814 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14815 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14816 and constrained to be a directory.
14817
14818
14819 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14820 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14821 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14822 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14823 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14824 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14825 and constrained to be a file.
14826
14827
14828 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14829 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14830 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14831 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14832 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14833
14834
14835 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14836 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14837 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14838 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14839 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14840 identity to be proven.
14841
14842
14843 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14844 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14845 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14846 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14847 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14848
14849
14850 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14851 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14852 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14853 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14854 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14855 with LDAP support.
14856
14857
14858 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14859 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14860 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14861 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14862 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14863 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14864 to hard/demand.
14865
14866
14867 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14868 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14869 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14870 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14871 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14872 of SSL-on-connect.
14873 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14874 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14875
14876
14877 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14878 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14879 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14880 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14881 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14882 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14883 has been built with LDAP support.
14884
14885
14886
14887 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14888 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14889 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14890 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14891 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14892 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14893 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14894
14895 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14896 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14897 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14898
14899 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14900 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14901 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14902 and the default qualify domain.
14903
14904 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14905 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14906 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14907 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14908
14909 .cindex "envelope sender"
14910 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14911 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14912 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14913
14914 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14915 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14916 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14917
14918
14919
14920
14921 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14922 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14923 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14924 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14925 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14926 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14927 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14928 example, if
14929 .code
14930 local_from_prefix = *-
14931 .endd
14932 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14933 .code
14934 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14935 .endd
14936 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14937 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14938 qualify domain.
14939
14940
14941 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14942 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14943
14944
14945 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14946 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14947 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14948 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14949 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14950 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14951 &%local_interfaces%& is
14952 .code
14953 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14954 .endd
14955 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14956 .code
14957 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14958 .endd
14959
14960 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14961 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14962 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14963 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14964 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14965 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14966 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14967 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14968
14969
14970
14971 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14972 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14973 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14974 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14975 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14976 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14977 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14978 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14979
14980
14981
14982
14983 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14984 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14985 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14986 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14987 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14988 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14989 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14990 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14991 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14992 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14993 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14994 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14995 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14996 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14997 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14998
14999
15000
15001 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15002 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15003 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15004 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15005 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15006 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15007 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15008 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15009 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15010 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15011 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15012 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15013 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15014 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15015 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15016
15017
15018 .option log_selector main string unset
15019 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15020 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15021 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15022 minus characters. For example:
15023 .code
15024 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15025 .endd
15026 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15027 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15028
15029
15030 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15031 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15032 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15033 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15034 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15035 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15036 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15037 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15038 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15039 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15040 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15041 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15042 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15043
15044
15045 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15046 .cindex "too many open files"
15047 .cindex "open files, too many"
15048 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15049 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15050 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15051 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15052 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15053 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15054 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15055 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15056 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15057 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15058 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15059 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15060
15061
15062 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15063 .cindex "length of login name"
15064 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15065 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15066 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15067 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15068 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15069 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15070
15071
15072 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15073 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15074 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15075 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15076 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15077 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15078 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15079 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15080
15081
15082 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15083 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15084 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15085 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15086 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15087 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15088 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15089
15090
15091 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15092 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15093 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15094 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15095 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15096 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15097 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15098 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15099 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15100 empty string, the option is ignored.
15101
15102
15103 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15104 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15105 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15106 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15107 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15108 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15109 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15110 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15111 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15112 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15113 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15114 colons will become hyphens.
15115
15116
15117 .option message_logs main boolean true
15118 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15119 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15120 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15121 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15122 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15123 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15124 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15125 which is not affected by this option.
15126
15127
15128 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15129 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15130 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15131 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15132 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15133 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15134 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15135 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15136 optionally followed by K or M.
15137
15138 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15139 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15140 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15141 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15142 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15143
15144 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15145 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15146 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15147 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15148 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15149 message that an individual transport can process.
15150
15151 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15152 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15153 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15154 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15155 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
15156 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15157 some problems may result.
15158
15159 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15160 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15161 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15162
15163
15164 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15165 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15166 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15167 .code
15168 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15169 .endd
15170 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15171 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15172 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15173 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15174 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15175
15176
15177 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15178 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15179 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15180 contains a full description of this facility.
15181
15182
15183
15184 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15185 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15186 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15187 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15188 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15189
15190
15191 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15192 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15193 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15194 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15195 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15196 safety precaution.
15197
15198 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15199 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15200 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15201 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15202 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15203
15204 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15205 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15206 example is
15207 .code
15208 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15209 .endd
15210 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15211 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15212 transport driver.
15213
15214
15215 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15216 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15217 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15218 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15219 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15220
15221 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15222 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15223 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15224 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15225 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15226 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15227 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15228
15229 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15230 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15231 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15232 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15233 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15234
15235 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15236
15237 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15238 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15239 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15240 some now infamous attacks.
15241
15242 Examples:
15243 .code
15244 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15245 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15246 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15247
15248 # Disable older protocol versions:
15249 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15250 .endd
15251
15252 Possible options may include:
15253 .ilist
15254 &`all`&
15255 .next
15256 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15257 .next
15258 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15259 .next
15260 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15261 .next
15262 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15263 .next
15264 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15265 .next
15266 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15267 .next
15268 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15269 .next
15270 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15271 .next
15272 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15273 .next
15274 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15275 .next
15276 &`no_compression`&
15277 .next
15278 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15279 .next
15280 &`no_sslv2`&
15281 .next
15282 &`no_sslv3`&
15283 .next
15284 &`no_ticket`&
15285 .next
15286 &`no_tlsv1`&
15287 .next
15288 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15289 .next
15290 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15291 .next
15292 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15293 .next
15294 &`single_dh_use`&
15295 .next
15296 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15297 .next
15298 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15299 .next
15300 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15301 .next
15302 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15303 .next
15304 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15305 .next
15306 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15307 .endlist
15308
15309 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15310 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15311 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15312 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15313 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15314 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15315
15316
15317 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15318 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15319 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15320 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15321 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15322
15323
15324 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15325 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15326 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15327 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15328 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15329 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15330 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15331 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15332 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15333 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15334 an ACL.
15335
15336 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15337 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15338 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15339 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15340 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15341 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15342 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15343
15344
15345 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15346 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15347 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15348
15349
15350 .option perl_startup main string unset
15351 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15352 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15353
15354
15355 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15356 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15357 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15358 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15359 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15360 PostgreSQL support.
15361
15362
15363 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15364 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15365 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15366 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15367 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15368 to the host name:
15369 .code
15370 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15371 .endd
15372 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15373 spool directory.
15374 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15375 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15376 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15377
15378
15379 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15380 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15381 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15382 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15383 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15384 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15385 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15386 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15387 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15388
15389
15390 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15391 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15392 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15393 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15394 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15395 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15396 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15397 is recieved. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15398
15399 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15400 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15401 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15402 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15403 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15404 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15405 volume of mail. Use with care!
15406
15407
15408 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15409 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15410 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15411 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15412 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15413 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15414 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15415 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15416 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15417 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15418
15419 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15420 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15421 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15422 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15423 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15424 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15425
15426
15427 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15428 .cindex "printing characters"
15429 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15430 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15431 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15432 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15433 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15434 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15435 characters.
15436
15437 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15438 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15439 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15440 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15441 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15442 standards.
15443
15444
15445 .option process_log_path main string unset
15446 .cindex "process log path"
15447 .cindex "log" "process log"
15448 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15449 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15450 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15451 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15452 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15453 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15454 different spool directories.
15455
15456
15457 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15458 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15459 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15460 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15461 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15462 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15463 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15464
15465
15466 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15467 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15468 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15469 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15470 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15471 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15472 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15473 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15474 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15475
15476 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15477 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15478 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15479 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15480 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15481 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15482 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15483
15484
15485 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15486 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15487 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15488
15489
15490
15491 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15492 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15493 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15494 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15495 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15496 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15497 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15498 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15499
15500
15501 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15502 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15503 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15504 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15505 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15506
15507
15508 .option queue_only main boolean false
15509 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15510 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15511 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15512 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15513 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15514 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15515
15516 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15517 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15518 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15519 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15520
15521
15522 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15523 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15524 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15525 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15526 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15527 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15528 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15529 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15530 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15531 .code
15532 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15533 .endd
15534 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15535 &_/some/file_& exists.
15536
15537
15538 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15539 .cindex "load average"
15540 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15541 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15542 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15543 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15544 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15545 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15546 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15547 false.
15548
15549 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15550 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15551 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15552 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15553
15554
15555 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15556 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15557 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15558 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15559 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15560 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15561 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15562 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15563 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15564 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15565 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15566 re-evaluated for each message.
15567
15568
15569 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15570 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15571 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15572 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15573 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15574 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15575
15576
15577 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15578 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15579 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15580 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15581 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15582 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15583 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15584 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15585 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15586 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15587 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15588 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15589 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15590
15591
15592
15593 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15594 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15595 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15596 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15597 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15598 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15599 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15600 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15601 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15602
15603 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15604 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15605 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15606 the daemon's command line.
15607
15608 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15609 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15610 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15611 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15612 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15613 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15614 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15615 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15616 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15617 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15618 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15619 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15620 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15621 &%queue_domains%&.
15622
15623
15624 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15625 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15626 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15627 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15628 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15629 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15630 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15631
15632 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15633 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15634 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15635 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15636 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15637 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15638 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15639 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15640 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15641 header lines. The default setting is:
15642
15643 .code
15644 received_header_text = Received: \
15645 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15646 {${if def:sender_ident \
15647 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15648 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15649 by $primary_hostname \
15650 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15651 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15652 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15653 ${if def:sender_address \
15654 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15655 id $message_exim_id\
15656 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15657 .endd
15658
15659 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15660 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15661 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15662 header lines such as the following:
15663 .code
15664 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15665 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15666 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15667 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15668 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15669 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15670 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15671 .endd
15672 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15673 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15674 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15675 message was accepted.
15676
15677
15678 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15679 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15680 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15681 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15682 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15683 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15684 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15685 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15686
15687
15688 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15689 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15690 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15691 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15692 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15693 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15694 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15695 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15696 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15697 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15698 option was not set.
15699
15700
15701 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15702 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15703 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15704 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15705 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15706 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15707 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15708 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15709 done.
15710
15711 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15712 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15713 RCPT commands in a single message.
15714
15715
15716 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15717 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15718 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15719 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15720 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15721 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15722 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15723
15724
15725 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15726 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15727 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15728 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15729 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15730 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15731 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15732 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15733 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15734 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15735 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15736 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15737 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15738 tagged with its process id.
15739
15740 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15741 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15742 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15743 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15744 is received.
15745
15746 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15747 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15748 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15749 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15750 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15751 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15752 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15753 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15754 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15755 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15756 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15757
15758 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15759 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15760 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15761 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15762
15763
15764 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15765 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15766 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15767 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15768 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15769 .code
15770 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15771 .endd
15772 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15773 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15774
15775
15776 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15777 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15778 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15779 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15780 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15781 past failures.
15782
15783
15784 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15785 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15786 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15787 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15788 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15789 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15790 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15791 the default value.
15792
15793
15794 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15795 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15796 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15797 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15798 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15799 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15800 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15801 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15802 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15803 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15804
15805
15806 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15807 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15808
15809
15810 .new
15811 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15812 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15813 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15814 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15815 an item in the list.
15816 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15817 for the system.
15818 .wen
15819
15820 .new
15821 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15822 .wen
15823 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15824 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15825 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15826 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15827
15828
15829 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15830 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15831 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15832 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15833 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15834 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15835 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15836 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15837 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15838 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15839
15840
15841 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15842 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15843 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15844 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15845 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15846 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15847 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15848
15849
15850
15851 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15852 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15853 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15854 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15855 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15856 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15857 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15858 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15859 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15860 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15861 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15862
15863
15864
15865 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15866 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15867 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15868 .cindex "inetd"
15869 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15870 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15871 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15872 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15873 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15874 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15875
15876 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15877 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15878 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15879 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15880
15881
15882 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15883 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15884 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15885 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15886 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15887 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15888 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15889 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15890
15891 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15892 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15893 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15894 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15895 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15896 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15897 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15898 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15899
15900
15901 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15902 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15903 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15904 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15905 live with.
15906
15907
15908 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15909 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15910 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15911 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15912 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15913 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15914 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15915 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15916 . the option name to split.
15917
15918 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15919 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15920 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15921 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15922 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15923 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15924 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15925 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15926 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15927 seen).
15928
15929
15930 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15931 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15932 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15933 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15934 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15935 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15936 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15937 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15938 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15939 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15940 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15941
15942 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15943 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15944 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15945 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15946 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15947 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15948
15949
15950
15951 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15952 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15953 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15954 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15955 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15956 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15957 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15958 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15959 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15960 to all messages received in the same connection.
15961
15962 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15963 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15964 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15965 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15966
15967
15968 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15969
15970 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15971 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15972 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15973 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15974 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15975 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15976 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15977 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15978 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15979 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15980 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15981 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15982 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15983
15984
15985 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15986 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15987 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15988 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15989 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15990 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15991 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15992 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15993 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15994 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15995 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15996 individual host.
15997
15998 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15999 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16000 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16001 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16002
16003
16004 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16005 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16006 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16007 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16008 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16009 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16010 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16011 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16012 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16013
16014 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16015 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16016 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16017 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16018
16019 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16020 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16021 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16022 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16023 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16024 For example:
16025 .code
16026 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16027 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16028 .endd
16029
16030 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16031 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16032 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16033 &%helo_data%& value.
16034
16035 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16036 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16037 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16038 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16039 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16040 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16041 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16042 .code
16043 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16044 $version_number $tod_full
16045 .endd
16046 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16047 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16048 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16049 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16050 multiline response).
16051
16052
16053 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16054 .cindex "checking disk space"
16055 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16056 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16057 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16058 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16059 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16060 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16061 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16062
16063
16064 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16065 .cindex "connection backlog"
16066 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16067 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16068 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16069 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16070 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16071 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16072 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16073 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16074 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16075 attacks by SYN flooding.
16076
16077
16078 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16079 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16080 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16081 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16082 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16083 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16084 fewer, but they still exist.
16085
16086 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16087 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16088 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16089 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16090 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16091 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16092 does detect many instances.
16093
16094 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16095 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16096 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16097 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16098
16099
16100
16101 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16102 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16103 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16104 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16105 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16106 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16107 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16108 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16109 example:
16110 .code
16111 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16112 $sender_host_address
16113 .endd
16114 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16115 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16116 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16117 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16118 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16119 the command.
16120
16121
16122 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16123 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16124 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16125 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16126 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16127
16128
16129 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16130 .cindex "load average"
16131 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16132 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16133 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16134 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16135 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16136 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16137
16138
16139
16140 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16141 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16142 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16143 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16144 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16145 .code
16146 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16147 .endd
16148 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16149 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16150 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16151 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16152 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16153
16154 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16155 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16156 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16157 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16158 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16159 not count towards the limit.
16160
16161
16162
16163 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16164 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16165 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16166 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16167 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16168 that subvert web
16169 clients
16170 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16171 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16172
16173
16174
16175 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16176 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16177 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16178 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16179 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16180 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16181 recipients.
16182
16183 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16184 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16185 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16186 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16187
16188 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16189 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16190 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16191 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16192 values:
16193
16194 .ilist
16195 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16196 .next
16197 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16198 fractional parts are allowed here.
16199 .next
16200 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16201 .next
16202 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16203 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16204 .endlist
16205
16206 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16207 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16208 .code
16209 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16210 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16211 .endd
16212 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16213 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16214 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16215 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16216
16217
16218 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16219 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16220
16221
16222 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16223 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16224
16225
16226 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16227 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16228 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16229 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16230 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16231 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16232 the message is abandoned.
16233 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16234 .code
16235 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16236 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16237 .endd
16238 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16239 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16240
16241 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16242 expanded before use and may depend on
16243 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16244
16245
16246 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16247 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16248 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16249 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16250 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16251 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16252
16253
16254 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16255 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16256 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16257
16258
16259 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16260 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16261 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16262 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16263 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16264 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16265 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16266 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16267 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16268 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16269 .code
16270 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16271 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16272 .endd
16273
16274 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16275 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16276 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16277 The default value is
16278 .code
16279 127.0.0.1 783
16280 .endd
16281 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16282
16283
16284
16285 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16286 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16287 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16288 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16289 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16290 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16291 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16292 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16293 arrival of the message.
16294
16295 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16296 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16297 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16298 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16299 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16300
16301 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16302 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16303 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16304 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16305 automatically deleted.
16306
16307 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16308 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16309 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16310 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16311 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16312 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16313 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16314 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16315 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16316
16317
16318 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16319 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16320 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16321 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16322 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16323 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16324 &$primary_hostname$&.
16325
16326 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16327 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16328 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16329 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16330 as failures in the configuration file.
16331
16332 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16333 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16334
16335 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16336 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16337 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16338 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16339
16340 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16341 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16342 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16343 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16344 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16345 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16346
16347 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16348 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16349 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16350 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16351 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16352 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16353 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16354
16355
16356 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16357 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16358 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16359 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16360 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16361 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16362 domain causes a syntax error.
16363 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16364 syntax checking.
16365
16366
16367 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16368 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16369 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16370 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16371 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16372 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16373 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16374 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16375 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16376 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16377 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16378 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16379
16380
16381 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16382 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16383 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16384 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16385 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16386 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16387 details of Exim's logging.
16388
16389
16390
16391 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16392 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16393 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16394 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16395 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16396
16397
16398
16399 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16400 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16401 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16402 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16403 details of Exim's logging.
16404
16405
16406 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16407 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16408 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16409 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16410 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16411 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16412 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16413 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16414 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16415 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16416 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16417
16418
16419 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16420 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16421 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16422 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16423 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16424 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16425
16426
16427 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16428 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16429 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16430 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16431 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16432
16433 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16434 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16435 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16436 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16437 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16438
16439 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16440 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16441 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16442 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16443 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16444 contains the pipe command.
16445
16446
16447 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16448 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16449 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16450 is used in a system filter.
16451
16452
16453 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16454 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16455 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16456 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16457 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16458 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16459 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16460 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16461 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16462 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16463
16464 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16465 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16466 transport option overrides.
16467
16468
16469 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16470 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16471 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16472 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16473 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16474 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16475 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16476 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16477 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16478 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16479 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16480 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16481 TCP_NODELAY.
16482
16483
16484 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16485 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16486 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16487 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16488 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16489 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16490 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16491 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16492 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16493 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16494
16495 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16496 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16497 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16498
16499
16500 .option timezone main string unset
16501 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16502 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16503 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16504 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16505 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16506 .code
16507 timezone = UTC
16508 .endd
16509 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16510 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16511 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16512 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16513 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16514 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16515
16516
16517 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16518 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16519 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16520 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16521 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16522 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16523 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16524 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16525
16526
16527 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16528 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16529 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16530 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16531 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16532 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16533 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16534
16535 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16536 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16537 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16538 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16539
16540 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16541 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16542 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16543 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16544
16545 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16546 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16547 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16548 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16549 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16550
16551 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16552
16553
16554 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16555 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16556 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16557 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16558 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16559 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16560
16561 The value must be at least 1024.
16562
16563 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16564 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16565 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16566
16567 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16568 number.
16569
16570 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16571 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16572 larger prime than requested.
16573
16574
16575 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16576 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16577 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16578 to be used by Exim.
16579
16580 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16581 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16582 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16583 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16584 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16585 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16586 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16587
16588 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16589 loaded by Exim.
16590
16591 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16592 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16593 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16594 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16595
16596 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16597 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16598 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16599 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16600
16601 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16602 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16603 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16604 "ike23".
16605
16606 The available primes are:
16607 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16608 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16609 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16610
16611 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16612 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16613
16614 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16615 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16616 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16617 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16618 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16619 userbase.
16620
16621 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16622 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16623 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16624 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16625 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16626 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16627 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16628
16629
16630 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16631 This option
16632 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16633 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16634 Certificate Authority.
16635
16636
16637 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16638 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16639 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16640 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16641 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16642
16643
16644
16645 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16646 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16647 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16648 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16649 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16650 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16651 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16652
16653 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16654
16655
16656 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16657 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16658 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16659 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16660 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16661 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16662 TLS session.
16663
16664
16665 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16666 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16667 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16668 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16669 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16670 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16671 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16672 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16673 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16674 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16675 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16676
16677
16678 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16679 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16680 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16681 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16682
16683
16684 .new
16685 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16686 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16687 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16688 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16689 word "system"
16690 or the absolute path to
16691 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16692 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16693
16694 The "system" value for the option will use a
16695 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16696 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16697 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16698 must be specified.
16699
16700 The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
16701 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16702
16703 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16704 explicitly
16705 either by file or directory
16706 are added to those given by the system default location.
16707 .wen
16708
16709 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16710 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16711 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16712 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16713 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16714 use the explicit directory version.
16715
16716 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16717
16718 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16719 being unset.
16720
16721
16722 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16723 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16724 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16725 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16726 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16727 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16728 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16729 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16730
16731 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16732 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16733 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16734 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16735 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16736 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16737 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16738
16739 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16740 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16741 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16742 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16743 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16744 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16745 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16746 certificate"&.
16747
16748 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16749 certificates.
16750
16751
16752 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16753 .cindex "trusted groups"
16754 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16755 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16756 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16757 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16758 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16759 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16760 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16761 are trusted.
16762
16763 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16764 .cindex "trusted users"
16765 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16766 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16767 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16768 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16769 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16770 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16771 Exim user are trusted.
16772
16773 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16774 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16775 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16776 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16777 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16778 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16779 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16780 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16781 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16782 &%-F%& option.
16783
16784 .option unknown_username main string unset
16785 See &%unknown_login%&.
16786
16787 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16788 .cindex "trusted users"
16789 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16790 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16791 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16792 .cindex "envelope sender"
16793 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16794 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16795 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16796 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16797 is used) is ignored.
16798
16799 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16800 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16801 .code
16802 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16803 .endd
16804 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16805 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16806 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16807 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16808 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16809 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16810 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16811 followed by a hyphen
16812 by a setting like this:
16813 .code
16814 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16815 .endd
16816 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16817 restriction, you can use
16818 .code
16819 untrusted_set_sender = *
16820 .endd
16821 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16822 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16823 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16824 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16825 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16826 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16827 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16828 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16829
16830 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16831 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16832 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16833 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16834 sender address.
16835
16836
16837 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16838 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16839 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16840 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16841 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16842 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16843 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16844 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16845 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16846 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16847 .code
16848 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16849 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16850 .endd
16851 The pattern can be seen by running
16852 .code
16853 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16854 .endd
16855 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16856 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16857 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16858 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16859 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16860 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16861
16862
16863 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16864 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16865
16866
16867 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16868 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16869 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16870 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16871 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16872 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16873 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16874 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16875
16876
16877 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16878 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16879 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16880 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16881 .ecindex IIDconfima
16882 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16883
16884
16885
16886
16887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16889
16890 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16891 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16892 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16893 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16894 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16895
16896 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16897 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16898 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16899 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16900 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16901
16902
16903
16904 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16905 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16906 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16907 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16908 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16909 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16910 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16911
16912 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16913 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16914 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16915 routers, and the eventual transport.
16916
16917 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16918 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16919 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16920 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16921 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16922
16923 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16924 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16925 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16926 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16927 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16928
16929 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16930 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16931 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16932 .code
16933 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16934 .endd
16935 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16936 .code
16937 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16938 .endd
16939 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16940 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16941
16942 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16943 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16944 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16945 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16946 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16947 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16948 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16949
16950
16951
16952 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16953 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
16954 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16955 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16956 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16957 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16958 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16959 routing.
16960
16961
16962
16963 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16964 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16965 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16966 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16967 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16968 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16969 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16970 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16971 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16972 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16973 you could put:
16974 .code
16975 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16976 .endd
16977 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16978 and
16979 .code
16980 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16981 .endd
16982 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16983 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16984 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16985 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16986
16987
16988 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16989 .cindex "case of local parts"
16990 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16991 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16992 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16993 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16994 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16995 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16996 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16997 more details.
16998
16999 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17000 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17001 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17002 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17003 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17004 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17005 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17006 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17007 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17008
17009 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17010 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17011 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17012 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17013
17014
17015
17016 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17017 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17018 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17019 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17020 .vindex "&$home$&"
17021 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17022 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17023 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17024 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17025 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17026 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17027 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17028 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17029 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17030 the router is skipped.
17031
17032 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17033 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17034 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17035 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17036 setting to achieve this. For example:
17037 .code
17038 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17039 .endd
17040 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17041 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17042 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17043
17044
17045
17046 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17047 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17048 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17049 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17050 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17051 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17052 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17053 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17054
17055 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17056 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17057
17058 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17059 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17060
17061 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17062 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17063 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17064 .code
17065 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17066 .endd
17067 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17068 .code
17069 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17070 .endd
17071
17072 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17073 .code
17074 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17075 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17076 condition = foobar
17077 .endd
17078
17079 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17080 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17081 be specified using &%condition%&.
17082
17083 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17084 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17085 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17086 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17087 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17088 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17089 Router rules processing behavior.
17090
17091 This is best illustrated in an example:
17092 .code
17093 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17094 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17095
17096 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17097 true {yes} {no}}
17098
17099 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17100 {yes} {no}}
17101 .endd
17102 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17103 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17104 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17105 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17106 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17107 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17108 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17109 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17110
17111 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17112 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17113 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17114 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17115 string characters.
17116
17117 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17118 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17119 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17120 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17121 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17122
17123
17124 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17125 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17126 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17127 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17128 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17129 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17130 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17131 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17132 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17133 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17134 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17135 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17136 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17137 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17138
17139
17140
17141 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17142 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17143 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17144 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17145 transport option of the same name.
17146
17147 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17148 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17149 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17150 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17151 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17152 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17153 the dnssec request bit set.
17154 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17155
17156 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17157 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17158 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17159 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17160 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17161 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17162 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17163 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17164 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17165
17166
17167 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17168 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17169 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17170 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17171 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17172 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17173 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17174 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17175
17176
17177
17178 .option driver routers string unset
17179 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17180 to be used.
17181
17182
17183 .new
17184 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17185 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17186 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17187 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17188 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17189 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17190 Not effective on redirect routers.
17191 .wen
17192
17193
17194
17195 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17196 .cindex "envelope sender"
17197 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17198 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17199 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17200 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17201 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17202 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17203 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17204
17205 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17206 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17207 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17208 setting.
17209
17210 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17211 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17212 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17213 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17214
17215 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17216 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17217 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17218 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17219 settings:
17220 .code
17221 errors_to =
17222 errors_to = ""
17223 .endd
17224 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17225 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17226 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17227 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17228 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17229
17230 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17231 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17232 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17233 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17234 setting &%return_path%&.
17235
17236 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17237 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17238 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17239
17240
17241
17242 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17243 .cindex "address" "testing"
17244 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17245 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17246 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17247 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17248 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17249 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17250 on for the system alias file.
17251 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17252 are evaluated.
17253
17254 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17255 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17256 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17257
17258
17259
17260 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17261 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17262 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17263 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17264
17265
17266
17267 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17268 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17269 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17270
17271
17272
17273 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17274 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17275 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17276
17277
17278
17279 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17280 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17281 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17282 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17283 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17284 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17285 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17286 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17287 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17288
17289 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17290 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17291 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17292 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17293 transport for further details.
17294
17295
17296 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17297 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17298 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17299 .cindex "transport" "local"
17300 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17301 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17302 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17303 process.
17304 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17305 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17306 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17307 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17308 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17309
17310
17311
17312 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17313 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17314 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17315 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17316 .new
17317 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17318 .wen
17319 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17320 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17321 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17322 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17323 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17324 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17325 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17326 &"see"& the added header lines.
17327
17328 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17329 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17330 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17331 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17332
17333 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17334 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17335
17336 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17337 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17338
17339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17340 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17341 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17342 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17343 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17344 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17345 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17346 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17347 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17348 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17349
17350
17351
17352 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17353 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17354 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17355 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17356 .new
17357 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17358 .wen
17359 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17360 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17361 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17362 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17363 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17364 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17365 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17366 &"see"& the original header lines.
17367
17368 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17369 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17370 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17371 errors.
17372
17373 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17374 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17375
17376 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17377 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17378
17379 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17380 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17381 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17382 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17383
17384
17385 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17386 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17387 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17388 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17389 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17390 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17391 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17392 like
17393 .code
17394 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17395 .endd
17396 by setting
17397 .code
17398 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17399 .endd
17400 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17401 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17402 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17403 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17404 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17405 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17406
17407 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17408 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17409 .code
17410 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17411 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17412 .endd
17413 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17414 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17415
17416 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17417 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17418 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17419 domain that is being routed.
17420
17421 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17422 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17423 checked.
17424
17425 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17426 .cindex "additional groups"
17427 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17428 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17429 .cindex "transport" "local"
17430 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17431 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17432 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17433 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17434 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17435
17436
17437
17438 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17439 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17440 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17441 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17442 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17443 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17444 evaluated.
17445
17446 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17447 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17448 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17449 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17450 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17451 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17452 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17453 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17454 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17455
17456 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17457 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17458 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17459 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17460 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17461 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17462 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17463 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17464 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17465 the relevant transport.
17466
17467 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17468 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17469 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17470 callout.
17471
17472 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17473 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17474 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17475 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17476 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17477 .code
17478 real_localuser:
17479 driver = accept
17480 local_part_prefix = real-
17481 check_local_user
17482 transport = local_delivery
17483 .endd
17484 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17485 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17486 .code
17487 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17488 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17489 .endd
17490
17491 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17492 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17493 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17494 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17495
17496
17497 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17498 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17499
17500
17501
17502 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17503 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17504 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17505 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17506 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17507 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17508 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17509 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17510 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17511 &%username-foo%&.
17512
17513
17514 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17515 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17516
17517
17518
17519 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17520 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17521 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17522 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17523 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17524 are evaluated, and
17525 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17526 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17527 example:
17528 .code
17529 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17530 .endd
17531 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17532 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17533 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17534 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17535 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17536 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17537 each virtual domain:
17538 .code
17539 postmaster:
17540 driver = redirect
17541 local_parts = postmaster
17542 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17543 .endd
17544
17545
17546 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17547 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17548 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17549 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17550 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17551 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17552 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17553 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17554 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17555 redirect addresses.
17556
17557
17558
17559 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17560 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17561 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17562 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17563 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17564 delivery to be deferred.
17565
17566 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17567 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17568 .oindex "&%self%&"
17569 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17570 means of the setting
17571 .code
17572 self = pass
17573 .endd
17574 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17575 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17576 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17577
17578 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17579 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17580 controls what happens next.
17581
17582
17583 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17584 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17585 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17586 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17587 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17588 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17589 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17590 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17591
17592 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17593 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17594 applies to all of them.
17595
17596
17597
17598 .option pass_router routers string unset
17599 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17600 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17601 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17602 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17603 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17604 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17605 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17606 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17607 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17608 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17609
17610
17611
17612 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17613 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17614 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17615 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17616 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17617 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17618
17619 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17620 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17621 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17622 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17623
17624
17625
17626 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17627 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17628 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17629 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17630 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17631 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17632 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17633
17634 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17635 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17636 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17637 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17638
17639 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17640 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17641 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17642 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17643 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17644
17645 .cindex "NFS"
17646 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17647 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17648 unavailable.
17649
17650 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17651 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17652 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17653 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17654 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17655 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17656 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17657 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17658
17659 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17660 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17661 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17662 operates as follows:
17663
17664 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17665 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17666 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17667 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17668 used. For example:
17669 .code
17670 require_files = mail:/some/file
17671 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17672 .endd
17673 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17674 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17675
17676 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17677 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17678 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17679 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17680
17681 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17682 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17683 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17684 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17685 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17686
17687 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17688 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17689 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17690 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17691 check again in that process.
17692
17693 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17694 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17695 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17696 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17697 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17698 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17699 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17700 .code
17701 require_files = +/some/file
17702 .endd
17703 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17704 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17705 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17706
17707
17708
17709 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17710 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17711 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17712 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17713 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17714 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17715 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17716 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17717 latter kind.
17718
17719 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17720 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17721 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17722 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17723 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17724 same name.
17725
17726 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17727 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17728 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17729
17730
17731
17732 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17733 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17734 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17735 .vindex "&$home$&"
17736 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17737 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17738 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17739 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17740 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17741 cause the router to defer.
17742
17743 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17744 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17745 place.
17746 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17747 are evaluated.)
17748 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17749 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17750
17751 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17752 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17753 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17754 of these values that is set:
17755
17756 .ilist
17757 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17758 .next
17759 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17760 .next
17761 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17762 .next
17763 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17764 .endlist
17765
17766 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17767 router, but not for the transport.
17768
17769
17770
17771 .option self routers string freeze
17772 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17773 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17774 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17775 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17776 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17777 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17778 of remote hosts.
17779 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17780 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17781 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17782 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17783 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17784
17785 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17786 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17787 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17788 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17789 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17790 cases:
17791
17792 .vlist
17793 .vitem &%defer%&
17794 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17795
17796 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17797 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17798 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17799 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17800
17801 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17802 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17803 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17804 rewritten.
17805
17806 .vitem &%pass%&
17807 .oindex "&%more%&"
17808 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17809 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17810 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17811 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17812 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17813 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17814 combination
17815 .code
17816 self = pass
17817 no_more
17818 .endd
17819 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17820 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17821 be passed to the next router.
17822
17823 .vitem &%fail%&
17824 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17825
17826 .vitem &%send%&
17827 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17828 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17829 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17830 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17831 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17832 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17833 .endlist
17834
17835
17836
17837 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17838 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17839 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17840 address matches something on the list.
17841 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17842 are evaluated.
17843
17844 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17845 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17846 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17847 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17848 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17849 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17850 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17851 matters.
17852
17853
17854 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17855 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17856 .cindex "packet radio"
17857 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17858 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17859 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17860 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17861 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17862 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17863 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17864 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17865
17866 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17867 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17868 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17869 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17870 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17871 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17872 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17873 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17874 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17875 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17876 .code
17877 translate_ip_address = \
17878 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17879 {$value}fail}}
17880 .endd
17881 The file would contain lines like
17882 .code
17883 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17884 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17885 .endd
17886 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17887 are doing.
17888
17889
17890
17891 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17892 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17893 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17894 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17895 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17896 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17897 delivery is deferred.
17898
17899 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17900 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17901 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17902
17903
17904
17905 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17906 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17907 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17908 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17909 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17910 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17911 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17912 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17913 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17914 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17915 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17916 environment.
17917
17918
17919
17920
17921 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17922 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17923 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17924 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17925 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17926 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17927 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17928 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17929 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17930 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17931
17932 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17933 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17934 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17935 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17936 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17937
17938 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17939 environment.
17940
17941
17942
17943
17944 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17945 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17946 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17947 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17948 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17949 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17950 delivery to be deferred.
17951
17952 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17953 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17954 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17955 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17956 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17957 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17958
17959 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17960 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17961 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17962 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17963 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17964 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17965 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17966 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17967
17968 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17969 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17970 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17971 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17972 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17973 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17974 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17975 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17976 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17977 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17978
17979 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17980 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17981 subsequent routers.
17982
17983
17984 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17985 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17986 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17987 .cindex "transport" "local"
17988 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17989 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17990 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17991 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17992 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17993 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17994 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17995 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17996 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17997 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17998 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17999 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18000
18001
18002
18003 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18004 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18005 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18006
18007
18008 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18009 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18010 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18011 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18012 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18013 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18014 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18015 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18016 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18017 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18018
18019 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18020 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18021 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18022 user or group.
18023
18024
18025 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18026 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18027 addresses,
18028 delivering in cutthrough mode
18029 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18030 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18031 are evaluated.
18032 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18033
18034
18035 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18036 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18037 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18038 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18039 are evaluated.
18040 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18041 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18042 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18043
18044
18045
18046
18047
18048
18049 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18050 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18051
18052 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18053 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18054 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18055 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18056 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18057 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18058 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18059 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18060 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18061 .code
18062 localusers:
18063 driver = accept
18064 domains = mydomain.example
18065 check_local_user
18066 transport = local_delivery
18067 .endd
18068 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18069 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18070 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18071 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18072
18073
18074
18075
18076
18077
18078 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18079 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18080
18081 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18082 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18083 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18084 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18085 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18086 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18087
18088 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18089 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18090 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18091 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18092 records.
18093
18094 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18095 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18096 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18097 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18098 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18099 generic option, the router declines.
18100
18101 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18102 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18103 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18104
18105 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18106 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18107 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18108 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18109 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18110 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18111
18112
18113 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18114 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18115 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18116 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18117 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18118 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18119
18120 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18121 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18122 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18123 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18124 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18125 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18126 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18127 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18128 case routing fails.
18129
18130
18131 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18132 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18133 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18134 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18135 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18136
18137 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18138 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18139
18140 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18141 .ilist
18142 The domain does not exist in DNS
18143 .next
18144 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18145 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18146 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18147 .next
18148 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18149 .next
18150 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18151 .next
18152 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18153 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18154 .next
18155 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18156 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18157 .next
18158 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18159 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18160 .next
18161 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18162 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18163 .endlist
18164
18165
18166
18167
18168 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18169 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18170 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18171
18172 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18173 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18174 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18175 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18176 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18177 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18178 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18179
18180
18181 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18182 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18183 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18184 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18185 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18186 required. For example,
18187 .code
18188 check_srv = smtp
18189 .endd
18190 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18191 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18192 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18193 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18194 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18195 normal way.
18196
18197 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18198 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18199 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18200 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18201 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18202 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18203
18204 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18205 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18206 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18207 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18208 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18209 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18210 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18211 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18212
18213 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18214 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18215
18216
18217
18218
18219 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18220 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18221 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18222 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18223 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18224 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18225 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18226 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18227 also being queued.
18228
18229
18230 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18231 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18232 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18233 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18234 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18235 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18236 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18237 setting:
18238 .code
18239 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18240 .endd
18241 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18242 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18243 the address record.
18244
18245
18246 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18247 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18248 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18249 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18250
18251
18252
18253
18254 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18255 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18256 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18257 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18258 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18259 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18260 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18261 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18262 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18263 &'resolv.conf'&.
18264
18265
18266
18267 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18268 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18269 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18270 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18271 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18272 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18273 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18274 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18275 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18276 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18277 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18278
18279 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18280 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18281 sense.
18282
18283 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18284 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18285 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18286 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18287 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18288 header rewriting.
18289
18290
18291 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18292 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18293 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18294 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18295 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18296 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18297 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18298 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18299
18300 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18301 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18302 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18303 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18304 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18305 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18306 without processing them independently,
18307 provided the following conditions are met:
18308
18309 .ilist
18310 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18311 &%headers_remove%&.
18312 .next
18313 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18314 the domain.
18315 .endlist
18316
18317
18318
18319
18320 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18321 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18322 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18323 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18324 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18325 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18326 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18327 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18328 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18329 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18330
18331 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18332 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18333 local wildcard.
18334
18335
18336
18337 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18338 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18339 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18340 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18341
18342
18343
18344
18345 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18346 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18347 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18348 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18349 if
18350 .code
18351 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18352 .endd
18353 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18354 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18355 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18356 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18357 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18358 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18359
18360
18361 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18362 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18363 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18364 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18365 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18366
18367 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18368 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18369 such as that implied by
18370 .code
18371 domains = @mx_any
18372 .endd
18373 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18374 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18375 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18376 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18377
18378
18379
18380
18381
18382
18383
18384
18385
18386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18387 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18388
18389 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18390 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18391 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18392 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18393 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18394 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18395 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18396 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18397 router handles the address
18398 .code
18399 root@[192.168.1.1]
18400 .endd
18401 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18402 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18403 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18404 .code
18405 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18406 .endd
18407 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18408 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18409
18410 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18411 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18412 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18413 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18414
18415 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18416 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18417 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18418 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18419
18420
18421
18422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18423 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18424
18425 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18426 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18427 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18428 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18429 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18430 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18431 must set
18432 .code
18433 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18434 .endd
18435 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18436
18437 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18438 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18439 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18440 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18441 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18442 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18443 must not be specified for it.
18444
18445 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18446 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18447 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18448 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18449 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18450 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18451 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18452
18453
18454 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18455 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18456 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18457 delivery to the address is deferred.
18458
18459
18460 .option port iplookup integer 0
18461 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18462 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18463 call.
18464
18465
18466 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18467 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18468 protocols is to be used.
18469
18470
18471 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18472 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18473 default value is:
18474 .code
18475 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18476 .endd
18477 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18478 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18479
18480
18481 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18482 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18483 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18484 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18485 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18486 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18487 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18488 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18489
18490
18491 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18492 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18493 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18494 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18495 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18496 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18497 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18498 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18499 following could be used:
18500 .code
18501 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18502 reroute = $local_part@$1
18503 .endd
18504
18505 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18506 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18507 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18508 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18509
18510
18511
18512
18513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18515
18516 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18517 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18518 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18519 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18520 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18521 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18522 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18523 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18524 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18525 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18526
18527 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18528 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18529 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18530 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18531 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18532 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18533 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18534
18535 .vindex "&$host$&"
18536 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18537 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18538 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18539 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18540 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18541 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18542 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18543 text string.
18544
18545 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18546 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18547 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18548 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18549 below, following the list of private options.
18550
18551
18552 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18553
18554 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18555 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18556
18557 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18558 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18559
18560 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18561 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18562 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18563 of the following values:
18564 .code
18565 decline
18566 defer
18567 fail
18568 freeze
18569 ignore
18570 pass
18571 .endd
18572 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18573 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18574 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18575 &%pass_router%&),
18576 .oindex "&%more%&"
18577 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18578 router only if &%more%& is true.
18579
18580 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18581 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18582 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18583 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18584
18585 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18586 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18587 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18588
18589
18590 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18591 .cindex "randomized host list"
18592 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18593 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18594 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18595 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18596 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18597 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18598 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18599 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18600
18601 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18602 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18603 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18604 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18605 .code
18606 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18607 .endd
18608 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18609 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18610 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18611 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18612 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18613
18614
18615 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18616 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18617 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18618 example:
18619 .code
18620 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18621 .endd
18622 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18623 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18624 deferred.
18625
18626
18627 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18628 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18629 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18630 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18631
18632
18633 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18634 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18635 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18636 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18637 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18638 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18639 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18640 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18641
18642 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18643 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18644 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18645 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18646 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18647 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18648 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18649 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18650
18651
18652
18653
18654 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18655 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18656 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18657 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18658 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18659 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18660 .display
18661 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18662 .endd
18663 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18664 no options:
18665 .code
18666 route_list = \
18667 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18668 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18669 .endd
18670 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18671 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18672 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18673 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18674 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18675 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18676 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18677 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18678 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18679 in a &%route_list%&).
18680
18681 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18682 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18683 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18684 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18685
18686
18687
18688 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18689 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18690 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18691 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18692 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18693 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18694 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18695 like this:
18696 .code
18697 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18698 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18699 .endd
18700 This data can be accessed by setting
18701 .code
18702 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18703 .endd
18704 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18705 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18706 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18707 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18708 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18709
18710
18711
18712
18713 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18714 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18715 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18716 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18717 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18718 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18719 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18720
18721 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18722 variables are set during its expansion:
18723
18724 .ilist
18725 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18726 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18727 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18728 .code
18729 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18730 .endd
18731 .next
18732 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18733 .next
18734 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18735
18736 .next
18737 .vindex "&$value$&"
18738 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18739 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18740 .code
18741 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18742 .endd
18743 .endlist
18744
18745 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18746 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18747
18748
18749
18750 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18751 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18752 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18753 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18754 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18755 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18756
18757 .ilist
18758 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18759 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18760 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18761 .code
18762 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18763 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18764 .endd
18765 .next
18766 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18767 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18768 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18769 number follows. For example:
18770 .code
18771 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18772 .endd
18773 .endlist
18774
18775 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18776 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18777 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18778 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18779 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18780 transport.
18781
18782 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18783 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18784 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18785 records in the DNS. For example:
18786 .code
18787 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18788 .endd
18789 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18790 example:
18791 .code
18792 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18793 .endd
18794 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18795 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18796 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18797 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18798 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18799 happens is controlled by the
18800 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18801 &%self%& option of the router.
18802
18803 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18804 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18805 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18806 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18807 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18808 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18809 defined by MX preferences.
18810
18811 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18812 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18813 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18814
18815 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18816 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18817 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18818 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18819
18820 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18821 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18822 router.
18823
18824 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18825 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18826 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18827
18828 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18829 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18830
18831
18832
18833 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18834 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18835 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18836 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18837 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18838 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18839 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18840
18841 .ilist
18842 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18843 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18844 .next
18845 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18846 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18847 .next
18848 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18849 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18850 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18851 .next
18852 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18853 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18854 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18855 .endlist
18856
18857 For example:
18858 .code
18859 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18860 domain2 host4:host5
18861 .endd
18862 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18863 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18864 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18865 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18866 call.
18867
18868 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18869 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18870 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18871 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18872 function called.
18873
18874
18875
18876 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18877 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18878
18879 .vindex "&$host$&"
18880 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18881 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18882
18883
18884
18885 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18886 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18887 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18888
18889 .ilist
18890 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18891 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18892 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18893 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18894 .code
18895 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18896 .endd
18897 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18898 your first router something like this:
18899 .code
18900 smart_route:
18901 driver = manualroute
18902 domains = !+local_domains
18903 transport = remote_smtp
18904 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18905 .endd
18906 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18907 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18908 they are tried in order
18909 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18910 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18911 .code
18912 smart_route:
18913 driver = manualroute
18914 transport = remote_smtp
18915 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18916 .endd
18917 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18918 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18919 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18920 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18921 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18922 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18923 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18924 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18925
18926 .next
18927 .cindex "mail hub example"
18928 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18929 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18930 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18931 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18932 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18933 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18934 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18935 lookup is easier to manage.
18936
18937 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18938 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18939 example:
18940 .code
18941 hub_route:
18942 driver = manualroute
18943 transport = remote_smtp
18944 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18945 .endd
18946 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18947 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18948 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18949 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18950 domain can be used to find the host:
18951 .code
18952 through_firewall:
18953 driver = manualroute
18954 transport = remote_smtp
18955 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18956 .endd
18957 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18958 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18959 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18960 next router.
18961
18962 .next
18963 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18964 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18965 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18966 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18967 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18968 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18969 .code
18970 save_in_file:
18971 driver = manualroute
18972 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18973 route_list = saved.domain.example
18974 .endd
18975 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18976 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18977 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18978 .code
18979 save_in_file:
18980 driver = manualroute
18981 route_list = \
18982 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18983 *.saved.domain2.example \
18984 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18985 batch_pipe
18986 .endd
18987 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18988 .vindex "&$host$&"
18989 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18990 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18991 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18992 the address if the lookup fails.
18993
18994 .next
18995 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18996 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18997 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18998 one way it can be done:
18999 .code
19000 # Transport
19001 uucp:
19002 driver = pipe
19003 user = nobody
19004 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19005 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19006 return_fail_output = true
19007
19008 # Router
19009 uucphost:
19010 transport = uucp
19011 driver = manualroute
19012 route_data = \
19013 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19014 .endd
19015 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19016 .code
19017 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19018 .endd
19019 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19020 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19021 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19022 .endlist
19023 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19024 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19025
19026
19027
19028
19029
19030
19031
19032
19033 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19034 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19035
19036 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19037 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19038 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19039 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19040 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19041 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19042 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19043 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19044 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19045 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19046 options:
19047 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19048
19049 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19050 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19051 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19052 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19053 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19054
19055
19056 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19057 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19058 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19059 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19060 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19061 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19062
19063
19064 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19065 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19066 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19067 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19068 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19069 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19070 not set, a value for the gid also.
19071
19072 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19073 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19074 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19075 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19076 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19077 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19078 gid.
19079
19080
19081 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19082 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19083 before running the command.
19084
19085
19086 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19087 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19088 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19089 timeout.
19090
19091
19092 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19093 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19094 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19095 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19096 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19097
19098 .ilist
19099 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19100 below).
19101 .next
19102 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19103 &%no_more%& is set.
19104 .next
19105 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19106 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19107 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19108 included in the SMTP response.
19109 .next
19110 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19111 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19112 included in any SMTP response.
19113 .next
19114 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19115 .next
19116 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19117 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19118 .next
19119 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19120 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19121 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19122 .endlist
19123
19124 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19125 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19126 the page):
19127 .code
19128 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19129 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19130 .endd
19131 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19132 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19133 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19134 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19135
19136 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19137 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19138 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19139 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19140 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19141
19142 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19143 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19144 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19145 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19146 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19147
19148 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19149 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19150 variable. For example, this return line
19151 .code
19152 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19153 .endd
19154 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19155 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19156 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19157 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19158
19159
19160
19161
19162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19164
19165 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19166 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19167 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19168 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19169 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19170 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19171 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19172 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19173 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19174 redirected in several different ways:
19175
19176 .ilist
19177 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19178 independently.
19179 .next
19180 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19181 .next
19182 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19183 .next
19184 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19185 .next
19186 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19187 .next
19188 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19189 .next
19190 It can be discarded.
19191 .endlist
19192
19193 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19194 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19195 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19196 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19197
19198 .new
19199 If success DSNs have been requested
19200 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19201 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19202 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19203 .wen
19204
19205
19206
19207 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19208 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19209 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19210 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19211 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19212 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19213 .code
19214 system_aliases:
19215 driver = redirect
19216 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19217 .endd
19218 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19219 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19220 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19221 cause delivery to be deferred.
19222
19223 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19224 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19225 .code
19226 userforward:
19227 driver = redirect
19228 check_local_user
19229 file = $home/.forward
19230 no_verify
19231 .endd
19232 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19233 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19234 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19235 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19236 comments.
19237
19238
19239
19240 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19241 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19242 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19243 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19244
19245 .ilist
19246 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19247 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19248 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19249 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19250 .next
19251 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19252 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19253 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19254 saves some resources.
19255 .endlist
19256
19257
19258
19259
19260
19261
19262 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19263 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19264 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19265 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19266 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19267
19268 .ilist
19269 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19270 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19271 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19272 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19273 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19274 document is intended for use by end users.
19275 .next
19276 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19277 described in the next section.
19278 .endlist
19279
19280 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19281 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19282 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19283 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19284 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19285
19286
19287
19288 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19289 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19290 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19291 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19292 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19293 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19294 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19295 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19296 commas or newlines.
19297 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19298 quotes.
19299
19300 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19301 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19302 next newline character is ignored.
19303
19304 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19305 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19306 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19307 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19308 removed.
19309
19310 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19311 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19312 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19313 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19314 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19315 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19316 setting:
19317 .code
19318 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19319 .endd
19320
19321
19322 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19323 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19324 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19325 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19326 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19327 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19328 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19329 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19330 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19331 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19332 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19333
19334 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19335 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19336 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19337 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19338 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19339 .code
19340 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19341 .endd
19342 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19343 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19344 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19345 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19346 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19347 synonymously.
19348
19349 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19350 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19351 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19352 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19353 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19354
19355 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19356 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19357 contains:
19358 .code
19359 Sam.Reman: spqr
19360 .endd
19361 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19362 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19363 this forward file:
19364 .code
19365 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19366 .endd
19367 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19368 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19369 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19370 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19371 should really contain
19372 .code
19373 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19374 .endd
19375 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19376 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19377 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19378
19379
19380
19381 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19382 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19383 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19384
19385 .ilist
19386 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19387 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19388 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19389 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19390 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19391 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19392 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19393
19394 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19395 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19396 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19397 in double quotes, for example:
19398 .code
19399 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19400 .endd
19401 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19402 quote just the command. An item such as
19403 .code
19404 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19405 .endd
19406 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19407
19408 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19409 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19410 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19411 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19412 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19413 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19414 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19415 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19416 an &%accept%& router.
19417
19418 .next
19419 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19420 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19421 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19422 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19423 .code
19424 /home/world/minbari
19425 .endd
19426 is treated as a file name, but
19427 .code
19428 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19429 .endd
19430 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19431 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19432 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19433 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19434
19435 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19436 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19437
19438 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19439 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19440 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19441 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19442
19443 .next
19444 .cindex "included address list"
19445 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19446 If an item is of the form
19447 .code
19448 :include:<path name>
19449 .endd
19450 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19451 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19452 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19453 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19454 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19455 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19456 .code
19457 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19458 .endd
19459 It must be given as
19460 .code
19461 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19462 .endd
19463 .next
19464 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19465 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19466 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19467 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19468 .cindex "black hole"
19469 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19470 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19471 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
19472 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19473
19474 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19475 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19476 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19477 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19478 &_/dev/null_&.
19479
19480 .next
19481 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19482 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19483 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19484 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19485 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19486 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19487 redirection items of the form
19488 .code
19489 :defer:
19490 :fail:
19491 .endd
19492 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19493 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19494 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19495 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19496 .code
19497 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19498 .endd
19499 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19500 of a
19501 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19502 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19503 default.
19504 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19505 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19506 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19507
19508 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19509 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19510 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19511 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19512 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19513 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19514 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19515 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19516 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19517 ignored.
19518
19519 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19520 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19521 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19522 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19523
19524 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19525 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19526 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19527 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19528 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19529
19530 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19531 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19532 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19533 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19534 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19535 rules still apply.
19536
19537 .next
19538 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19539 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19540 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19541 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19542 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19543 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19544 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19545 .endlist
19546
19547
19548 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19549 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19550 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19551 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19552 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19553 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19554 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19555 aliasing scheme of the type
19556 .code
19557 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19558 localpart1: pipe
19559 localpart2: pipe
19560 .endd
19561 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19562 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19563 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19564 such as
19565 .code
19566 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19567 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19568 .endd
19569 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19570 the pipes are distinct.
19571
19572
19573
19574 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19575 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19576 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19577 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19578 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19579 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19580 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19581 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19582 can be used to avoid this.
19583
19584
19585 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19586 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19587 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19588 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19589 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19590 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19591 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19592
19593
19594
19595 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19596
19597 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19598 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19599
19600
19601 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19602 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19603 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19604
19605
19606 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19607 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19608 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19609 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19610
19611
19612 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19613 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19614 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19615 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19616 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19617 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19618 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19619
19620 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19621 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19622
19623
19624 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19625 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19626 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19627 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19628 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19629
19630
19631
19632 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19633 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19634 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19635 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19636 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19637 let ordinary users do.
19638
19639
19640
19641 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19642 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19643 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19644 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19645 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19646 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19647
19648 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19649 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19650 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19651 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19652 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19653 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19654 .code
19655 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19656 .endd
19657 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19658 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19659 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19660 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19661 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19662 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19663 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19664 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19665
19666
19667 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19668 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19669 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19670 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19671 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19672 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19673 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19674 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19675
19676
19677
19678 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19679 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19680 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19681 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19682 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19683 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19684
19685
19686 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19687 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19688 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19689 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19690 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19691 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19692
19693 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19694 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19695 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19696 .code
19697 data = #Exim filter\n\
19698 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19699 .endd
19700 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19701 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19702 choice into a newline.
19703
19704
19705 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19706 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19707 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19708 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19709 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19710
19711
19712 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19713 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19714 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19715 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19716 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19717 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19718 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19719 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19720
19721 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19722 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19723 runs a check on the containing directory,
19724 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19725 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19726 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19727 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19728 not, the router declines.
19729
19730
19731 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19732 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19733 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19734 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19735 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19736 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19737 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19738
19739
19740 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19741 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19742 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19743 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19744 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19745
19746
19747 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19748 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19749 redirection list.
19750
19751
19752 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19753 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19754 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19755
19756
19757
19758
19759 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19760 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19761 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19762 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19763 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19764 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19765 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19766 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19767 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19768
19769
19770 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19771 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19772 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19773 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19774 functions.
19775
19776 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19777 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19778 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19779 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19780
19781 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19782 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19783 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19784 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19785 &_.forward_& files).
19786
19787
19788 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19789 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19790 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19791
19792
19793 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19794 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19795 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19796 of the embedded Perl support.
19797
19798
19799 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19800 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19801 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19802
19803
19804 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19805 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19806 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19807
19808
19809 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19810 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19811 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19812 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19813 &%one_time%& is set.
19814
19815
19816 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19817 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19818 to make use of &%run%& items.
19819
19820
19821 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19822 If this option is true, items of the form
19823 .code
19824 :include:<path name>
19825 .endd
19826 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19827
19828
19829 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19830 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19831 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19832 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19833 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19834
19835
19836 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19837 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19838 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19839
19840
19841 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19842 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19843 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19844 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19845 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19846
19847
19848
19849
19850 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19851 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19852 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19853 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19854 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19855 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19856 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19857
19858
19859 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19860 .cindex "EACCES"
19861 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19862 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19863 file did not exist.
19864
19865
19866 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19867 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19868 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19869 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19870 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19871
19872 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19873 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19874 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19875 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19876 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19877 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19878 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19879 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19880
19881
19882
19883 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19884 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19885 redirection list must start with this directory.
19886
19887
19888 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19889 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19890 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19891
19892
19893 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19894 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19895 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19896 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19897 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19898 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19899 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19900 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19901 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19902 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19903 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19904 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19905 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19906 before they subscribed.
19907
19908 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19909 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19910 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19911 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19912 attempt.
19913
19914 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19915 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19916 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19917 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19918
19919 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19920 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19921 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19922
19923 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19924 &%one_time%&.
19925
19926 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19927 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19928 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19929 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19930 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19931 expansion.
19932
19933
19934 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19935 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19936 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19937 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19938 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19939 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19940 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19941 See &%check_owner%& above.
19942
19943
19944 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19945 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19946 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19947 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19948
19949
19950 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19951 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19952 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19953 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19954 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19955 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19956 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19957
19958
19959 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19960 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19961 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19962 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19963 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19964 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19965 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19966 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19967
19968 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19969 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19970 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19971 addresses.
19972
19973 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19974 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19975 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19976 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19977 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19978 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19979 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19980 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19981 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19982 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19983
19984
19985 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19986 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19987 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19988 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19989 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19990 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19991
19992
19993 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19994 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19995 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19996 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19997 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19998 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19999
20000
20001 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20002 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20003 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20004 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20005 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20006
20007
20008 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20009 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20010 :subaddress part of an address.
20011
20012 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20013 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20014 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20015 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20016
20017
20018 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20019 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20020 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20021 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20022 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20023 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20024 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20025
20026
20027
20028 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20029 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20030 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20031 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20032 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20033 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20034 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20035 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20036 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20037 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20038 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20039 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20040 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20041 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20042 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20043 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20044
20045 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20046 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20047 the following routers.
20048
20049 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20050 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20051 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20052 so it is passed to the following routers.
20053
20054 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20055 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20056 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20057 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20058
20059 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20060 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20061 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20062 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20063 .code
20064 userforward:
20065 driver = redirect
20066 allow_filter
20067 check_local_user
20068 file = $home/.forward
20069 file_transport = address_file
20070 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20071 reply_transport = address_reply
20072 no_verify
20073 skip_syntax_errors
20074 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20075 syntax_errors_text = \
20076 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20077 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20078 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20079 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20080 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20081 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20082 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20083 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20084 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20085 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20086 .endd
20087 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20088 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20089 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20090 .code
20091 real_localuser:
20092 driver = accept
20093 check_local_user
20094 local_part_prefix = real-
20095 transport = local_delivery
20096 .endd
20097 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20098 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20099 .code
20100 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20101 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20102 .endd
20103
20104
20105 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20106 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20107
20108
20109 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20110 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20111 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20112 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20113
20114
20115
20116
20117
20118
20119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20121
20122 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20123 "Environment for local transports"
20124 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20125 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20126 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20127 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20128 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20129 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20130 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20131
20132 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20133 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20134 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20135 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20136
20137 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20138 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20139 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20140 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20141 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20142
20143
20144
20145 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20146 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20147 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20148 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20149 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20150 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20151 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20152 time.
20153
20154 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20155 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20156 .code
20157 my_transport:
20158 driver = pipe
20159 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20160 .endd
20161 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20162 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20163 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20164 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20165
20166
20167
20168
20169 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20170 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20171 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20172 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20173 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20174 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20175 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20176 group (set by the transport). For example:
20177 .code
20178 # Routers ...
20179 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20180 local_users:
20181 driver = accept
20182 check_local_user
20183 transport = group_delivery
20184
20185 # Transports ...
20186 # This transport overrides the group
20187 group_delivery:
20188 driver = appendfile
20189 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20190 group = mail
20191 .endd
20192 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20193 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20194 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20195 set.
20196
20197 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20198 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20199 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20200 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20201 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20202 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20203
20204 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20205 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20206 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20207 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20208 original gid is also used.
20209
20210 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20211 following that is set is used:
20212
20213 .ilist
20214 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20215 .next
20216 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20217 .next
20218 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20219 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20220 .next
20221 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20222 .next
20223 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20224 the uid is the creator's uid;
20225 .next
20226 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20227 .endlist
20228
20229 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20230 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20231 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20232 The first of the following that is set is used:
20233
20234 .ilist
20235 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20236 .next
20237 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20238 .next
20239 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20240 .next
20241 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20242 .next
20243 The Exim uid.
20244 .endlist
20245
20246 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20247 &%never_users%& list.
20248
20249
20250
20251
20252
20253 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20254 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20255 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20256 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20257 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20258 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20259 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20260 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20261 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20262 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20263
20264 .ilist
20265 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20266 .next
20267 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20268 .next
20269 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20270 .next
20271 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20272 .endlist
20273
20274 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20275
20276 .ilist
20277 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20278 .next
20279 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20280 .endlist
20281
20282
20283 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20284 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20285 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20286
20287
20288
20289 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20290 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20291 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20292 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20293 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20294 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20295 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20296 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20297 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20298 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20299 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20300 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20301 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20302 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20303
20304
20305
20306
20307
20308
20309
20310 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20311 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20312
20313 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20314 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20315 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20316 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20317 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20318
20319
20320 .option body_only transports boolean false
20321 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20322 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20323 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20324 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20325 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20326 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20327 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20328 automatically suppress them.
20329
20330
20331 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20332 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20333 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20334 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20335 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20336 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20337
20338
20339 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20340 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20341 deliveries by the transport or for any
20342 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20343 what you are doing.
20344
20345
20346 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20347 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20348 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20349 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20350 transport is run.
20351 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20352 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20353 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20354 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20355 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20356 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20357 one.
20358 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20359 transport and the router that called it.
20360
20361 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20362 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20363 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20364 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20365 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20366 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20367 safely be resent to other recipients.
20368
20369
20370 .option driver transports string unset
20371 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20372 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20373
20374
20375 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20376 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20377 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20378 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20379 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20380 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20381 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20382 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20383 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20384 resent to other recipients.
20385
20386
20387 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20388 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20389 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20390 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20391 &%user%& (see below).
20392
20393
20394 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20395 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20396 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20397 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20398 .new
20399 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20400 .wen
20401 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20402 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20403 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20404 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20405 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20406 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20407
20408 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20409 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20410
20411
20412 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20413 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20414 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20415 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20416 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20417 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20418 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20419 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20420
20421
20422 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20423 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20424 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20425 This option specifies a list of header names,
20426 .new
20427 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20428 .wen
20429 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20430 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20431 routers.
20432 Each list item is separately expanded.
20433 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20434 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20435 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20436
20437 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20438 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20439
20440
20441
20442 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20443 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20444 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20445 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20446 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20447 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20448 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20449 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20450 example,
20451 .code
20452 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20453 x@y w@z
20454 .endd
20455 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20456 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20457 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20458 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20459 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20460 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20461 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20462 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20463 change envelope recipients at this time.
20464
20465
20466 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20467 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20468 .vindex "&$home$&"
20469 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20470 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20471 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20472 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20473 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20474 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20475 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20476 deferred.
20477
20478
20479 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20480 .cindex "additional groups"
20481 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20482 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20483 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20484 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20485 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20486
20487
20488 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20489 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20490 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20491 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20492 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20493 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20494 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20495 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20496 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20497 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20498 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20499 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20500 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20501 delivered.
20502
20503
20504
20505 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20506 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20507 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20508 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20509 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20510 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20511 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20512 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20513 that contains
20514 .code
20515 local_part_prefix = *-
20516 .endd
20517 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20518 is delivered with
20519 .code
20520 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20521 .endd
20522 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20523 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20524 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20525 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20526 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20527
20528
20529 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20530 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20531 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20532 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20533 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20534 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20535 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20536 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20537 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20538
20539 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20540 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20541 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20542 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20543
20544 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20545 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20546 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20547
20548
20549 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20550 .cindex "envelope sender"
20551 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20552 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20553 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20554 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20555 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20556 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20557 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20558 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20559 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20560
20561 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20562 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20563
20564 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20565 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20566 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20567 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20568 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20569 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20570 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20571
20572 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20573 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20574 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20575 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20576 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20577
20578
20579
20580 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20581 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20582 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20583 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20584 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20585 have easy access to it.
20586
20587 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20588 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20589 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20590 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20591 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20592 recipients.
20593
20594
20595 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20596 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20597
20598
20599 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20600 .cindex "shadow transport"
20601 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20602 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20603 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20604
20605 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20606 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20607 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20608 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20609 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20610 cause a log line to be written.
20611
20612 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20613 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20614 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20615 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20616 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20617 of the form
20618 .code
20619 ST=<shadow transport name>
20620 .endd
20621 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20622 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20623 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20624 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20625 headers that some sites insist on.
20626
20627
20628 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20629 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20630 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20631 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20632 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20633 individual users or via a system filter.
20634
20635 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20636 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20637 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20638 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20639 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20640
20641 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20642 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20643 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20644 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20645 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20646 &(pipe)& transports.
20647
20648 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20649 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20650 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20651 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20652 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20653
20654 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20655 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20656 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20657 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20658
20659 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20660 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20661 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20662 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20663 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20664 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20665
20666 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20667 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20668 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20669 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20670 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20671 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20672 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20673 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20674
20675 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20676 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20677 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20678 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20679 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20680 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20681 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20682 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20683 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20684 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20685
20686 .vindex "&$host$&"
20687 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20688 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20689 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20690 which the message is being sent. For example:
20691 .code
20692 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20693 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20694 .endd
20695
20696 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20697 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20698 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20699 .ilist
20700 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20701 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20702 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20703 example:
20704 .code
20705 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20706 .endd
20707 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20708 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20709 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20710 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20711 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20712 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20713 .next
20714 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20715 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20716 arguments. Consider this example:
20717 .code
20718 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20719 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20720 .endd
20721 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20722 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20723 .code
20724 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20725 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20726 .endd
20727 .endlist
20728
20729 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20730 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20731 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20732 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20733 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20734 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20735 bounced from a transport filter.
20736
20737 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20738 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20739 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20740
20741
20742 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20743 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20744 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20745 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20746 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20747 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20748 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20749 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20750 becomes a temporary error.
20751
20752
20753 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20754 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20755 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20756 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20757 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20758 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20759 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20760 option is not set.
20761
20762 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20763 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20764 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20765
20766 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20767 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20768 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20769 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20770 retry data.
20771 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20772 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20773 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20774
20775
20776
20777
20778
20779
20780 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20781 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20782
20783 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20784 "Address batching"
20785 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20786 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20787 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20788 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20789 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20790 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20791 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20792
20793 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20794 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20795 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20796 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20797 local transport, for example:
20798
20799 .ilist
20800 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20801 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20802 recipients saves space.
20803 .next
20804 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20805 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20806 .next
20807 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20808 to a scanner program or
20809 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20810 acceptable.
20811 .endlist
20812
20813 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20814 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20815 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20816
20817 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20818 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20819 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20820 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20821 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20822 to certain conditions:
20823
20824 .ilist
20825 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20826 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20827 batching is possible.
20828 .next
20829 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20830 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20831 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20832 .next
20833 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20834 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20835 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20836 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20837 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20838 from taking place.
20839 .next
20840 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20841 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20842 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20843 be the same.
20844 .endlist
20845
20846 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20847 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20848 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20849 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20850 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20851 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20852 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20853 .code
20854 check_string = "."
20855 escape_string = ".."
20856 .endd
20857 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20858 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20859 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20860
20861 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20862 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20863 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20864 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20865 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20866 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20867
20868 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20869 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20870 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20871 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20872 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20873 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20874 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20875 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20876 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20877
20878
20879
20880
20881 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20883
20884 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20885 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20886 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20887 .cindex "directory creation"
20888 .cindex "creating directories"
20889 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20890 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20891 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20892 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20893 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20894 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20895 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20896 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20897 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20898 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20899
20900 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20901 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20902 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20903 included.
20904
20905 .cindex "quota" "system"
20906 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20907 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20908 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20909
20910 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20911 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20912 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20913 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20914
20915 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20916 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20917 private options.
20918
20919 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20920 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20921 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20922 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20923 option).
20924
20925
20926
20927 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20928 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20929 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20930 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20931 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20932
20933 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20934 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20935 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20936 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20937 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20938 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20939 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20940 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20941 operation. There are two cases:
20942
20943 .ilist
20944 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20945 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20946 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20947 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20948 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20949 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20950 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20951 .next
20952 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20953 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20954 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20955 .endlist
20956
20957
20958 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20959 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20960 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20961 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20962 form:
20963 .code
20964 save folder23
20965 .endd
20966 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20967 .code
20968 require "fileinto";
20969 fileinto "folder23";
20970 .endd
20971 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20972 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20973 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20974 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20975 way of handling this requirement:
20976 .code
20977 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20978 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20979 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20980 {$address_file} \
20981 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20982 }} \
20983 }
20984 .endd
20985 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20986 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20987 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20988
20989 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20990 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20991 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20992 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20993 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20994 path to the transport.
20995
20996 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20997 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20998
20999
21000
21001
21002 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21003 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21004
21005
21006
21007 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21008 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21009 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21010 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21011 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21012 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21013 delivery is deferred.
21014
21015
21016 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21017 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21018 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21019 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21020 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21021 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21022 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21023 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21024
21025
21026 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21027 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21028 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21029 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21030 file.
21031
21032
21033 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21034 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21035
21036
21037 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21038 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21039 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21040 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21041 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21042
21043
21044 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21045 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21046 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21047 process is running.
21048
21049
21050 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21051 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21052 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21053 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21054 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21055 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21056 contains is significant.
21057
21058 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21059 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21060 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21061 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21062 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21063
21064 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21065 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21066 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21067 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21068 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21069 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21070 .code
21071 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21072 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21073 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21074 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21075 .endd
21076 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21077 .cindex "directory creation"
21078 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21079 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21080 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21081
21082 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21083 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21084 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21085 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21086 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21087
21088
21089
21090 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21091 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21092 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21093 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21094 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21095 beneath.
21096
21097 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21098 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21099 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21100 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21101 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21102 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21103 &%file_must_exist%&.
21104
21105
21106 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21107 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21108 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21109 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21110
21111 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21112 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21113 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21114 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21115 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21116
21117
21118 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21119 .cindex "base62"
21120 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21121 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21122 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21123 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21124 .code
21125 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21126 .endd
21127 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21128 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21129 option.
21130
21131
21132 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21133 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21134 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21135
21136
21137 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21138 See &%check_string%& above.
21139
21140
21141 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21142 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21143 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21144 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21145 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21146 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21147 &%file%&.
21148
21149 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21150 .cindex "locking files"
21151 .cindex "lock files"
21152 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21153 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21154
21155 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21156 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21157 examples:
21158 .code
21159 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21160 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21161 file = $home/inbox
21162 .endd
21163 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21164 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21165 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21166 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21167 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21168 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21169
21170
21171
21172 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21173 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21174 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21175 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21176 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21177 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21178 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21179 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21180 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21181 this added to it:
21182 .code
21183 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21184 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21185 .endd
21186 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21187 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21188 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21189 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21190 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21191 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21192 delivery is deferred.
21193
21194
21195 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21196 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21197 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21198 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21199
21200
21201 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21202 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21203 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21204 .cindex "locking files"
21205 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21206 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21207 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21208 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21209 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21210 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21211 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21212 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21213
21214 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21215 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21216 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21217 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21218
21219 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21220 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21221 retries is
21222 .code
21223 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21224 .endd
21225 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21226 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21227 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21228
21229 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21230 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21231 .code
21232 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21233 .endd
21234
21235 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21236 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21237 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21238 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21239
21240
21241 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21242 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21243 for details of locking.
21244
21245
21246 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21247 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21248 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21249
21250
21251 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21252 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21253 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21254
21255
21256 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21257 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21258 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21259 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21260 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21261
21262
21263 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21264 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21265 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21266 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21267 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21268 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21269 external source that maintains the data.
21270
21271
21272 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21273 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21274 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21275 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21276 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21277 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21278 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21279 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21280
21281
21282
21283 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21284 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21285 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21286 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21287 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21288 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21289 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21290 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21291 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21292 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21293
21294
21295 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21296 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21297 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21298 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21299 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21300 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21301 calculation. The default value is:
21302 .code
21303 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21304 .endd
21305 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21306 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21307 &_Trash_&
21308 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21309 .code
21310 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21311 .endd
21312 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21313 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21314 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21315 directly into that directory.
21316
21317
21318 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21319 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21320 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21321
21322
21323 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21324 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21325 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21326
21327
21328 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21329 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21330 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21331 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21332 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21333 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21334 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21335 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21336
21337 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21338 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21339 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21340 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21341 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21342 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21343 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21344 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21345 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21346 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21347
21348
21349 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21350 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21351 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21352 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21353 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21354 below for further details.
21355
21356
21357 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21358 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21359 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21360
21361
21362 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21363 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21364 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21365
21366
21367 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21368 .cindex "locking files"
21369 .cindex "file" "locking"
21370 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21371 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21372 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21373 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21374 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21375 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21376 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21377
21378 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21379 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21380 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21381 combination:
21382 .code
21383 mbx_format = true
21384 message_prefix =
21385 message_suffix =
21386 .endd
21387 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21388 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21389 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21390 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21391 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21392 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21393 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21394 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21395
21396 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21397 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21398 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21399 append messages to it.
21400
21401
21402 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21403 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21404 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21405 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21406 in which case it is:
21407 .code
21408 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21409 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21410 .endd
21411 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21412 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21413
21414 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21415 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21416 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21417 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21418 setting
21419 .code
21420 message_suffix =
21421 .endd
21422 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21423 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21424
21425 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21426 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21427 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21428 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21429 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21430 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21431 value, and this option is ignored.
21432
21433
21434 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21435 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21436 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21437 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21438 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21439
21440
21441 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21442 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21443 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21444 on users about incoming mail.
21445
21446
21447 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21448 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21449 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21450 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21451 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21452 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21453 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21454 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21455 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21456
21457 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21458 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21459 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21460
21461 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21462 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21463 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21464 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21465 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21466 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21467
21468 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21469 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21470 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21471 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21472 be handled.
21473
21474 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21475
21476 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21477 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21478 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21479 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21480 system quota failures.
21481
21482 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21483 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21484 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21485 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21486 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21487 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21488 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21489 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21490 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21491 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21492
21493
21494 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21495 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21496 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21497 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21498 delivery directory.
21499
21500
21501 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21502 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21503 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21504 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21505 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21506 &"no quota"&.
21507
21508
21509 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21510 See &%quota%& above.
21511
21512
21513 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21514 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21515 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21516 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21517 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21518 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21519 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21520
21521 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21522 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21523 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21524 the file length to the file name. For example:
21525 .code
21526 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21527 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21528 .endd
21529 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21530 number of lines in the message.
21531
21532 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21533 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21534 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21535
21536 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21537
21538
21539 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21540 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21541 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21542 .code
21543 quota_warn_message = "\
21544 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21545 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21546 This message is automatically created \
21547 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21548 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21549 a warning threshold that is\n\
21550 set by the system administrator.\n"
21551 .endd
21552
21553
21554 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21555 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21556 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21557 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21558 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21559 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21560 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21561 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21562 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21563 sign. For example:
21564 .code
21565 quota = 10M
21566 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21567 .endd
21568 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21569 percent sign is ignored.
21570
21571 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21572 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21573 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21574 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21575 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21576 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21577 .code
21578 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21579 .endd
21580 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21581 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21582 option.
21583
21584 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21585 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21586 percentage.
21587
21588
21589 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21590 .cindex "envelope sender"
21591 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21592 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21593 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21594 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21595 for details of batch SMTP.
21596
21597
21598 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21599 .cindex "carriage return"
21600 .cindex "linefeed"
21601 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21602 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21603 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21604 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21605
21606 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21607 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21608 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21609 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21610 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21611 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21612
21613
21614 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21615 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21616 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21617 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21618 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21619 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21620
21621
21622 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21623 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21624 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21625 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21626 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21627
21628 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21629 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21630 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21631 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21632
21633 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21634 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21635 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21636 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21637 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21638 error.
21639
21640 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21641 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21642
21643
21644 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21645 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21646 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21647 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21648 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21649 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21650 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21651
21652 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21653 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21654 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21655 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21656 file corruption.
21657
21658 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21659 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21660 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21661
21662
21663 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21664 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21665 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21666 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21667 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21668 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21669 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21670 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21671 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21672
21673 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21674 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21675 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21676 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21677
21678
21679
21680
21681 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21682 .cindex "appending to a file"
21683 .cindex "file" "appending"
21684 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21685
21686 .ilist
21687 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21688 return is given.
21689
21690 .next
21691 .cindex "directory creation"
21692 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21693 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21694 &%directory_mode%& option.
21695
21696 .next
21697 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21698 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21699 transport.
21700
21701 .next
21702 .cindex "file" "locking"
21703 .cindex "locking files"
21704 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21705 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21706 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21707
21708 .olist
21709 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21710 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21711 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21712 .next
21713 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21714 .next
21715 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21716 Unlink the hitching post name.
21717 .next
21718 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21719 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21720 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21721 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21722 .next
21723 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21724 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21725 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21726 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21727 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21728 it before trying again.
21729 .endlist olist
21730
21731 .next
21732 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21733 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21734 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21735
21736 .next
21737 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21738 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21739 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21740 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21741 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21742 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21743 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21744 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21745 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21746 checked.
21747
21748 .next
21749 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21750 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21751 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21752 delivery is deferred.
21753
21754 .next
21755 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21756 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21757 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21758 permissions.
21759
21760 .next
21761 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21762 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21763 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21764
21765 .next
21766 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21767 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21768 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21769
21770 .next
21771 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21772 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21773 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21774 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21775 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21776 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21777 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21778 that prevents link following.
21779
21780 .next
21781 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21782 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21783 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21784 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21785 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21786
21787 .next
21788 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21789
21790 .next
21791 .cindex "file" "locking"
21792 .cindex "locking files"
21793 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21794 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21795 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21796 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21797 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21798 .code
21799 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21800 .endd
21801 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21802 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21803 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21804
21805 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21806 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21807 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21808
21809 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21810 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21811 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21812 delivery is deferred.
21813
21814 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21815 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21816 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21817 immediately. It retries up to
21818 .code
21819 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21820 .endd
21821 times (rounded up).
21822 .endlist
21823
21824 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21825 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21826
21827
21828 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21829 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21830 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21831 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21832 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21833 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21834 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21835 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21836 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21837 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21838
21839 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21840 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21841 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21842 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21843 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21844 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21845 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21846
21847 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21848 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21849 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21850 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21851
21852
21853 .cindex "maildir format"
21854 .cindex "mailstore format"
21855 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21856 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21857 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21858 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21859 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21860
21861 .cindex "directory creation"
21862 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21863 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21864 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21865 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21866 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21867 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21868 deferred.
21869
21870
21871
21872 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21873 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21874 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21875 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21876 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21877 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21878 &_new_& subdirectory.
21879
21880 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21881 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21882 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21883 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21884 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21885 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21886 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21887
21888 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21889 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21890 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21891 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21892 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21893 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21894 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21895 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21896
21897 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21898 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21899 folders. Consider this example:
21900 .code
21901 maildir_format = true
21902 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21903 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21904 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21905 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21906 .endd
21907 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21908 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21909 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21910 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21911 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21912 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21913
21914 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21915 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21916 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21917 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21918 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21919
21920 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21921 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21922 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21923
21924 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21925 .cindex "maildir++"
21926 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21927 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21928 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21929 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21930 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21931 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21932 amount of space used.
21933
21934 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21935 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21936 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21937 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21938 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21939 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21940
21941
21942
21943
21944 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21945 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21946 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21947 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21948 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21949 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21950
21951
21952 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21953 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21954 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21955 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21956 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21957 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21958 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21959 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21960 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21961 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21962 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21963 backwards compatibility).
21964
21965 For one common implementation, you might set:
21966 .code
21967 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21968 .endd
21969 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21970
21971 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21972 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21973 &[stat()]& each message file.
21974
21975
21976 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21977 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21978 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21979 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21980 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21981 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21982 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21983 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21984 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21985
21986 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21987 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21988 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21989 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21990 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21991 need to know the quota.
21992
21993 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21994 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21995
21996 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21997 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21998 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21999 details.
22000
22001
22002 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22003 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22004 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22005 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22006 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22007 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22008 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22009 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22010
22011 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22012 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22013 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22014 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22015 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22016 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22017
22018 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22019 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22020 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22021 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22022 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22023 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22024
22025 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22026 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22027 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22028 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22029
22030
22031 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22032 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22033 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22034 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22035 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22036 .code
22037 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22038 .endd
22039 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22040 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22041 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22042 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22043 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22044
22045
22046
22047
22048
22049
22050 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22052
22053 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22054 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22055 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22056 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22057 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22058 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22059 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22060 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22061
22062 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22063 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22064 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22065 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22066 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22067
22068
22069 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22070 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22071 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22072 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22073 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22074
22075 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22076 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22077 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22078 transport is run as a consequence of a
22079 &%mail%&
22080 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22081 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22082 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22083 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22084 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22085 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22086
22087 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22088 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22089 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22090 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22091
22092 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22093 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22094 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22095 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22096 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22097 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22098 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22099
22100 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22101 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22102 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22103 the transport defers.
22104 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22105 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22106
22107 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22108 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22109 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22110 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22111
22112 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22113 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22114 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22115 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22116 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22117 problems. They are just discarded.
22118
22119
22120
22121 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22122 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22123
22124 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22125 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22126 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22127
22128
22129 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22130 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22131 when the message is specified by the transport.
22132
22133
22134 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22135 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22136 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22137 string comes first.
22138
22139
22140 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22141 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22142 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22143
22144
22145 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22146 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22147 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22148
22149
22150 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22151 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22152 specified by the transport.
22153
22154
22155 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22156 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22157 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22158 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22159
22160
22161 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22162 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22163 the message is specified by the transport.
22164
22165
22166 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22167 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22168 used.
22169
22170
22171 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22172 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22173 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22174 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22175 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22176
22177
22178
22179 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22180 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22181 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22182 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22183
22184 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22185 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22186 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22187 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22188 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22189 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22190 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22191 infinity.
22192
22193 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22194 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22195 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22196 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22197 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22198
22199 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22200 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22201 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22202 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22203 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22204 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22205
22206
22207 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22208 See &%once%& above.
22209
22210
22211 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22212 See &%once%& above.
22213 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22214
22215
22216 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22217 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22218 specified by the transport.
22219
22220
22221 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22222 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22223 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22224 configuration option.
22225
22226
22227 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22228 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22229 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22230 automatic responses. For example:
22231 .code
22232 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22233 .endd
22234 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22235 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22236 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22237 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22238 small.
22239
22240
22241
22242 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22243 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22244 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22245 the text comes first.
22246
22247
22248 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22249 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22250 when the message is specified by the transport.
22251 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22252 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22253
22254
22255
22256
22257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22258 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22259
22260 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22261 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22262 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22263 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22264 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22265 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22266 specified command
22267 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22268 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22269 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22270 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22271 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22272 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22273 .code
22274 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22275 .endd
22276 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22277 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22278 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22279 as follows:
22280
22281 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22282 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22283
22284
22285 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22286 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22287 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22288 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22289 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22290
22291
22292 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22293 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22294 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22295 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22296 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22297 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22298 LMTP protocol.
22299
22300 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22301 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22302 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22303 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22304 in its response to the LHLO command.
22305
22306 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22307 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22308 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22309 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22310
22311
22312 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22313 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22314 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22315 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22316 LMTP transport:
22317 .code
22318 lmtp:
22319 driver = lmtp
22320 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22321 batch_max = 20
22322 user = exim
22323 .endd
22324 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22325 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22326
22327
22328
22329 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22331
22332 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22333 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22334 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22335 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22336 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22337 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22338 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22339 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22340 following ways:
22341
22342 .ilist
22343 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22344 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22345 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22346 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22347 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22348 .next
22349 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22350 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22351 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22352 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22353 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22354 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22355 that are routed to the transport.
22356 .next
22357 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22358 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22359 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22360 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22361 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22362 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22363 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22364 .endlist
22365
22366
22367 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22368 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22369 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22370
22371 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22372 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22373 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22374 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22375 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22376 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22377 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22378
22379
22380 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22381 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22382 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22383 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22384 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22385
22386
22387
22388
22389 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22390 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22391 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22392 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22393 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22394 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22395 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22396 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22397 &"local delivery failed"&.
22398
22399 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22400 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22401 will be sent as normal.
22402
22403 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22404 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22405 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22406 apply in this case.
22407
22408 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22409 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22410 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22411 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22412
22413 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22414 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22415 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22416 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22417 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22418 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22419 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22420 &%temp_errors%&.
22421
22422
22423
22424 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22425 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22426 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22427 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22428 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22429 run.
22430
22431 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22432 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22433 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22434 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22435
22436 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22437 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22438 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22439 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22440 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22441 .code
22442 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22443 .endd
22444 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22445 arguments. You have to write
22446 .code
22447 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22448 .endd
22449 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22450 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22451 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22452 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22453 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22454 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22455 example:
22456 .code
22457 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22458 .endd
22459
22460 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22461 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22462 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22463 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22464 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22465 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22466 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22467 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22468 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22469 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22470
22471 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22472 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22473 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22474 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22475 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22476 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22477 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22478 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22479
22480 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22481 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22482 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22483 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22484 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22485 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22486 control what is done with it.
22487
22488 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22489 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22490 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22491 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22492 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22493 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22494 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22495 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22496 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22497 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22498 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22499
22500
22501
22502 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22503 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22504 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22505 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22506 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22507 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22508 environment.
22509 .display
22510 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22511 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22512 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22513 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22514 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22515 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22516 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22517 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22518 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22519 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22520 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22521 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22522 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22523 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22524 &`USER `& see below
22525 .endd
22526 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22527 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22528 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22529 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22530 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22531 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22532 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22533
22534 .cindex "HOST"
22535 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22536 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22537 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22538 the router.
22539
22540 .cindex "HOME"
22541 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22542 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22543 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22544 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22545
22546
22547 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22548 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22549
22550
22551
22552 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22553 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22554 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22555 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22556 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22557 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22558 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22559 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22560 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22561 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22562 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22563 example, if
22564 .code
22565 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22566 .endd
22567 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22568 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22569 &%use_shell%& is set.
22570
22571
22572 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22573 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22574
22575
22576 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22577 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22578 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22579
22580
22581 .option check_string pipe string unset
22582 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22583 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22584 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22585 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22586 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22587 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22588 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22589 ignored.
22590
22591
22592 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22593 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22594 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22595 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22596 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22597 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22598 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22599
22600
22601 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22602 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22603 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22604 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22605 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22606 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22607 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22608
22609
22610 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22611 See &%check_string%& above.
22612
22613
22614 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22615 .cindex "exec failure"
22616 .cindex "failure of exec"
22617 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22618 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22619 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22620 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22621 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22622
22623
22624 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22625 .cindex "signal exit"
22626 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22627 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22628 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22629 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22630
22631
22632 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22633 .cindex "force command"
22634 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22635 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22636 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22637 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22638 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22639 command. For example:
22640 .code
22641 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22642 force_command
22643 .endd
22644
22645 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22646 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22647 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22648
22649 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22650 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22651 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22652 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22653 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22654 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22655
22656 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22657 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22658
22659 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22660 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22661 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22662 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22663 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22664
22665
22666 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22667 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22668 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22669 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22670 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22671 Only one of them may be set.
22672
22673
22674
22675 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22676 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22677 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22678 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22679
22680
22681
22682 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22683 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22684 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22685 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22686 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22687 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22688 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22689 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22690
22691
22692 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22693 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22694 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22695 .code
22696 message_prefix = \
22697 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22698 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22699 .endd
22700 .cindex "Cyrus"
22701 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22702 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22703 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22704 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22705 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22706 setting
22707 .code
22708 message_prefix =
22709 .endd
22710 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22711 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22712
22713
22714 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22715 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22716 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22717 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22718 .code
22719 message_suffix =
22720 .endd
22721 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22722 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22723
22724
22725 .option path pipe string "see below"
22726 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22727 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22728 .code
22729 /bin:/usr/bin
22730 .endd
22731 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22732 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22733 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22734
22735
22736 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22737 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22738 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22739 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22740 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22741 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22742 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22743 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22744 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22745
22746
22747 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22748 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22749 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22750 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22751 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22752 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22753 accept the message is used.
22754
22755
22756 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22757 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22758 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22759 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22760 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22761 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22762
22763
22764 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22765 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22766 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22767 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22768 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22769 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22770 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22771
22772
22773
22774 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22775 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22776 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22777 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22778 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22779 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22780 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22781 of them may be set.
22782
22783
22784
22785 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22786 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22787 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22788 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22789 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22790 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22791 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22792 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22793 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22794 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22795 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22796 and 73, respectively.
22797
22798
22799 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22800 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22801 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22802 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22803 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22804 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22805 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22806
22807 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22808 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22809 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22810 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22811 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22812 delivery to be deferred.
22813
22814 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22815 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22816
22817
22818 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22819 .cindex "envelope sender"
22820 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22821 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22822 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22823 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22824 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22825
22826 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22827 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22828 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22829 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22830 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22831 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22832 class database.
22833
22834
22835 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22836 .cindex "carriage return"
22837 .cindex "linefeed"
22838 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22839 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22840 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22841 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22842
22843 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22844 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22845 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22846 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22847 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22848
22849
22850 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22851 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22852 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22853 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22854 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22855 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22856 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22857 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22858 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22859 its &%-c%& option.
22860
22861
22862
22863 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22864 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22865 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22866 .cindex "external local delivery"
22867 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22868 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22869 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22870 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22871 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22872 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22873 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22874 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22875 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22876 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22877 .code
22878 # transport
22879 procmail_pipe:
22880 driver = pipe
22881 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22882 return_path_add
22883 delivery_date_add
22884 envelope_to_add
22885 check_string = "From "
22886 escape_string = ">From "
22887 umask = 077
22888 user = $local_part
22889 group = mail
22890
22891 # router
22892 procmail:
22893 driver = accept
22894 check_local_user
22895 transport = procmail_pipe
22896 .endd
22897 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22898 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22899 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22900 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22901 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22902 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22903
22904 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22905 .code
22906 IFS=" "
22907 .endd
22908 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22909 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22910
22911 .cindex "Cyrus"
22912 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22913 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22914 .code
22915 # transport
22916 local_delivery_cyrus:
22917 driver = pipe
22918 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22919 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22920 user = cyrus
22921 group = mail
22922 return_output
22923 log_output
22924 message_prefix =
22925 message_suffix =
22926
22927 # router
22928 local_user_cyrus:
22929 driver = accept
22930 check_local_user
22931 local_part_suffix = .*
22932 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22933 .endd
22934 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22935 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22936 sender.
22937 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22938 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22939
22940
22941 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22943
22944 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22945 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22946 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22947 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22948 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22949 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22950 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22951 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22952
22953
22954 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22955 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22956 two ways:
22957
22958 .ilist
22959 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22960 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22961 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22962 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22963 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22964 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22965 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22966 .next
22967 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22968 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22969 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22970 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22971 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22972 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22973 process.
22974 .endlist
22975
22976
22977 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22978 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22979 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22980
22981
22982
22983 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22984 .vindex "&$host$&"
22985 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22986 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22987 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22988 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22989 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22990 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22991 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22992 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22993
22994
22995 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22996 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22997 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22998 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22999 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23000 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23001 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23002 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23003 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23004 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23005 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23006 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23007 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23008 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23009
23010 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23011 and will be removed in a future release.
23012
23013
23014 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23015 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23016 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23017
23018
23019 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23020 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23021 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23022 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23023 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23024 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23025 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23026 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23027
23028 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23029 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23030 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23031 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23032 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23033 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23034 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23035 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23036 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23037
23038
23039 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23040 .cindex "Cyrus"
23041 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23042 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23043 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23044 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23045 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23046 ignored.
23047
23048 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23049 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23050 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23051 particular connection.
23052
23053 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23054 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23055 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23056 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23057
23058 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23059 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23060 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23061 .code
23062 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23063 .endd
23064 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23065 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23066
23067 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23068 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23069 value.
23070
23071
23072 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23073 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23074 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23075 authenticated as a client.
23076
23077
23078 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23079 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23080 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23081 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23082
23083
23084 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23085 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23086 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23087 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23088 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23089 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23090 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23091
23092
23093 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23094 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23095 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23096 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23097 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23098 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23099 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23100 option.
23101
23102
23103 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23104 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23105 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23106 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23107
23108
23109 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23110 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23111 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23112 cutoff times.
23113
23114 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23115 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23116 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23117 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23118 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23119 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23120
23121 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23122 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23123 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23124 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23125 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23126 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23127 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23128 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23129 to them.
23130
23131
23132 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23133 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23134 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23135 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23136 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23137
23138
23139 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23140 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23141 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23142 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23143 details.
23144
23145
23146 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23147 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23148 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23149 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23150 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23151 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23152 the dnssec request bit set.
23153 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23154
23155
23156
23157 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23158 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23159 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23160 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23161 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23162 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23163 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23164 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23165 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23166
23167
23168
23169 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23170 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23171 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23172 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23173 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23174 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23175 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23176
23177 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23178 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23179 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23180 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23181 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23182
23183
23184 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23185 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23186 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23187 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23188 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23189 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23190 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23191 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23192
23193 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23194 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23195 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23196 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23197 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23198 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23199
23200 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23201 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23202 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23203 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23204 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23205
23206 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23207 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23208 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23209 copy of the message is sent.
23210
23211 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23212 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23213 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23214 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23215 fails"& facility.
23216
23217
23218 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23219 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23220 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23221 zero.
23222
23223 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23224 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23225 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23226 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23227 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23228 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23229
23230 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23231 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23232 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23233 implementations of TLS.
23234
23235 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23236 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23237 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23238 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23239 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23240 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23241 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23242 option is:
23243 .code
23244 $primary_hostname
23245 .endd
23246 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23247 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23248 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23249 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23250 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23251 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23252 interface address, you could use this:
23253 .code
23254 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23255 {$primary_hostname}}
23256 .endd
23257 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23258 callouts.
23259
23260 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23261 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23262 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23263 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23264 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23265 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23266
23267 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23268 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23269 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23270 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23271
23272 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23273 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23274 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23275 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23276 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23277 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23278 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23279
23280 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23281 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23282 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23283 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23284 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23285 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23286 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23287 address are used.
23288
23289 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23290 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23291
23292
23293 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23294 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23295 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23296 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23297 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23298 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23299 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23300 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23301 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23302 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23303
23304
23305 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23306 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23307 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23308 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23309
23310
23311 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23312 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23313 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23314 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23315
23316 .new
23317 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23318 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23319 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23320 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23321 to any host that matches this list.
23322 .wen
23323
23324
23325 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23326 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23327 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23328 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23329 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23330 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23331 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23332 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23333
23334
23335 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23336 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23337 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23338 why it exists.
23339
23340
23341
23342 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23343 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23344 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23345 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23346 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23347 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23348 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23349 explanation of when this might be needed.
23350
23351
23352 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23353 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23354 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23355 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23356 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23357
23358
23359 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23360 .cindex "randomized host list"
23361 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23362 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23363 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23364 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23365 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23366 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23367 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23368 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23369
23370 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23371 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23372 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23373 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23374 .code
23375 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23376 .endd
23377 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23378 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23379 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23380
23381 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23382 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23383 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23384 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23385 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23386 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23387 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23388 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23389 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23390
23391
23392 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23393 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23394 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23395 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23396 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23397
23398 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23399 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23400 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23401 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23402 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23403
23404 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23405 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23406 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23407 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23408 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23409 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23410
23411 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23412 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23413 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23414 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23415 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23416 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23417 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23418
23419 .new
23420 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23421 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23422 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23423 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23424 for multi-recipient messages.
23425 The option can usually be left as default.
23426 .wen
23427
23428 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23429 .cindex "bind IP address"
23430 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23431 .vindex "&$host$&"
23432 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23433 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23434 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23435 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23436 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23437 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23438 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23439 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23440 unknown.
23441
23442 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23443 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23444 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23445 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23446 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23447 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23448 .code
23449 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23450 .endd
23451 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23452 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23453 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23454 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23455
23456
23457 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23458 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23459 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23460 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23461 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23462 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23463 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23464 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23465 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23466 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23467 unreachable hosts.
23468
23469
23470 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23471 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23472 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23473 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23474 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23475
23476 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23477 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23478 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23479 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23480 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23481 permits this.
23482
23483
23484 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23485 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23486 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23487 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23488 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23489 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23490 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23491 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23492
23493 .new
23494 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23495 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23496 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23497 .wen
23498
23499 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23500 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23501 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23502 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23503 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23504 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23505 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23506 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23507
23508 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23509 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23510 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23511 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23512 is deferred.
23513
23514
23515
23516 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23517 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23518 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23519 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23520 .vindex "&$port$&"
23521 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23522 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23523 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23524 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23525 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23526
23527 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
23528 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23529 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23530 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23531
23532
23533 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23534 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23535 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23536 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23537 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23538 addresses is not affected.
23539
23540 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23541 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23542 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23543 Exim to use only the host name.
23544 .new
23545 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23546 .wen
23547
23548
23549 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23550 .cindex "serializing connections"
23551 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23552 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23553 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23554 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23555 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23556 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23557 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23558
23559 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23560 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23561 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23562 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23563 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23564 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23565
23566 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23567 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23568 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23569 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23570 are used for ETRN serialization.
23571
23572
23573 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23574 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23575 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23576 .cindex "size" "of message"
23577 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23578 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23579 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23580 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23581 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23582 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23583 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23584 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23585
23586 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23587 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23588
23589
23590 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23591 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23592 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23593 .vindex "&$host$&"
23594 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23595 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23596 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23597 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23598 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23599 details of TLS.
23600
23601 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23602 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23603 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23604 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23605 client.
23606
23607
23608 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23609 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23610 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23611 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23612 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23613
23614
23615 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23616 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23617 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23618 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23619 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23620 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23621 will fail.
23622
23623 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23624
23625
23626 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23627 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23628 .vindex "&$host$&"
23629 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23630 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23631 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23632 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23633 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23634 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23635 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23636 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23637
23638
23639 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23640 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23641 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23642 .vindex "&$host$&"
23643 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23644 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23645 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23646 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23647 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23648 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23649 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23650 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23651 ciphers is a preference order.
23652
23653
23654
23655 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23656 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23657 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23658 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23659 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23660 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23661 certificate and private key for the session.
23662
23663 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23664
23665 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23666 TLS extensions.
23667
23668
23669
23670
23671 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23672 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23673 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23674 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23675 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23676 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23677 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23678 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23679 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23680 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23681 in clear.
23682
23683
23684 .new
23685 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23686 .wen
23687 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23688 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23689 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23690 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23691 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23692 Note that unless the host is in this list
23693 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23694 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23695 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23696 certificate verification succeeds.
23697
23698
23699 .new
23700 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23701 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23702 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23703 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23704 while verifying the server certificate,
23705 checks will be included on the host name
23706 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23707 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23708 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23709
23710 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23711 .wen
23712
23713
23714 .new
23715 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23716 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23717 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23718 .vindex "&$host$&"
23719 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23720 The value of this option must be either the
23721 word "system"
23722 or the absolute path to
23723 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23724 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23725
23726 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23727 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23728 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23729 must be specified.
23730
23731 The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
23732 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23733 .wen
23734
23735 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23736 explicitly
23737 either by file or directory
23738 are added to those given by the system default location.
23739
23740 The values of &$host$& and
23741 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23742 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23743
23744 For back-compatability,
23745 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23746 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23747 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23748
23749
23750 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23751 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23752 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23753 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23754 certificate verification must succeed.
23755 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23756 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23757 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23758
23759
23760
23761
23762 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23763 "SECTvalhosmax"
23764 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23765 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23766 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23767 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23768 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23769
23770
23771 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23772 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23773 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23774 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23775 retrying.
23776
23777 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23778 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23779 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23780
23781 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23782 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23783 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23784 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23785 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23786
23787 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23788 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23789 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23790 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23791 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23792 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23793 see below for an exception).
23794
23795 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23796 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23797 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23798 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23799 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23800
23801 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23802 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23803 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23804 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23805 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23806 reached their retry times.
23807
23808 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23809 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23810 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23811 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23812 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23813 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23814 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23815 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23816 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23817 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23818 reached.
23819
23820 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23821 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23822 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23823 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23824 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23825 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23826
23827 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23828 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23829 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23830 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23831 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23832 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23833
23834
23835
23836
23837
23838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23839 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23840
23841 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23842 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23843 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23844 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23845 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23846 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23847
23848 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23849 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23850 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23851 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23852 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23853 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23854 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23855
23856 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23857 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23858 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23859 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23860
23861
23862 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23863 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23864 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23865 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23866
23867 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23868 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23869 facility; you do not have to use it.
23870
23871 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23872 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23873 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23874 address to which it applies.
23875
23876 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23877 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23878 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23879 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23880 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23881 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23882 rules.
23883
23884 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23885 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23886 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23887 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23888
23889
23890 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23891 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23892 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23893 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23894 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23895 discouraged.
23896
23897 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23898 illustrated by these examples:
23899
23900 .ilist
23901 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23902 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23903 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23904 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23905 .next
23906 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23907 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23908 .endlist
23909
23910
23911
23912 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23913 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23914 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23915 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23916 message's processing.
23917
23918 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23919 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23920 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23921 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23922 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23923 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23924 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23925 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23926 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23927
23928 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23929 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23930 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23931 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23932 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23933 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23934 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23935 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23936 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23937 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23938
23939 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23940 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23941 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23942 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23943 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23944 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23945
23946 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23947 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23948 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23949
23950 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23951 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23952 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23953 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23954 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23955 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23956 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23957 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23958 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23959
23960 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23961 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23962 transport time.
23963
23964
23965
23966
23967 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23968 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23969 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23970 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23971 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23972 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23973 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23974 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23975 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23976 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23977 .code
23978 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23979 .endd
23980 might produce the output
23981 .code
23982 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23983 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23984 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23985 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23986 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23987 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23988 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23989 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23990 .endd
23991 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23992 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23993 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23994 set for a particular transport.
23995
23996
23997 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23998 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23999 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24000 rules in the form
24001 .display
24002 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24003 .endd
24004 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24005 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24006 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24007 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24008
24009 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24010 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24011 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24012 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24013 ignored.
24014
24015 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24016 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24017 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24018
24019 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24020 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24021 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24022 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24023 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24024 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24025 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24026
24027 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24028 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24029 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24030 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24031 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24032 .code
24033 *@* ${lookup ...
24034 .endd
24035 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24036 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24037
24038
24039 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24040 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24041 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24042 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24043 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24044 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24045 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24046 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24047 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24048
24049 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24050 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24051 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24052
24053 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24054 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24055 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24056 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24057 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24058 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24059 of pattern they are set as follows:
24060
24061 .ilist
24062 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24063 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24064 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24065 pattern
24066 .code
24067 *queen@*.fict.example
24068 .endd
24069 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24070 .code
24071 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24072 $1 = hearts-
24073 $2 = wonderland
24074 .endd
24075 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24076 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24077
24078 .next
24079 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24080 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24081 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24082 rewriting rule of the form
24083 .display
24084 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24085 .endd
24086 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24087 .code
24088 $1 = foo
24089 $2 = bar
24090 $3 = baz.example
24091 .endd
24092 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24093 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24094 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24095 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24096 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24097 .endlist
24098
24099
24100 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24101 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24102 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24103 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24104 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24105 .code
24106 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24107 .endd
24108 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24109 &'From:'& headers.
24110
24111 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24112 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24113 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24114 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24115 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24116 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24117 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24118 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24119 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24120 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24121 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24122 entry written to the panic log.
24123
24124
24125
24126 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24127 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24128
24129 .ilist
24130 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24131 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24132 .next
24133 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24134 .next
24135 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24136 .endlist
24137
24138 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24139 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24140
24141
24142
24143 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24144 "SECID154"
24145 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24146 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24147 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24148 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24149 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24150 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24151 .display
24152 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24153 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24154 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24155 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24156 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24157 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24158 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24159 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24160 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24161 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24162 .endd
24163 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24164 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24165 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24166
24167 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24168 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24169
24170
24171 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24172 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24173 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24174 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24175 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24176 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24177 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24178 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24179 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24180
24181 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24182 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24183 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24184 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24185 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24186 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24187 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24188 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24189
24190
24191 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24192 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24193 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24194 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24195
24196 .ilist
24197 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24198 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24199 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24200 .next
24201 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24202 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24203 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24204 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24205 .next
24206 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24207 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24208 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24209 .next
24210 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24211 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24212 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24213 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24214 .code
24215 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24216 .endd
24217 into
24218 .code
24219 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24220 .endd
24221 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24222 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24223 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24224 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24225 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24226 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24227 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24228 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24229 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24230
24231 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24232 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24233 .endlist
24234
24235
24236 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24237 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24238 .code
24239 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24240 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24241 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24242 .endd
24243 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24244 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24245 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24246 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24247 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24248 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24249 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24250 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24251
24252 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24253 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24254 .code
24255 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24256 .endd
24257 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24258 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24259
24260 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24261 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24262 messages that originate outside the local host:
24263 .code
24264 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24265 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24266 .endd
24267 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24268 space.
24269
24270 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24271 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24272 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24273 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24274 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24275 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24276 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24277 components. For example, the rule
24278 .code
24279 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24280 .endd
24281 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24282 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24283 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24284 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24285 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24286 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24287 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24288 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24289
24290
24291
24292
24293
24294 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24295 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24296
24297 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24298 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24299 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24300 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24301 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24302 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24303 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24304 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24305 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24306 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24307 address, domain and error.
24308
24309 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24310 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24311 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24312 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24313 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24314 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24315 log selector is set, the message
24316 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24317 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24318 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24319 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24320
24321 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24322 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24323 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24324 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24325 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24326 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24327 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24328 domain are maintained independently.
24329
24330 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24331 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24332 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24333 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24334 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24335 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24336 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24337 the local address is reached.
24338
24339 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24340 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24341 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24342 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24343 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24344
24345 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24346 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24347 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24348 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24349 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24350 messages that it should now be retaining.
24351
24352
24353
24354 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24355 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24356 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24357 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24358 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24359 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24360 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24361 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24362 message's sender, respectively.
24363
24364
24365 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24366 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24367 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24368 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24369 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24370 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24371 example,
24372 .code
24373 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24374 .endd
24375 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24376 whereas
24377 .code
24378 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24379 .endd
24380 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24381 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24382 part.
24383
24384 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24385 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24386 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24387 expressions work in address lists.
24388 .display
24389 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24390 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24391 .endd
24392
24393
24394 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24395 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24396 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24397 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24398 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24399 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24400 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24401 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24402 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24403
24404 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24405 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24406 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24407 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24408 local transports).
24409
24410 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24411 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24412 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24413 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24414 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24415 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24416 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24417 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24418 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24419 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24420 commands.
24421
24422
24423
24424 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24425 "SECID160"
24426 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24427 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24428 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24429 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24430 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24431 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24432 .code
24433 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24434 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24435 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24436 .endd
24437 and the retry rules are
24438 .code
24439 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24440 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24441 .endd
24442 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24443 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24444 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24445 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24446 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24447 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24448
24449 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24450 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24451 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24452 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24453
24454 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24455 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24456 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24457 .code
24458 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24459 .endd
24460 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24461 textual form of the IP address.
24462
24463 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24464 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24465 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24466 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24467
24468 .vlist
24469 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24470 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24471 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24472
24473 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24474 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24475 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24476
24477 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24478 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24479
24480 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24481 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24482 .endlist
24483
24484 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24485 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24486 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24487 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24488 retry rule of this form:
24489 .code
24490 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24491 .endd
24492 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24493 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24494
24495 .vlist
24496 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24497 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24498 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24499 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24500
24501 .vitem &%lookup%&
24502 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24503 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24504 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24505 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24506 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24507
24508 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24509 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24510
24511 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24512 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24513
24514 .vitem &%refused%&
24515 A connection was refused.
24516
24517 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24518 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24519
24520 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24521 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24522
24523 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24524 A connection attempt timed out.
24525
24526 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24527 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24528 obtained from an MX record.
24529
24530 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24531 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24532 obtained from an MX record.
24533
24534 .vitem &%timeout%&
24535 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24536
24537 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24538 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24539 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24540 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24541
24542 .vitem &%quota%&
24543 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24544 transport.
24545
24546 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24547 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24548 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24549 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24550 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24551 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24552 for four days.
24553 .endlist
24554
24555 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24556 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24557 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24558 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24559 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24560 heuristic rules:
24561
24562 .ilist
24563 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24564 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24565 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24566 .next
24567 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24568 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24569 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24570 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24571 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24572 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24573 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24574 .next
24575 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24576 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24577 .endlist
24578
24579 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24580 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24581 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24582 error).
24583
24584
24585
24586 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24587 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24588 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24589 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24590 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24591 form:
24592 .display
24593 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24594 .endd
24595 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24596 .code
24597 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24598 .endd
24599 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24600 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24601 For example:
24602 .code
24603 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24604 .endd
24605 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24606 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24607 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24608 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24609 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24610
24611 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24612 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24613 .code
24614 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24615 .endd
24616 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24617 list is never matched.
24618
24619
24620
24621
24622
24623 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24624 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24625 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24626 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24627 .display
24628 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24629 .endd
24630 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24631 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24632 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24633 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24634 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24635
24636 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24637 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24638 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24639 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24640 The available algorithms are:
24641
24642 .ilist
24643 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24644 the interval.
24645 .next
24646 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24647 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24648 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24649 .next
24650 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24651 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24652 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24653 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24654 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24655 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24656 queue processing times.
24657 .endlist
24658
24659 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24660 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24661 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24662 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24663 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24664 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24665 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24666 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24667 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24668 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24669 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24670 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24671
24672 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24673 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24674 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24675 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24676 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24677 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24678 time.
24679
24680 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24681 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24682 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24683 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24684 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24685 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24686 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24687 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24688 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24689 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24690 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24691 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24692
24693 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24694 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24695 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24696 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24697 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24698 deliveries that have been deferred.
24699
24700
24701 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24702 Here are some example retry rules:
24703 .code
24704 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24705 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24706 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24707 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24708 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24709 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24710 .endd
24711 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24712 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24713 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24714 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24715 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24716 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24717 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24718 days.
24719
24720 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24721 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24722 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24723 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24724 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24725
24726 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24727 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24728 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24729 were not obtained from an MX record.
24730
24731 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24732 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24733 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24734 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24735 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24736
24737
24738
24739 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24740 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24741 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24742 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24743 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24744 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24745 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24746 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24747 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24748 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24749 failing for the first time.
24750
24751 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24752 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24753 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24754 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24755
24756 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24757 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24758 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24759
24760
24761
24762
24763 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24764 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24765 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24766 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24767 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24768 default retry rule:
24769 .code
24770 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24771 .endd
24772 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24773 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24774 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24775
24776 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24777 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24778 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24779 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24780 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24781
24782 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24783 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24784 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24785
24786 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24787 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24788 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24789 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24790 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24791 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24792 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24793 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24794
24795 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24796 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24797 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24798 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24799 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24800 notice.
24801
24802 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24803 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24804 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24805 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24806 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24807 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24808 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24809 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24810 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24811 true.
24812
24813 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24814 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24815 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24816 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24817 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24818 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24819 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24820 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24821 reached.
24822
24823 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24824 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24825 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24826 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24827 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24828 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24829 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24830 time out the address.
24831
24832 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24833 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24834 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24835 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24836 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24837 considered immediately.
24838 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24839 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24840
24841
24842
24843
24844
24845
24846 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24847 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24848
24849 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24850 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24851 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24852 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24853 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24854 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24855 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24856 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24857 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24858 other.
24859
24860 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24861 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24862
24863 .ilist
24864 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24865 the client's EHLO command.
24866 .next
24867 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24868 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24869 .next
24870 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24871 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24872 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24873 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24874 with the AUTH command.
24875 .next
24876 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24877 .next
24878 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24879 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24880 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24881 connection.
24882 .next
24883 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24884 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24885 unauthenticated connection.
24886 .endlist
24887
24888 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24889 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24890 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24891 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24892 .display
24893 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24894 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24895 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24896 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24897 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24898 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24899 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24900 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24901 &`250-PIPELINING`&
24902 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24903 &`250 HELP`&
24904 .endd
24905 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24906 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24907 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24908 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24909 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24910 included by setting
24911 .code
24912 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24913 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24914 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
24915 AUTH_GSASL=yes
24916 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24917 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
24918 AUTH_SPA=yes
24919 AUTH_TLS=yes
24920 .endd
24921 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24922 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24923 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24924 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24925 work via a socket interface.
24926 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24927 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24928 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24929 supporting setting a server keytab.
24930 The sixth can be configured to support
24931 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24932 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24933 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24934 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
24935 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
24936
24937 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24938 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24939 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24940 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24941 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24942 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24943 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24944
24945 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24946 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24947 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24948 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24949 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24950 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24951 .code
24952 cram:
24953 driver = cram_md5
24954 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24955 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24956 client_name = ph10
24957 client_secret = secret2
24958 .endd
24959 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24960 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24961
24962 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24963 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24964 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24965 in Exim.
24966
24967 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24968 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24969 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24970 authenticating data.
24971
24972 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24973 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24974 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24975 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24976 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24977 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24978 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24979 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24980 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24981 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24982 choose to honour.
24983
24984 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24985 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24986 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24987 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24988
24989
24990
24991 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24992 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24993 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24994
24995 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24996 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24997 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24998 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24999 encrypted by a setting such as:
25000 .code
25001 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25002 .endd
25003
25004
25005 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25006 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25007 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
25008 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25009
25010
25011 .option driver authenticators string unset
25012 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25013 authenticators is to be used.
25014
25015
25016 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25017 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25018 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25019 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25020 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25021 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25022
25023
25024 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25025 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25026 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25027 mechanism is not advertised.
25028 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25029 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25030 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25031
25032
25033 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25034 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25035 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25036 for details.
25037
25038 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25039 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25040
25041 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25042 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25043 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25044 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25045 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25046 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25047 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25048 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25049 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25050 the error text.
25051
25052
25053 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25054 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25055 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25056 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25057 out the values of variables.
25058 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25059 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25060
25061
25062 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25063 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25064 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25065 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25066 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25067 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25068 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25069 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25070 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25071
25072
25073 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25074 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25075 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25076 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25077 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25078 remembered for later use.
25079 How it is used is described in the following section.
25080
25081
25082
25083
25084
25085 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25086 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25087 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25088 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25089 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25090 message:
25091
25092 .ilist
25093 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25094 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25095 .next
25096 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25097 .next
25098 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25099 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25100 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25101 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25102 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25103 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25104 given for the MAIL command.
25105 .next
25106 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25107 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25108 authenticated.
25109 .next
25110 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25111 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25112 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25113 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25114 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25115 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25116 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25117 message.
25118 .endlist
25119
25120
25121 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25122 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25123 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25124 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25125
25126 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25127 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25128 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25129 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25130 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25131 ACL is run.
25132
25133
25134
25135 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25136 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25137 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25138 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25139 conditions:
25140
25141 .ilist
25142 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25143 .next
25144 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25145 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25146 .endlist
25147
25148 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25149 the mechanisms are advertised.
25150
25151 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25152 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25153 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25154 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25155 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25156 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25157 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25158 .code
25159 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25160 .endd
25161 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25162
25163 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25164 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25165 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25166 such as:
25167 .code
25168 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25169 .endd
25170 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25171 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25172 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25173
25174 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25175 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25176 command. This is the case if
25177
25178 .ilist
25179 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25180 .next
25181 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25182 .next
25183 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25184 server authenticators.
25185 .endlist
25186
25187
25188 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25189 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25190 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25191
25192 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25193 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25194 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25195 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25196 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25197 rejected with a 504 error.
25198
25199 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25200 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25201 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25202 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25203 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25204 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25205 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25206 no successful authentication.
25207
25208
25209
25210
25211 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25212 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25213 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25214 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25215 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25216 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25217 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25218 script:
25219 .code
25220 use MIME::Base64;
25221 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25222 .endd
25223 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25224 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25225 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25226 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25227 command line to run this script on such data might be
25228 .code
25229 encode '\0user\0password'
25230 .endd
25231 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25232 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25233 whose code value is zero.
25234
25235 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25236 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25237 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25238 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25239
25240 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25241 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25242 example, a command such as
25243 .code
25244 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25245 .endd
25246 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25247
25248 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25249 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25250 .code
25251 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25252 .endd
25253 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25254 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25255 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25256 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25257
25258
25259
25260 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25261 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25262 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25263 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25264 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25265 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25266
25267 .ilist
25268 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25269 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25270 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25271 of the authenticator.
25272 .next
25273 .vindex "&$host$&"
25274 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25275 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25276 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25277 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25278 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25279 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25280 delivery to be deferred.
25281 .next
25282 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25283 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25284 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25285 usual way.
25286 .next
25287 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25288 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25289 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25290 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25291 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25292 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25293 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25294 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25295 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25296 .endlist
25297
25298 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25299 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25300 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25301 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25302 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25303 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25304 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25305 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25306 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25307 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25308 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25309 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25310 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25311
25312
25313
25314
25315
25316
25317 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25318 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25319
25320 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25321 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25322 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25323 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25324 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25325 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25326 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25327 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25328 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25329 connections as you do for login accounts.
25330
25331 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25332 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25333 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25334
25335 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25336 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25337 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25338
25339 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25340 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25341 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25342 given.
25343
25344 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25345 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25346 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25347 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25348 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25349 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25350 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25351
25352 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25353 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25354 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25355 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25356 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25357 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25358 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25359
25360 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25361 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25362 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25363 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25364
25365 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25366 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25367 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25368
25369 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25370 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25371 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25372 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25373 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25374 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25375 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25376 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25377 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25378 string as the error text
25379
25380 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25381 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25382 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25383
25384
25385
25386 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25387 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25388 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25389 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25390 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25391 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25392 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25393 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25394
25395 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25396 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25397 configured as follows:
25398 .code
25399 fixed_plain:
25400 driver = plaintext
25401 public_name = PLAIN
25402 server_prompts = :
25403 server_condition = \
25404 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25405 server_set_id = $auth2
25406 .endd
25407 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25408 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25409 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25410 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25411
25412 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25413 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25414 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25415 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25416 .code
25417 250-AUTH PLAIN
25418 .endd
25419 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25420 .code
25421 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25422 .endd
25423 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25424 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25425 .code
25426 AUTH PLAIN
25427 .endd
25428 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25429 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25430
25431 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25432 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25433 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25434 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25435 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25436
25437 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25438 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25439 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25440
25441 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25442 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25443 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25444 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25445 This is an incorrect example:
25446 .code
25447 server_condition = \
25448 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25449 .endd
25450 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25451 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25452 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25453 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25454 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25455 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25456 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25457 .code
25458 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25459 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25460 .endd
25461 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25462 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25463 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25464 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25465 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25466
25467
25468 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25469 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25470 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25471 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25472 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25473 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25474 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25475 .code
25476 fixed_login:
25477 driver = plaintext
25478 public_name = LOGIN
25479 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25480 server_condition = \
25481 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25482 server_set_id = $auth1
25483 .endd
25484 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25485 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25486 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25487 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25488
25489 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25490 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25491 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25492 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25493 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25494 .code
25495 login:
25496 driver = plaintext
25497 public_name = LOGIN
25498 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25499 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25500 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25501 ldapauth{\
25502 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25503 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25504 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25505 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25506 .endd
25507 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25508 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25509 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25510 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25511 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25512 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25513 uninterpreted string.
25514
25515
25516 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25517 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25518 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25519 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25520 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25521 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25522
25523
25524
25525
25526 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25527 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25528 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25529
25530 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25531 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25532 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25533 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25534 usual.
25535
25536 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25537 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25538 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25539 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25540 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25541 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25542 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25543 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25544 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25545 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25546 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25547 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25548
25549 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25550 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25551
25552 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25553 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25554 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25555 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25556 the string.
25557
25558 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25559 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25560 .code
25561 fixed_plain:
25562 driver = plaintext
25563 public_name = PLAIN
25564 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25565 .endd
25566 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25567 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25568 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25569 .code
25570 fixed_login:
25571 driver = plaintext
25572 public_name = LOGIN
25573 client_send = : username : mysecret
25574 .endd
25575 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25576 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25577 prompts.
25578 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25579 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25580
25581
25582
25583
25584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25585 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25586
25587 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25588 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25589 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25590 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25591 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25592 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25593 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25594 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25595 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25596 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25597 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25598 available in plain text at either end.
25599
25600
25601 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25602 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25603 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25604 authenticator as a server:
25605
25606 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25607 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25608 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25609 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25610 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25611 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25612 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25613 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25614 returned to the client.
25615
25616 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25617 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25618 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25619 numeric variables for other things.
25620
25621 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25622 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25623 user name, authentication fails.
25624 .code
25625 fixed_cram:
25626 driver = cram_md5
25627 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25628 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25629 server_set_id = $auth1
25630 .endd
25631 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25632 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25633 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25634 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25635 .code
25636 lookup_cram:
25637 driver = cram_md5
25638 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25639 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25640 {$value}fail}
25641 server_set_id = $auth1
25642 .endd
25643 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25644 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25645
25646 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25647 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25648 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25649 realm, with:
25650 .code
25651 cyrusless_crammd5:
25652 driver = cram_md5
25653 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25654 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25655 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25656 server_set_id = $auth1
25657 .endd
25658
25659 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25660 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25661 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25662
25663
25664
25665 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25666 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25667 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25668
25669
25670 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25671 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25672 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25673
25674
25675 .vindex "&$host$&"
25676 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25677 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25678 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25679 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25680 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25681 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25682 send the message to the current server.
25683
25684 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25685 strings, is:
25686 .code
25687 fixed_cram:
25688 driver = cram_md5
25689 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25690 client_name = ph10
25691 client_secret = secret
25692 .endd
25693 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25694 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25695
25696
25697
25698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25700
25701 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25702 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25703 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25704 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25705 .cindex "Kerberos"
25706 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25707 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25708
25709 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25710 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25711 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25712 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25713 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25714
25715 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25716 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25717 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25718 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25719
25720 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25721 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25722 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25723 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25724 depending on the driver you are using.
25725
25726 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25727 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25728 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25729 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25730 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25731 implementation.
25732
25733 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25734 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25735 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25736 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25737 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25738 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25739 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25740 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25741
25742
25743 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25744 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25745 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25746 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25747 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25748 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25749 things.
25750
25751
25752 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25753 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25754 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25755 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25756
25757
25758 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25759 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25760 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25761 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25762 example:
25763 .code
25764 sasl:
25765 driver = cyrus_sasl
25766 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25767 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25768 server_set_id = $auth1
25769 .endd
25770
25771 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25772 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25773
25774
25775 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25776 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25777
25778
25779 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25780 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25781 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25782 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25783 .code
25784 sasl_cram_md5:
25785 driver = cyrus_sasl
25786 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25787 server_set_id = $auth1
25788
25789 sasl_plain:
25790 driver = cyrus_sasl
25791 public_name = PLAIN
25792 server_set_id = $auth2
25793 .endd
25794 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25795 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25796 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25797 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25798 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25799
25800
25801
25802
25803 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25804 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25805 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25806 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25807 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25808 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25809 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25810 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25811 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25812 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25813 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25814
25815 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25816
25817 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25818 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25819 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25820 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25821 .code
25822 dovecot_plain:
25823 driver = dovecot
25824 public_name = PLAIN
25825 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25826 server_set_id = $auth1
25827
25828 dovecot_ntlm:
25829 driver = dovecot
25830 public_name = NTLM
25831 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25832 server_set_id = $auth1
25833 .endd
25834 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25835 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25836 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25837 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25838 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25839 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25840 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25841 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25842
25843
25844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25845 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25846 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25847 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25848 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25849 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25850 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25851 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25852 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25853 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25854 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25855 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25856 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25857 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25858 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25859 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25860 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25861 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25862 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25863 without code changes in Exim.
25864
25865
25866 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25867 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25868 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25869 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25870 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25871 context.
25872
25873 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25874 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25875 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25876
25877 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25878 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25879 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25880
25881 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25882 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25883 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25884
25885
25886 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25887 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25888 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25889 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25890
25891
25892 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25893 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25894 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25895 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25896 example:
25897 .code
25898 sasl:
25899 driver = gsasl
25900 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25901 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25902 server_set_id = $auth1
25903 .endd
25904
25905
25906 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25907 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25908 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25909 the password itself.
25910
25911 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25912 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25913 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25914 if available, else the empty string.
25915 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25916 else the empty string.
25917
25918 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25919
25920 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25921 option to be simply "true".
25922
25923
25924 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25925 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25926 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25927
25928
25929 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25930 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25931 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25932 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25933
25934
25935 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25936 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25937 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25938 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25939
25940
25941 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25942 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25943 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25944
25945
25946 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25947 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25948 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25949 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25950
25951 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25952 meanings for these variables:
25953
25954 .ilist
25955 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25956 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25957 .next
25958 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25959 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25960 .next
25961 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25962 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25963 .endlist
25964
25965 On a per-mechanism basis:
25966
25967 .ilist
25968 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25969 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25970 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25971 .next
25972 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25973 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25974 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25975 .next
25976 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25977 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25978 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25979 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25980 .endlist
25981
25982 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25983 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25984 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25985
25986
25987 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25988 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25989 .code
25990 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25991 driver = gsasl
25992 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25993 server_realm = imap.example.org
25994 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25995 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25996 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25997 server_condition = yes
25998 .endd
25999
26000
26001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26002 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26003
26004 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26005 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26006 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26007 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26008 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26009 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26010 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26011 reliably.
26012
26013 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26014 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26015 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26016 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26017
26018 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26019 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26020 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26021 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26022
26023 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26024 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26025 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
26026 from the keytab.
26027
26028
26029 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26030 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26031 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26032 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26033
26034 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26035 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26036 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26037 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26038
26039 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26040 .ilist
26041 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26042 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26043 .next
26044 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26045 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26046 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26047 GSS Display Name.
26048 .endlist
26049
26050
26051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26053
26054 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26055 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26056 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26057 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26058 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26059 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26060 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26061 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26062 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26063 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26064 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26065 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26066 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26067 follows:
26068
26069 .ilist
26070 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26071 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26072 .next
26073 The server sends back a challenge.
26074 .next
26075 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26076 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26077 .endlist
26078
26079 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26080
26081
26082
26083 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26084 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26085 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26086
26087 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26088 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26089 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26090 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26091 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26092 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26093 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26094 for other things. For example:
26095 .code
26096 spa:
26097 driver = spa
26098 public_name = NTLM
26099 server_password = \
26100 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26101 .endd
26102 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26103 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26104
26105
26106
26107
26108
26109 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26110 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26111 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26112
26113
26114
26115 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26116 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26117
26118
26119 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26120 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26121
26122
26123 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26124 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26125 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26126 &'msn.com'&:
26127 .code
26128 msn:
26129 driver = spa
26130 public_name = MSN
26131 client_username = msn/msn_username
26132 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26133 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26134 .endd
26135 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26136 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26137
26138
26139
26140
26141
26142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26144
26145 .new
26146 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26147 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26148 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26149 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26150 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26151 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26152 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26153 authentication based on client certificates.
26154
26155 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26156 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26157 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26158 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26159 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26160 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26161
26162 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26163 for which it must have been requested via the
26164 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26165 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26166
26167 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26168 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26169 and can authenticate the connection.
26170 If it does, SMTP suthentication is not offered.
26171
26172 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26173
26174
26175 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26176 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26177
26178 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26179 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26180 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26181 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26182 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26183 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26184
26185 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26186 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26187 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26188
26189 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26190
26191
26192 Example:
26193 .code
26194 tls:
26195 driver = tls
26196 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26197 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26198 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26199 {!= {0} \
26200 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26201 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26202 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26203 } } } }
26204 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26205 .endd
26206 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26207 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26208 .wen
26209
26210
26211 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26212 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26213 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26214
26215
26216
26217 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26219
26220 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26221 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26222 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26223 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26224 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26225 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26226 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26227 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26228 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26229 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26230 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26231 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26232 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26233 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26234 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26235 certificates are used.
26236
26237 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26238 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26239 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26240 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26241 between them is encrypted.
26242
26243 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26244 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26245 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26246 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26247 encryption state.
26248
26249 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26250 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26251 in order to get TLS to work.
26252
26253
26254
26255 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26256 "SECID284"
26257 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26258 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26259 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26260 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26261 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26262 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26263 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26264 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26265 allocated for this purpose.
26266
26267 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26268 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26269 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26270 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26271 .code
26272 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26273 .endd
26274 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26275 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26276 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26277 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26278 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26279 defined elsewhere.
26280
26281 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26282 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26283
26284
26285
26286
26287
26288
26289 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26290 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26291 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26292 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26293 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26294 .code
26295 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26296 .endd
26297 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26298 .code
26299 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26300 .endd
26301 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26302 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26303
26304 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26305
26306 .ilist
26307 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26308 cannot be the path of a directory
26309 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26310 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26311 .next
26312 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26313 .next
26314 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26315 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26316 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26317 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26318 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26319 .next
26320 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26321 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26322 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26323 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26324 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26325 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26326 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26327 option).
26328 .next
26329 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26330 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26331 .next
26332 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26333 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26334 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26335 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26336 .next
26337 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26338 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26339 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26340 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26341 .endlist
26342
26343
26344 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26345 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26346 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26347 but not the chosen filename.
26348 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26349 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26350
26351 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26352 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26353 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26354 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26355 of bits requested.
26356 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26357 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26358 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26359 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26360 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26361 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26362 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26363
26364 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26365 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26366 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26367 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26368 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26369
26370 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26371 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26372 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26373 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26374 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26375 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26376
26377 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26378 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26379 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26380
26381 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26382 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26383 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26384 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26385 .code
26386 # ls
26387 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26388 # rm -f new-params
26389 # touch new-params
26390 # chown exim:exim new-params
26391 # chmod 0600 new-params
26392 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26393 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26394 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26395 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26396 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26397 # chmod 0400 new-params
26398 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26399 .endd
26400 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26401 stalling is removed.
26402
26403 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26404 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26405 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26406 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26407 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26408 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26409 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26410 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26411 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26412 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26413 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26414
26415 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26416 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26417 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26418 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26419
26420 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26421 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26422 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26423 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26424 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26425
26426
26427 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26428 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26429 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26430 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26431 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26432 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26433 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26434 directly to this function call.
26435 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26436 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26437 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26438 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26439
26440 .ilist
26441 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26442 .next
26443 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26444 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26445 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26446 SSL v3 algorithms.
26447 .next
26448 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26449 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26450 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26451 algorithms.
26452 .endlist
26453
26454 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26455 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26456 .ilist
26457 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26458 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26459 stated.
26460 .next
26461 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26462 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26463 .next
26464 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26465 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26466 .endlist
26467
26468 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26469 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26470 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26471 not be moved to the end of the list.
26472 .endlist
26473
26474 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26475 string:
26476 .code
26477 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26478 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26479 .endd
26480
26481 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26482 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26483 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26484 choice of clients used:
26485 .code
26486 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26487 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26488 {DEFAULT}\
26489 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26490 .endd
26491
26492
26493
26494 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26495 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26496 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26497 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26498 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26499 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26500 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26501 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26502 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26503 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26504 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26505 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26506
26507 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26508 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26509
26510 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26511 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26512 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26513 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26514 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26515 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26516
26517 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26518 "Priority strings". This is online as
26519 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26520 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26521 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26522 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26523 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26524
26525 For example:
26526 .code
26527 # Disable older versions of protocols
26528 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26529 .endd
26530
26531 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26532 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26533 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26534
26535 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26536 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26537 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26538 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26539 used:
26540 .code
26541 # GnuTLS variant
26542 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26543 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26544 {SECURE128}}
26545 .endd
26546
26547
26548 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26549 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26550 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26551 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26552 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26553 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26554 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26555 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26556
26557 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26558 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26559 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26560 with the error
26561 .code
26562 554 Security failure
26563 .endd
26564 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26565 rejected with a 554 error code.
26566
26567 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26568 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26569 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26570 without some further configuration at the server end.
26571
26572 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26573 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26574 .code
26575 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26576 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26577 .endd
26578 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26579 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26580 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26581 that goes with it. These files need to be
26582 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26583 always be given as full path names.
26584 The key must not be password-protected.
26585 They can be the same file if both the
26586 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26587 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26588 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26589 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26590 the server's certificate.
26591
26592 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26593 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26594 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26595
26596 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26597 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26598 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26599 transport.
26600
26601 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26602 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26603 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26604 .code
26605 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26606 .endd
26607 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26608 with the parameters contained in the file.
26609 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26610 available:
26611 .code
26612 tls_dhparam = none
26613 .endd
26614 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26615 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26616 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26617 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26618
26619 See the command
26620 .code
26621 openssl dhparam
26622 .endd
26623 for a way of generating file data.
26624
26625 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26626 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26627 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26628 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26629 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26630
26631 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26632 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26633 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26634 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26635 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26636 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26637 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26638 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26639 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26640
26641 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26642 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26643 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26644 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26645 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26646 documentation for more details.
26647
26648 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26649 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26650
26651
26652 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26653 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26654 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26655 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26656 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26657 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26658 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26659 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26660 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26661 expected certificates.
26662 .new
26663 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26664 .wen
26665 an explicit file or,
26666 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26667 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26668
26669 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26670 directory is used
26671 (OpenSSL only),
26672 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26673 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26674 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26675 .code
26676 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26677 .endd
26678 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26679
26680 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26681 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26682 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26683 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26684 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26685 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26686 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26687 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26688 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26689 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26690
26691 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26692 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26693 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26694 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26695
26696 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26697 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26698 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26699 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26700 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26701 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26702
26703
26704 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26705 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26706 .cindex "revocation list"
26707 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26708 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26709 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26710 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26711 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26712 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26713 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26714 CRL in PEM format.
26715 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26716 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26717
26718 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26719 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26720 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26721 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26722 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26723 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26724
26725 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26726 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26727 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26728 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26729
26730 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26731 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26732 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26733 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26734 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26735 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26736 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26737 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26738
26739 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26740 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26741 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26742
26743 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26744 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26745 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26746 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26747 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26748
26749 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26750 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26751 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26752 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26753 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26754 next connection.
26755
26756 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26757 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26758 ignored.
26759
26760 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26761 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26762 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26763 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26764 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26765 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26766
26767 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26768 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26769
26770 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26771
26772 .code
26773 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26774 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26775 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26776
26777 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26778 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26779 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26780 .endd
26781
26782
26783
26784
26785 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26786 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26787 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26788 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26789 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26790 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26791 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26792 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26793 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26794
26795 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26796 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26797 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26798 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26799 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26800
26801 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26802 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26803 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26804 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26805 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26806 usual way.
26807
26808 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26809 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26810 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26811 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26812 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26813 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26814 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26815 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26816 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26817 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26818 unencrypted.
26819
26820 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26821 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26822 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26823 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26824
26825 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26826 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26827 .new
26828 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26829 .wen
26830 a file or,
26831 depnding on liibrary version, a directory,
26832 must name a file or,
26833 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26834 The client verifies the server's certificate
26835 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26836 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26837 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26838 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26839
26840 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26841 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26842 or need not succeed respectively.
26843
26844 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26845 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26846 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26847 value is empty.
26848 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26849 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26850 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26851 otherwise.
26852
26853 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26854 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26855 for OCSP to be relevant.
26856
26857 If
26858 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26859 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26860 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26861 alternative hosts, if any.
26862
26863 &*Note*&:
26864 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26865 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26866 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26867 client.
26868
26869 .vindex "&$host$&"
26870 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26871 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26872 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26873 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26874 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26875
26876 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26877 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26878 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26879 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26880 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26881 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26882 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26883 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26884 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26885 outgoing connection.
26886
26887
26888
26889 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26890 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26891 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26892 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26893 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26894 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26895 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26896 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26897 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26898 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26899 for this session.
26900
26901 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26902 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26903 address.
26904
26905 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26906 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26907 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26908 be of limited use in that environment.
26909
26910 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26911 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26912 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26913 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26914 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26915
26916 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26917 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26918 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26919 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26920 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26921
26922 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26923 received from a client.
26924 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26925
26926 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26927 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26928 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26929
26930 .ilist
26931 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26932 &%tls_certificate%&
26933 .next
26934 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26935 &%tls_crl%&
26936 .next
26937 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26938 &%tls_privatekey%&
26939 .next
26940 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26941 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26942 .next
26943 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
26944 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
26945 .endlist
26946
26947 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26948 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26949 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26950 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26951
26952 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26953 are re-expanded.
26954
26955 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26956 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26957 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26958 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26959
26960 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26961 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26962 built, then you have SNI support).
26963
26964
26965
26966 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26967 "SECTmulmessam"
26968 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26969 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26970 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26971 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26972 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26973 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26974 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26975 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26976 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26977 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26978 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26979
26980 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26981 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26982 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26983 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26984 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26985 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26986 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26987 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26988 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26989
26990 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26991 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26992 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26993 information is recorded.
26994
26995 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26996 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26997 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26998
26999
27000
27001
27002 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27003 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27004 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27005 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27006 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27007 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27008 to Apache, currently at
27009 .display
27010 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27011 .endd
27012 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27013 links to further files.
27014 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27015 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27016 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27017 .display
27018 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27019 .endd
27020
27021
27022 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27023 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27024 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27025 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27026 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27027 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27028 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27029 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27030 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27031 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27032 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27033 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27034 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27035
27036 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27037 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27038 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27039 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27040
27041
27042
27043 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27044 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27045 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27046 with OpenSSL, like this:
27047 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27048 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27049 .code
27050 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27051 -days 9999 -nodes
27052 .endd
27053 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27054 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27055 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27056 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27057 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27058 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27059 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27060
27061 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27062 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27063 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27064 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27065 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27066 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27067 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27068 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27069 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27070 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27071 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27072 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27073 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27074 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27075 be a sensible resolution).
27076
27077 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27078 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27079 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27080
27081 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27082 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27083 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27084 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27085 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27086 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27087
27088 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27089 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27090 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27091 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27092 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27093 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27094
27095
27096
27097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27098 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27099
27100 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27101 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27102 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27103 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27104 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27105 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27106 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27107 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27108 one very small ACL:
27109 .code
27110 begin acl
27111 small_acl:
27112 accept hosts = one.host.only
27113 .endd
27114 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27115 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27116
27117 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27118 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27119 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27120 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27121 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27122 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27123 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27124 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27125
27126
27127 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27128 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27129 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27130 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27131 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27132
27133
27134
27135 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27136 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27137 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27138 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27139 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27140 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27141 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27142 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27143 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27144 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27145 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27146 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27147 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27148 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27149 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27150 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27151 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27152 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27153 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27154 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27155
27156 .table2 140pt
27157 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27158 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27159 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27160 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27161 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27162 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27163 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27164 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27165 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27166 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27167 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27168 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27169 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27170 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27171 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27172 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27173 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27174 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27175 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27176 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27177 .endtable
27178
27179 For example, if you set
27180 .code
27181 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27182 .endd
27183 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27184 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27185 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27186 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27187 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27188 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27189 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27190
27191
27192 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27193 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27194 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27195 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27196 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27197 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27198 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27199 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27200 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27201 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27202 in any of these ACLs.
27203
27204 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27205 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27206 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27207 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27208 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27209 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27210 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27211 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27212 .code
27213 control = suppress_local_fixups
27214 .endd
27215 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27216 run, it is too late.
27217
27218 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27219 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27220
27221 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27222 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27223 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27224
27225
27226 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27227 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27228 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27229 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27230 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27231 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27232 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27233 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27234 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27235
27236
27237 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27238 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27239 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27240 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27241 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27242 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27243 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27244 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27245 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27246
27247 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27248 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27249 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27250 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27251 an EHLO response.
27252
27253
27254 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27255 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27256 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27257 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27258 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27259 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27260 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27261 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27262 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27263 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27264
27265 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27266 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27267 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27268 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27269 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27270 associated with the DATA command.
27271
27272 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27273 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27274 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27275 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27276 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27277 your resources.
27278
27279 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27280 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27281 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27282 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27283
27284 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27285 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27286 enabled (which is the default).
27287
27288 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27289 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27290 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27291
27292 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27293
27294 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27295
27296
27297 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27298 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27299 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27300
27301 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27302
27303
27304 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27305 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27306 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27307 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27308 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27309 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27310 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27311 has been accepted.
27312
27313 The ACL test specfied by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27314 has been recieved, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27315 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27316 The test may accept, defer or deny for inividual recipients.
27317 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27318 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27319 for some or all recipients.
27320
27321 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27322 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27323 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27324 for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
27325 "PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27326 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27327 will avoid doing so in some situations (eg. single-recipient mails).
27328
27329 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27330 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27331
27332 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27333 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27334 the feature was not requested by the client.
27335
27336 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27337 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27338 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27339 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27340 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, it may only accept
27341 or warn as its final result.
27342
27343 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27344 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27345 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27346 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27347
27348 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27349 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27350
27351 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27352 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27353 response to QUIT.
27354
27355 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27356 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27357 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27358 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27359 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27360
27361
27362 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27363 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27364 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27365 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27366 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27367 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27368 situation even worse.
27369
27370 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27371 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27372 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27373 and &%warn%&.
27374
27375 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27376 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27377 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27378 connection. The possible values are:
27379 .table2
27380 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27381 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27382 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27383 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27384 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27385 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27386 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27387 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27388 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27389 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27390 .endtable
27391 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27392 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27393 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27394 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27395 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27396 used.
27397
27398
27399 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27400 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27401 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27402 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27403 .code
27404 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27405 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27406 .endd
27407 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27408 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27409 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27410 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27411 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27412
27413 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27414 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27415 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27416
27417 .ilist
27418 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27419 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27420 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27421 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27422 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27423 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27424 .code
27425 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27426 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27427 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27428 .endd
27429 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27430 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27431 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27432 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27433 .next
27434 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27435 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27436 matches the string.
27437 .next
27438 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27439 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27440 want to have something like
27441 .code
27442 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27443 .endd
27444 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27445 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27446 .endlist
27447
27448
27449
27450
27451 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27452 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27453 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27454 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27455 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27456 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27457 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27458 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27459 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27460
27461 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27462 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27463 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27464
27465
27466 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27467 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27468 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27469 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27470
27471 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27472 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27473 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27474 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27475 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27476 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27477 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27478
27479
27480 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27481 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27482 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27483
27484
27485
27486 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27487 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27488 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27489 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27490 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27491 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27492
27493 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27494 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27495 used to accept or reject anything.
27496
27497 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27498 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27499 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27500 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27501
27502 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27503 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27504 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27505 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27506 configuration file.
27507
27508
27509
27510
27511 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27512 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27513 .vindex &$domain$&
27514 .vindex &$local_part$&
27515 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27516 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27517 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27518 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27519 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27520 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27521 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27522 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27523 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27524
27525 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27526 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27527 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27528 how it is used.
27529
27530 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27531 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27532 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27533 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27534 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27535 received).
27536
27537 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27538 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27539 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27540 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27541 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27542 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27543 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27544 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27545
27546
27547
27548
27549
27550 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27551 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27552 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27553 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27554 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27555 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27556 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27557 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27558 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27559 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27560 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27561 unencrypted connections.
27562 .code
27563 acl_check_auth:
27564 accept encrypted = *
27565 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27566 {CRAM-MD5}}
27567 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27568 .endd
27569 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27570 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27571 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27572 option to do this.)
27573
27574
27575
27576 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27577 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27578 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27579 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27580 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27581 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27582 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27583
27584 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27585 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27586 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27587 example:
27588 .code
27589 deny dnslists = list1.example
27590 dnslists = list2.example
27591 .endd
27592 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27593 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27594 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27595 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27596 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27597
27598
27599 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27600 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27601
27602 .ilist
27603 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27604 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27605 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27606 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27607 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27608 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27609 check a RCPT command:
27610 .code
27611 accept domains = +local_domains
27612 endpass
27613 verify = recipient
27614 .endd
27615 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27616 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27617 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27618 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27619 &%endpass%&.
27620
27621 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27622 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27623 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27624 configuration.
27625
27626 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27627 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27628 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27629 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27630 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27631 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27632 .display
27633 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27634 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27635 .endd
27636 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27637 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27638 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27639
27640 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27641 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27642 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27643 of &%endpass%&.
27644
27645
27646 .next
27647 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27648 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27649 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27650 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27651 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27652 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27653 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27654
27655
27656 .next
27657 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27658 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27659 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27660 example,
27661 .code
27662 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27663 .endd
27664 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27665
27666
27667 .next
27668 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27669 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27670 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27671 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27672 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27673 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27674 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27675 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27676 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27677
27678 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27679 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27680 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27681
27682
27683 .next
27684 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27685 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27686 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27687 .code
27688 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27689 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27690 .endd
27691 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27692 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27693
27694 .next
27695 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27696 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27697 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27698 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27699 .code
27700 require message = Sender did not verify
27701 verify = sender
27702 .endd
27703 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27704 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27705 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27706 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27707
27708 .next
27709 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27710 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27711 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27712 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27713 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27714 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27715 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27716
27717 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27718 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27719 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27720 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27721 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27722
27723 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27724 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27725 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27726 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27727 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27728 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27729 onwards.
27730
27731
27732 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27733 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27734 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27735 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27736 .code
27737 warn !verify = sender
27738 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27739 .endd
27740 .endlist
27741
27742 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27743
27744 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27745 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27746 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27747 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27748 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27749
27750
27751
27752 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27753 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27754 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27755 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27756 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27757 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27758 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27759 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27760 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27761 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27762 .ilist
27763 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27764 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27765 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27766 on the same SMTP connection.
27767 .next
27768 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27769 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27770 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27771 .endlist
27772
27773 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27774 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27775 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27776 .code
27777 accept hosts = whatever
27778 set acl_m4 = some value
27779 accept authenticated = *
27780 set acl_c_auth = yes
27781 .endd
27782 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27783 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27784 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27785
27786 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27787 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27788 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27789 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27790 error is generated.
27791
27792 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27793 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27794
27795
27796 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27797 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27798 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27799 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27800 .code
27801 deny domains = *.dom.example
27802 !verify = recipient
27803 .endd
27804 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27805 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27806 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27807 two statements are equivalent:
27808 .code
27809 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27810 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27811 .endd
27812 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27813 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27814
27815 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27816 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27817 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27818 .code
27819 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27820 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27821 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27822 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27823 .endd
27824 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27825 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27826 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27827 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27828 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27829 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27830 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27831
27832 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27833 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27834 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27835 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27836 message is handled.
27837
27838 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27839 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27840 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27841 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27842 .code
27843 require message = Can't verify sender
27844 verify = sender
27845 message = Can't verify recipient
27846 verify = recipient
27847 message = This message cannot be used
27848 .endd
27849 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27850 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27851 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27852 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27853 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27854 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27855
27856 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27857 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27858 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27859 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27860 .code
27861 deny hosts = ...
27862 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27863 message = Invalid sender from client host
27864 .endd
27865 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27866 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27867
27868
27869
27870 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27871 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27872 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27873
27874 .vlist
27875 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27876 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27877 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27878 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27879
27880 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27881 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27882 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27883 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27884 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
27885 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
27886 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
27887 write rather ugly lines like this:
27888 .display
27889 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
27890 .endd
27891 Instead, all you need is
27892 .display
27893 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
27894 .endd
27895
27896 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27897 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27898 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
27899 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
27900 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
27901 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
27902 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
27903 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
27904
27905 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
27906 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
27907 in several different ways. For example:
27908
27909 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
27910 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
27911 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
27912 . ==== way.
27913
27914 .ilist
27915 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
27916 .code
27917 accept ...some conditions
27918 control = queue_only
27919 .endd
27920 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27921 other words, when the conditions are all true.
27922
27923 .next
27924 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27925 .code
27926 accept ...some conditions...
27927 control = queue_only
27928 ...some more conditions...
27929 .endd
27930 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27931 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27932 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27933 to be relevant.
27934
27935 .next
27936 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27937 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27938 example:
27939 .code
27940 warn ...some conditions...
27941 control = freeze
27942 accept ...
27943 .endd
27944 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27945 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27946 log entry.
27947
27948 .next
27949 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27950 &%require%& verb. For example:
27951 .code
27952 require control = no_multiline_responses
27953 .endd
27954 .endlist
27955
27956 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27957 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27958 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
27959 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27960 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27961 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27962 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27963 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27964 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27965
27966 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27967 example:
27968 .code
27969 deny ...some conditions...
27970 delay = 30s
27971 .endd
27972 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27973 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
27974 .code
27975 deny delay = 30s
27976 ...some conditions...
27977 .endd
27978 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27979 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27980 .code
27981 warn ...some conditions...
27982 delay = 2m
27983 control = freeze
27984 accept ...
27985 .endd
27986
27987 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27988 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27989 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27990 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27991 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27992 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27993 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27994
27995
27996 .vitem &*endpass*&
27997 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27998 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27999 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28000 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28001 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28002 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28003 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28004
28005
28006 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28007 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28008 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28009 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28010 .code
28011 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28012 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28013 .endd
28014 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28015 example:
28016 .display
28017 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28018 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28019 .endd
28020 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28021 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28022 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28023 message.
28024
28025 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28026 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28027 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28028 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28029 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28030 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28031 ignored.
28032
28033 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28034 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28035 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28036 error message.
28037
28038 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28039 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28040 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28041 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28042 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28043 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28044
28045 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28046 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28047 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28048 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28049 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28050 logging rejections.
28051
28052
28053 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28054 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28055 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28056 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28057 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28058 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28059 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28060 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28061 .display
28062 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28063 &` log_reject_target =`&
28064 .endd
28065 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28066 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28067 current ACL.
28068
28069
28070 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28071 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28072 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28073 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28074 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28075 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28076 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28077 ACLs. For example:
28078 .display
28079 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28080 &` control = freeze`&
28081 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28082 .endd
28083 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28084 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28085 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28086 example:
28087 .code
28088 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28089 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28090 .endd
28091
28092
28093 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28094 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28095 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28096 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28097 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28098 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28099 &%accept%& for details.)
28100
28101 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28102 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28103 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28104 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28105 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28106 .code
28107 require message = Host not recognized
28108 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28109 .endd
28110 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28111 processed.)
28112
28113 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28114 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28115 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28116 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28117 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28118 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28119 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28120 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28121 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28122 EHLO options.
28123
28124 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28125 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28126 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28127 .code
28128 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28129 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28130 .endd
28131 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28132 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28133 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28134 2&'xx'&.
28135
28136 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28137 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28138
28139 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28140 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28141 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28142 response.
28143
28144 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28145 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28146 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28147
28148 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28149 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28150 However, the original message is available in the variable
28151 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28152 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28153 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28154 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28155
28156 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28157 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28158 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28159 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28160 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28161 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28162 effect.
28163
28164
28165 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28166 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28167 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28168 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28169
28170
28171 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28172 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28173 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28174 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28175
28176
28177 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28178 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28179 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28180 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28181 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28182 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28183 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28184 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28185 when:
28186 .code
28187 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28188 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28189 .endd
28190 .endlist
28191
28192
28193
28194
28195 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28196 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28197 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28198
28199 .vlist
28200 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28201 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28202 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28203 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28204 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28205 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28206 not work without it. For example:
28207 .code
28208 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28209 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28210 .endd
28211 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28212 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28213 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28214 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28215 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28216
28217
28218 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28219 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28220 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28221 .cindex "case of local parts"
28222 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28223 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28224 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28225 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28226 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28227 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28228 is encountered.
28229
28230 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28231 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28232 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28233 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28234 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28235
28236 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28237 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28238 spam score:
28239 .code
28240 warn control = caseful_local_part
28241 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28242 $acl_m4 + \
28243 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28244 }
28245 control = caselower_local_part
28246 .endd
28247 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28248 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28249
28250
28251 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28252 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28253 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28254 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28255
28256 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28257 If enabled for a message recieved via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28258 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28259 is used for all recipients of the message,
28260 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28261 and data is copied from one to the other.
28262
28263 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28264 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28265 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28266 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28267 any subsequent receipients and the data,
28268 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28269
28270 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28271 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28272 Note also that headers cannot be
28273 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28274 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28275
28276 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28277 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28278 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28279 It is not supported for messages recieved with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28280
28281 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28282 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28283 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28284 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28285 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28286 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28287
28288 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28289 (possibly faked)
28290 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28291
28292
28293 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28294 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28295 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28296 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28297 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28298 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28299 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28300 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28301 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28302 contexts):
28303 .code
28304 control = debug
28305 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28306 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28307 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28308 .endd
28309
28310
28311 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28312 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28313 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28314 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28315 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28316
28317
28318 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28319 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28320 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28321 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28322 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28323 strings or to numeric value.
28324 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28325 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28326 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28327
28328 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28329 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28330 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28331 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28332 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28333
28334
28335 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28336 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28337 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28338 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28339 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28340 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28341 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28342 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28343
28344 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28345 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28346 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28347 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28348 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28349 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28350 work with.
28351
28352
28353 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28354 .cindex "fake defer"
28355 .cindex "defer, fake"
28356 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28357 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28358 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28359 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28360 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28361
28362 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28363 .cindex "fake rejection"
28364 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28365 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28366 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28367 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28368 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28369 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28370 the same SMTP connection.
28371
28372 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28373 message is supplied, the following is used:
28374 .code
28375 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28376 550-kept for evaluation.
28377 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28378 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28379 .endd
28380 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28381
28382 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28383 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28384 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28385 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28386 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28387 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28388 SMTP connection.
28389
28390 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28391 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28392 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28393 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28394
28395 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28396 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28397 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28398 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28399 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28400 disables such output flushing.
28401
28402 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28403 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28404 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28405 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28406 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28407 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28408
28409 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28410 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28411 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28412 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28413 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28414 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28415 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28416 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28417 to be useful in production.
28418
28419 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28420 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28421 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28422 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28423 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28424
28425 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28426 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28427 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28428 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28429 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28430 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28431
28432 .ilist
28433 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28434 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28435 verification failed"&) is sent.
28436 .next
28437 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28438 line is output.
28439 .endlist
28440
28441 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28442 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28443
28444 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28445 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28446 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28447 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28448 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28449 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28450 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28451
28452 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28453 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28454 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28455 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28456 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28457 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28458 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28459 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28460 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28461 same SMTP connection.
28462
28463 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28464 .cindex "message" "submission"
28465 .cindex "submission mode"
28466 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28467 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28468 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28469 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28470 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28471 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28472 late (the message has already been created).
28473
28474 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28475 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28476 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28477 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28478 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28479
28480 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28481 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28482 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28483 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28484 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28485
28486 .ilist
28487 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28488 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28489 .next
28490 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28491 .next
28492 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28493 .endlist ilist
28494
28495 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28496 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28497 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28498 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28499 data is read.
28500
28501 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28502 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28503 .endlist vlist
28504
28505
28506 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28507 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28508
28509 .ilist
28510 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28511 .next
28512 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28513 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28514 .next
28515 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28516 .next
28517 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28518 .endlist
28519
28520
28521
28522 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28523 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28524 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28525 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28526 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28527 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28528 .code
28529 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28530 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28531 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28532 .endd
28533 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28534 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28535 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28536 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28537 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28538 RCPT ACL).
28539
28540 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28541 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28542
28543 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28544 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28545 contains one or more newlines that
28546 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28547 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28548 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28549
28550 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28551 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28552 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28553 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28554 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28555 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28556 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28557 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28558 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28559 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28560 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28561
28562 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28563 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28564 of message headers
28565 until they are added to the
28566 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28567 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28568 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28569 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28570 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28571 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28572 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28573
28574 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28575
28576 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28577 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28578 .display
28579 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28580 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28581
28582 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28583 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28584 .endd
28585 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28586 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28587 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28588 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28589 honoured.
28590
28591 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28592 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28593 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28594 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28595 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28596 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28597 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28598 specifications.
28599
28600 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28601 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28602 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28603 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28604 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28605
28606 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28607 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28608 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28609 to be a header name first.) For example:
28610 .code
28611 warn add_header = \
28612 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28613 .endd
28614 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28615 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28616 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28617 up in reverse order.
28618
28619 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28620 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28621 system filter or in a router or transport.
28622
28623
28624
28625 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28626 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28627 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28628 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28629 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28630 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28631 .code
28632 warn message = Remove internal headers
28633 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28634 .endd
28635 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28636 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28637 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28638 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28639 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28640 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28641
28642 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28643 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28644
28645 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28646 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28647 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28648 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28649 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28650 .code
28651 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28652 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28653 warn message = Remove internal headers
28654 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28655 .endd
28656 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28657 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28658 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28659 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28660 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28661 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28662 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28663 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28664 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28665 would have been removed.
28666
28667 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28668 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28669 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28670 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28671 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28672 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28673 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28674 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28675 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28676
28677 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28678 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28679 .display
28680 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28681 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28682
28683 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28684 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28685 .endd
28686 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28687 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28688 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28689 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28690 are honoured.
28691
28692 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28693 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28694 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28695
28696
28697
28698
28699 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28700 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28701 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28702 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28703 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28704 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28705
28706 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28707 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28708 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28709 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28710 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28711 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28712 The conditions are as follows:
28713
28714
28715 .vlist
28716 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28717 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28718 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28719 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28720 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28721 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28722 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28723 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28724 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28725 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28726 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28727 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28728
28729 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28730 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28731 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28732 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28733 The name and values are expanded separately.
28734 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28735 will act as argument separators.
28736
28737 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28738 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28739 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28740 conditions are tested.
28741
28742 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28743 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28744 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28745 for different local users or different local domains.
28746
28747 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28748 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28749 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28750 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28751 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28752 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28753 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28754 .code
28755 authenticated = *
28756 .endd
28757
28758 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28759 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28760 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28761 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28762 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28763 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28764 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28765 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28766 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28767 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28768 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28769 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28770 negative.
28771
28772 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28773 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28774 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28775 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28776 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28777 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28778 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28779 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28780
28781 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28782 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28783 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28784 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28785 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28786
28787 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28788 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28789 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28790 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28791 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28792 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28793 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28794 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28795 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28796 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28797
28798 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28799 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28800 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28801 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28802 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28803 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28804 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28805 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28806 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28807 &%domains%& test.
28808
28809 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28810 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28811
28812
28813 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28814 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28815 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28816 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28817 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28818 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28819 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28820 .code
28821 encrypted = *
28822 .endd
28823
28824
28825 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28826 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28827 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28828 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28829 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28830 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28831 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28832 .code
28833 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28834 .endd
28835 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28836 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28837 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28838
28839 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28840 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28841 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28842 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28843 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28844 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28845
28846 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28847 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28848 .code
28849 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28850 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28851 .endd
28852 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28853 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28854 statement can then check the IP address.
28855
28856 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28857 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28858 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28859 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28860 .code
28861 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28862 message = $host_data
28863 .endd
28864 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28865
28866 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28867 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28868 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28869 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28870 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28871 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28872 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28873 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28874 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28875 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28876
28877 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28878 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28879 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28880 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28881 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28882 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28883 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28884
28885 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28886 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
28887 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28888 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28889 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28890 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
28891 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
28892 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28893
28894 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
28895 .cindex "rate limiting"
28896 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
28897 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
28898
28899 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28900 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
28901 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
28902 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
28903 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
28904 recipient address against a list of recipients.
28905
28906 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28907 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
28908 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28909 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28910 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
28911 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
28912 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28913
28914 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28915 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
28916 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28917 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
28918 .vindex "&$domain$&"
28919 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
28920 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
28921 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
28922 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
28923 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
28924 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
28925 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
28926 influence the sender checking.
28927
28928 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28929 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28930
28931 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28932 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
28933 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28934 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
28935 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28936 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28937 .code
28938 senders = :
28939 .endd
28940 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28941 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28942
28943 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28944 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28945 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28946 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28947 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28948 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28949
28950 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28951 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28952 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28953 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28954 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28955 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28956 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28957 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28958 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28959 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28960
28961 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28962 .cindex "CSA verification"
28963 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28964 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28965 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28966
28967 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28968 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28969 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28970 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28971 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28972 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28973 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28974 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28975 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28976 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28977
28978 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28979 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28980 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
28981
28982 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28983 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28984 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28985 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28986 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28987 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28988 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28989 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28990 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
28991 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
28992 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
28993 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
28994 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
28995 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
28996 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
28997
28998 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
28999 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29000 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29001 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29002 .code
29003 deny senders = :
29004 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29005 !verify = header_sender
29006 .endd
29007
29008 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29009 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29010 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29011 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29012 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29013 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29014 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29015 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29016 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29017 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29018 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29019 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29020 appropriate.
29021
29022 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29023 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29024 .code
29025 To: @
29026 .endd
29027 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29028 common as they used to be.
29029
29030 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29031 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29032 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29033 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29034 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29035 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29036 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29037 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29038 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29039 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29040 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29041 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29042 independently of this condition.
29043
29044 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29045 option), this condition is always true.
29046
29047
29048 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29049 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29050 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29051 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29052 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29053 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29054 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29055 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29056 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29057
29058 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29059 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29060
29061
29062 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29063 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29064 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29065 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29066 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29067 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29068 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29069 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29070 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29071 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29072 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29073 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29074 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29075 value for the child address.
29076
29077 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29078 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29079 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29080 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29081 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29082 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29083 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29084 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29085 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29086 original IP address.
29087
29088 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29089 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29090
29091 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29092 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29093
29094 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29095 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29096 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29097 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29098 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29099 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29100 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29101 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29102 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29103
29104 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29105 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29106 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29107 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29108 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29109 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29110 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29111
29112 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29113 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29114 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29115
29116 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29117 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29118 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29119 verified as a sender.
29120 .endlist
29121
29122
29123
29124 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29125 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29126 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29127 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29128 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29129 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29130 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29131 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29132 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29133 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29134 .code
29135 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29136 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29137 .endd
29138 the following records are looked up:
29139 .code
29140 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29141 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29142 .endd
29143 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29144 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29145 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29146 use two separate conditions:
29147 .code
29148 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29149 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29150 .endd
29151 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29152 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29153 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29154 processed.
29155
29156 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29157 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29158 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29159 following special items in the list:
29160 .display
29161 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29162 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29163 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29164 .endd
29165 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29166 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29167 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29168 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29169 .code
29170 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29171 .endd
29172 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29173 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29174 .code
29175 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29176 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29177 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29178 .endd
29179 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
29180 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29181 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29182 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29183
29184
29185
29186 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29187 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29188 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29189 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29190 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29191 .code
29192 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29193 .endd
29194 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29195 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29196 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29197 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29198
29199
29200
29201
29202 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29203 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29204 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29205 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29206 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29207 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29208 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29209 .code
29210 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29211 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29212 .endd
29213 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29214 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29215 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29216 up by this example is
29217 .code
29218 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29219 .endd
29220 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29221 addresses. For example:
29222 .code
29223 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29224 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29225 .endd
29226 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29227 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29228
29229
29230
29231
29232 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29233 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29234 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29235 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29236 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29237 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29238 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29239 either to double the separators like this:
29240 .code
29241 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29242 .endd
29243 or to change the separator character, like this:
29244 .code
29245 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29246 .endd
29247 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29248 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29249 occurs. Consider this condition:
29250 .code
29251 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29252 .endd
29253 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29254 .code
29255 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29256 a.domain.black.list.tld
29257 .endd
29258 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29259 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29260 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29261 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29262 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29263 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29264 error for a previous item.
29265
29266 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29267 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29268 .code
29269 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29270 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29271 .endd
29272 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29273 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29274 .code
29275 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29276 $sender_address_domain \
29277 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29278 see $dnslist_text.
29279 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29280 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29281 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29282 .endd
29283 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29284 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29285 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29286 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29287 .code
29288 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29289 .endd
29290 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29291 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29292
29293 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29294 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29295
29296
29297
29298
29299 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29300 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29301 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29302 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29303 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29304 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29305 .display
29306 127.1.0.1 RBL
29307 127.1.0.2 DUL
29308 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29309 127.1.0.4 RSS
29310 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29311 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29312 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29313 .endd
29314 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29315 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29316 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29317
29318
29319 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29320 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29321 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29322 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29323 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29324 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29325 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29326 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29327 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29328 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29329 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29330 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29331 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29332 cases, for example:
29333 .code
29334 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29335 .endd
29336 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29337 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29338 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29339 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29340 .code
29341 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29342 .endd
29343 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29344 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29345
29346 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29347 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29348 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29349 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29350 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29351 information.
29352
29353 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29354 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29355 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29356 .code
29357 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29358 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29359 at $dnslist_domain
29360 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29361 .endd
29362
29363
29364
29365 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29366 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29367 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29368 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29369 For example,
29370 .code
29371 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29372 .endd
29373 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29374 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29375 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29376 describes how multiple records are handled.
29377
29378 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29379 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29380 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29381 .code
29382 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29383 .endd
29384 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29385 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29386 first. For example:
29387 .code
29388 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29389 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29390 .endd
29391
29392 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29393 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29394 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29395 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29396 tested. For example:
29397 .code
29398 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29399 .endd
29400 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29401 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29402 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29403 .code
29404 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29405 .endd
29406 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29407 an odd number.
29408
29409
29410
29411 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29412 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29413 condition. Whereas
29414 .code
29415 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29416 .endd
29417 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29418 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29419 .code
29420 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29421 .endd
29422 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29423 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29424 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29425 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29426
29427 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29428 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29429
29430 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29431 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29432 .code
29433 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29434 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29435 .endd
29436 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29437 Consider this example:
29438 .code
29439 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29440 list.dsbl.org : \
29441 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29442 relays.ordb.org
29443 .endd
29444 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29445 .code
29446 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29447 list.dsbl.org
29448 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29449 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29450 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29451 .endd
29452 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29453
29454
29455
29456
29457 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29458 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29459 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29460 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29461 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29462 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29463 .code
29464 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29465 .endd
29466 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29467 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29468 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29469 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29470 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29471 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29472
29473 .ilist
29474 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29475 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29476 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29477 .next
29478 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29479 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29480 changed to:
29481 .code
29482 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29483 .endd
29484 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29485 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29486 .code
29487 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29488 .endd
29489 for the condition to be true.
29490 .endlist
29491
29492 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29493 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29494 .ilist
29495 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29496 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29497 .code
29498 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29499 .endd
29500 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29501 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29502 .next
29503 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29504 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29505 .code
29506 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29507 .endd
29508 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29509 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29510 .code
29511 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29512 .endd
29513 for the condition to be false.
29514 .endlist
29515 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29516 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29517
29518
29519
29520
29521 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29522 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29523 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29524 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29525 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29526 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29527 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29528 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29529 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29530 lists.
29531
29532 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29533 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29534 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29535 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29536 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29537 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29538 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29539 .code
29540 reject message = \
29541 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29542 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29543 dnslists = \
29544 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29545 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29546 .endd
29547 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29548 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29549 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29550 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29551 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29552 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29553
29554 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29555 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29556 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29557 .code
29558 reject dnslists = \
29559 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29560 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29561 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29562 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29563 .endd
29564 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29565 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29566 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29567
29568
29569
29570 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29571 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29572 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29573 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29574 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29575 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29576 .code
29577 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29578 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29579 .endd
29580 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29581 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29582 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29583 .code
29584 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29585 .endd
29586 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29587 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29588
29589 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29590 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29591 .code
29592 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29593 dnslists = some.list.example
29594 .endd
29595
29596 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29597 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29598 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29599 .code
29600 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29601 .endd
29602
29603 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29604 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29605 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29606 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29607 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29608 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29609 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29610 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29611 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29612 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29613 .display
29614 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29615 .endd
29616 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29617 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29618
29619 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29620 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29621 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29622 of &'p'&.
29623
29624 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29625 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29626 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29627 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29628 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29629 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29630 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29631 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29632 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29633
29634 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29635 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29636 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29637 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29638
29639 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29640 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29641 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29642 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29643 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29644 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29645 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29646 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29647 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29648 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29649
29650 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29651 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29652 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29653 ACL.
29654
29655 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29656 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29657 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29658 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29659 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29660 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29661
29662 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29663 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29664 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29665 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29666 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29667 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29668 the &%count=%& option.
29669
29670
29671 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29672 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29673 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29674 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29675 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29676
29677 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29678 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29679 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29680 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29681
29682 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29683 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29684 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29685 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29686 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29687 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29688 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29689
29690 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29691 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29692 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29693 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29694 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
29695 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29696 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29697
29698 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29699 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29700 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29701 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29702 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29703
29704 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29705 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29706 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29707 multiple different commands.
29708
29709 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29710 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29711 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29712 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29713 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29714
29715 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29716
29717
29718 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29719 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29720 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29721 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29722 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29723
29724 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29725 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29726
29727 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29728 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29729 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29730 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29731 new rate.
29732 .code
29733 acl_check_connect:
29734 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29735 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29736 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29737 # ...
29738 acl_check_mail:
29739 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29740 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29741 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29742 .endd
29743
29744 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29745 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29746 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29747 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29748 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29749 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29750 checks.
29751
29752 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29753 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29754 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29755 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29756 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29757
29758
29759 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29760 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29761 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29762 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29763 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29764 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29765 rest of the ACL.
29766
29767 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29768 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29769 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29770 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29771 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29772 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29773 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29774 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29775 from getting any email through.
29776
29777 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29778 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29779 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29780 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29781 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29782 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29783 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29784 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29785 .code
29786 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29787 .endd
29788
29789
29790 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29791 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29792 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29793 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29794 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29795 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29796 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29797 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29798 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29799
29800 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29801 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29802 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29803 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29804 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29805 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29806
29807 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29808 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29809 rate.
29810
29811 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29812 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29813 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29814 required increases with larger limits.
29815
29816 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29817 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29818 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29819 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29820 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29821 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29822 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29823 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29824 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29825 as intended.
29826
29827
29828 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29829 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29830 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29831 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29832 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29833 message. For example:
29834 .code
29835 # Log all senders' rates
29836 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29837 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29838
29839 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29840 # at the decimal point.
29841 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29842 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29843 $sender_rate_limit }s
29844
29845 # Keep authenticated users under control
29846 deny authenticated = *
29847 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29848
29849 # System-wide rate limit
29850 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29851 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29852
29853 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29854 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29855 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29856 messages per $sender_rate_period
29857 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29858 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29859 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29860 .endd
29861 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29862 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29863 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29864 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29865 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29866 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29867 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29868
29869
29870
29871 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29872 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29873 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29874 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29875 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29876 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29877 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
29878 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
29879 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
29880 .code
29881 verify = sender/callout
29882 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
29883 .endd
29884 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
29885 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
29886 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
29887 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
29888 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
29889 The available options are as follows:
29890
29891 .ilist
29892 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
29893 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
29894 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
29895 .next
29896 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
29897 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
29898 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
29899 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
29900 .next
29901 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
29902 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
29903 .next
29904 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
29905 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
29906 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
29907 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
29908 .endlist
29909
29910 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
29911 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
29912 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
29913 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29914 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
29915 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
29916 coding like this:
29917 .code
29918 warn !verify = sender
29919 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
29920 .endd
29921 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
29922 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
29923 verification failure.
29924
29925 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
29926 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
29927
29928 .ilist
29929 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
29930 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
29931 .next
29932 &%route%&: Routing failed.
29933 .next
29934 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
29935 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
29936 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29937 .next
29938 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29939 .next
29940 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29941 .endlist
29942
29943 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29944 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29945
29946
29947
29948
29949 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29950 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29951 .cindex "callout" "verification"
29952 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29953 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29954 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29955 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29956 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29957 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29958 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29959 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29960 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29961 sender's domain.
29962
29963 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29964 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29965 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29966 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29967 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29968 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29969
29970 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29971 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29972 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29973 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29974 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29975
29976 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29977 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29978 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29979 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29980 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29981 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29982 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29983 supplies a host list.
29984 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
29985
29986 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29987 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29988 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
29989 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
29990 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
29991 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
29992 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
29993
29994 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
29995 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
29996 following SMTP commands are sent:
29997 .display
29998 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
29999 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30000 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30001 &`QUIT`&
30002 .endd
30003 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30004 set to &"lmtp"&.
30005
30006 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30007 settings.
30008
30009 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30010 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30011 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30012 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30013 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30014 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30015
30016 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30017 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30018 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30019 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30020 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30021
30022 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30023 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30024 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30025 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30026 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30027
30028
30029
30030
30031 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30032 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30033 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30034 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30035 .code
30036 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30037 .endd
30038 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30039 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30040 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30041
30042
30043 .vlist
30044 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30045 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30046 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30047 For example:
30048 .code
30049 verify = sender/callout=5s
30050 .endd
30051 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30052 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30053 the &%connect%& parameter.
30054
30055
30056 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30057 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30058 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30059 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30060 .code
30061 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30062 .endd
30063 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30064
30065 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30066 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30067 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30068 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30069 updated in this circumstance.
30070
30071 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30072 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30073 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30074 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30075 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30076 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30077
30078
30079 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30080 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30081 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30082 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30083 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30084 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30085 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30086 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30087 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30088 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30089 .code
30090 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30091 .endd
30092 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30093
30094
30095 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30096 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30097 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30098 For example:
30099 .code
30100 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30101 .endd
30102 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30103 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30104 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30105 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30106 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30107
30108
30109 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30110 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30111 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30112 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30113
30114 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30115 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30116 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30117 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30118 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30119 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30120 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30121 made, until the cache record expires.
30122
30123 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30124 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30125 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30126 For example:
30127 .code
30128 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30129 .endd
30130 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30131 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30132 .code
30133 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30134 .endd
30135 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30136 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30137 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30138 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30139
30140
30141 .vitem &*random*&
30142 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30143 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30144 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30145 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30146 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30147 .code
30148 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30149 .endd
30150 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30151 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30152 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30153 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30154 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30155
30156 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30157 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30158 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30159 .code
30160 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30161 .endd
30162 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30163 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30164 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30165 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30166 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30167
30168 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30169 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30170 .code
30171 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30172 .endd
30173 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30174 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30175 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30176 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30177 usefulness of callout caching.
30178 .endlist
30179
30180 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30181 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30182 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30183 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30184 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30185 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30186 these circumstances.
30187
30188 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30189 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30190 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30191 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30192 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30193 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30194 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30195
30196 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30197 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30198 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30199 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30200
30201
30202
30203
30204 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30205 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30206 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30207 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30208 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30209 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30210 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30211 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30212 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30213 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30214
30215 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30216 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30217 is not available.
30218
30219 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30220 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30221 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30222
30223 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30224 commands up to and including
30225 .code
30226 MAIL FROM:<>
30227 .endd
30228 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30229 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30230 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30231 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30232 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30233 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30234 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30235
30236 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30237 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30238 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30239 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30240 will eventually be noticed.
30241
30242 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30243 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30244 behaviour will be the same.
30245
30246
30247
30248 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30249 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30250 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30251 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30252 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30253 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30254 you might see:
30255 .code
30256 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30257 250 OK
30258 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30259 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30260 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30261 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30262 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30263 550 Sender verification failed
30264 .endd
30265 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30266 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30267 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30268 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30269 example:
30270 .code
30271 verify = sender/no_details
30272 .endd
30273
30274 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30275 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30276 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30277 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30278 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30279 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30280 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30281
30282 .ilist
30283 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30284 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30285 verification also fails.
30286 .next
30287 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30288 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30289 .endlist
30290
30291 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30292 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30293 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30294 .code
30295 A.Wol: aw123
30296 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30297 .endd
30298 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30299 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30300 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30301 verification to succeed.
30302
30303 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30304 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30305 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30306 option. For example:
30307 .code
30308 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30309 .endd
30310 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30311 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30312
30313 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30314 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30315 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30316 address and a report is output for each of them.
30317
30318
30319
30320 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30321 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30322 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30323 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30324 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30325 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30326 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30327 .code
30328 verify = csa
30329 .endd
30330 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30331 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30332 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30333 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30334 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30335 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30336
30337 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30338 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30339 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30340 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30341
30342 .ilist
30343 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30344 .next
30345 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30346 .next
30347 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30348 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30349 .next
30350 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30351 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30352 .endlist
30353
30354 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30355 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30356 .code
30357 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30358 .endd
30359 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30360 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30361 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30362 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30363 meaningful to say:
30364 .code
30365 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30366 .endd
30367 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30368 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30369 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30370
30371 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30372 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30373 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30374 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30375 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30376 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30377 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30378 of legitimate HELO domains.
30379
30380 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30381 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30382 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30383 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30384 lookup such as:
30385 .code
30386 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30387 .endd
30388 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30389 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30390 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30391
30392
30393
30394
30395 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30396 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30397 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30398 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30399 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30400 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30401 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30402 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30403
30404 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30405 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30406 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30407 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30408 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30409 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30410 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30411
30412 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30413 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30414 like this:
30415 .code
30416 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30417 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30418 }{$value}}
30419 .endd
30420 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30421 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30422 use this:
30423 .code
30424 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30425 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30426 senders = :
30427 recipients = +batv_senders
30428
30429 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30430 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30431 senders = :
30432 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30433 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30434 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30435 .endd
30436 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30437 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30438 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30439 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30440 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30441
30442 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30443 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30444 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30445 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30446 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30447 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30448 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30449
30450 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30451 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30452 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30453 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30454 .code
30455 batv_redirect:
30456 driver = redirect
30457 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30458 .endd
30459 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30460 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30461 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30462 local addresses.
30463
30464 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30465 can be used:
30466 .code
30467 external_smtp_batv:
30468 driver = smtp
30469 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30470 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30471 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30472 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30473 {$value}fail}}}
30474 .endd
30475 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30476
30477
30478
30479 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30480 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30481 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30482 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30483 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30484 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30485 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30486 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30487 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30488 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30489
30490 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30491 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30492 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30493 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30494 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30495 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30496 . ///
30497 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30498 . ///
30499 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30500 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30501 system to arbitrary domains.
30502
30503
30504 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30505 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30506 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30507 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30508
30509 .ilist
30510 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30511 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30512 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30513 .next
30514 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30515 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30516 .next
30517 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30518 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30519 .endlist
30520
30521
30522 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30523 .code
30524 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30525 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30526 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30527 .endd
30528 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30529 command:
30530 .code
30531 acl_check_rcpt:
30532 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30533 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30534 .endd
30535 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30536 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30537 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30538 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30539 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30540 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30541 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30542
30543
30544
30545 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30546 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30547 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30548 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30549 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30550
30551 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30552 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30553 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30554 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30555 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30556 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30557 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30558 .ecindex IIDacl
30559
30560
30561
30562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30564
30565 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30566 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30567 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30568 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30569 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30570 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30571 specification.
30572
30573 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30574 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30575 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30576 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30577 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30578
30579 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30580 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30581 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30582
30583 .ilist
30584 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30585 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30586 .next
30587 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30588 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30589 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30590 .next
30591 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30592 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30593 .next
30594 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30595 conditions.
30596 .next
30597 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30598 .endlist
30599
30600 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30601 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30602 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30603
30604 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30605 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30606 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30607 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30608 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30609 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30610
30611 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30612 temporarily created in a file called:
30613 .display
30614 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30615 .endd
30616 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30617 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30618 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30619 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30620 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30621 .code
30622 control = no_mbox_unspool
30623 .endd
30624 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30625 same directory by default.
30626
30627
30628
30629 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30630 .cindex "virus scanning"
30631 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30632 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30633 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30634 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30635 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30636 in memory and thus are much faster.
30637
30638 .new
30639 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30640 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30641 .wen
30642
30643 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30644 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30645 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30646 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30647 .display
30648 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30649 .endd
30650 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30651 .code
30652 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30653 .endd
30654 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30655 before use.
30656 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30657 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30658
30659 .vlist
30660 .new
30661 .vitem &%avast%&
30662 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30663 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30664 Security (currenty at version 1.1.7).
30665 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30666 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30667 This scanner type takes one option,
30668 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30669 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30670 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30671 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30672 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30673 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30674 For example:
30675 .code
30676 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30677 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30678 .endd
30679 If you omit the argument, the default path
30680 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30681 is used.
30682 If you use a remote host,
30683 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30684 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30685 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30686 .code
30687 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30688 FLAGS
30689 SENSITIVITY
30690 PACK
30691 .endd
30692 .wen
30693
30694
30695 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30696 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30697 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30698 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30699 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30700 example:
30701 .code
30702 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30703 .endd
30704
30705
30706 .vitem &%clamd%&
30707 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30708 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30709 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30710 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30711 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30712
30713 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30714 a UNIX socket specification,
30715 a TCP socket specification,
30716 or a (global) option.
30717
30718 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30719 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30720 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30721 and the second a port number,
30722 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30723 These per-server options are supported:
30724 .code
30725 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30726 .endd
30727
30728 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30729 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30730
30731 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30732
30733 Examples:
30734 .code
30735 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30736 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30737 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30738 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30739 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30740 .endd
30741 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30742 &`local`&
30743 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30744 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30745 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30746 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30747 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30748 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30749
30750 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30751 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30752 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30753 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30754 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30755 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30756 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30757 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30758 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30759 .code
30760 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30761 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30762 (Connection refused)
30763 .endd
30764
30765 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30766 contributing the code for this scanner.
30767
30768 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30769 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30770 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30771 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30772 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30773
30774 .olist
30775 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30776 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30777
30778 .next
30779 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30780 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30781 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30782 the &"trigger"& expression.
30783
30784 .next
30785 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30786 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30787 &"name"& expression.
30788 .endlist olist
30789
30790 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30791 .code
30792 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30793 .endd
30794 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30795 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30796 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30797 configuration setting:
30798 .code
30799 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30800 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30801 found in file:'(.+)'
30802 .endd
30803 .vitem &%drweb%&
30804 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30805 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30806 takes one option,
30807 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30808 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30809 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30810 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30811 For example:
30812 .code
30813 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30814 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30815 .endd
30816 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30817 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30818
30819 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30820 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30821 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30822 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30823 (or port-range).
30824 For example:
30825 .code
30826 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30827 .endd
30828 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30829
30830 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30831 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30832 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30833 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30834 .code
30835 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30836 .endd
30837 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30838 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30839
30840 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30841 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30842 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30843 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30844 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30845 For example:
30846 .code
30847 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30848 .endd
30849 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30850
30851 .vitem &%mksd%&
30852 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30853 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30854 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30855 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30856 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30857 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30858 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30859 .code
30860 av_scanner = mksd:2
30861 .endd
30862 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30863
30864 .vitem &%sock%&
30865 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30866 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30867 running on the local machine.
30868 There are four options:
30869 an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30870 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30871 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30872 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30873 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30874 For example:
30875 .code
30876 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30877 .endd
30878 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30879 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30880 Both regular-expressions are required.
30881
30882 .vitem &%sophie%&
30883 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
30884 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
30885 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
30886 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
30887 client communication. For example:
30888 .code
30889 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
30890 .endd
30891 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
30892 the option.
30893 .endlist
30894
30895 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
30896 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
30897 ACL.
30898
30899 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
30900 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
30901 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
30902 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
30903 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
30904 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
30905 message.
30906
30907 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
30908 .new
30909 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
30910 .wen
30911 The first element can then be one of
30912
30913 .ilist
30914 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
30915 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
30916 recommended usage.
30917 .next
30918 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
30919 the condition fails immediately.
30920 .next
30921 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
30922 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
30923 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
30924 .new
30925 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
30926 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
30927 .wen
30928 .endlist
30929
30930 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
30931 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
30932 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
30933
30934 .new
30935 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
30936 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
30937 For example:
30938 .code
30939 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
30940 .endd
30941 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
30942 .wen
30943
30944 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
30945 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
30946 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
30947 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
30948 logging data.
30949
30950 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
30951 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
30952 &%malware%& condition.
30953
30954 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
30955 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
30956
30957 Here is a very simple scanning example:
30958 .code
30959 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30960 demime = *
30961 malware = *
30962 .endd
30963 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
30964 .code
30965 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30966 demime = *
30967 malware = */defer_ok
30968 .endd
30969 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
30970 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
30971 .code
30972 av_scanner = $acl_m0
30973 .endd
30974 in the main Exim configuration.
30975 .code
30976 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30977 set acl_m0 = sophie
30978 malware = *
30979
30980 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30981 set acl_m0 = aveserver
30982 malware = *
30983 .endd
30984
30985
30986 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
30987 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
30988 .cindex "spam scanning"
30989 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
30990 .cindex "Rspamd"
30991 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
30992 score and a report for the message.
30993 .new
30994 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
30995
30996 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
30997 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
30998 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
30999 .wen
31000
31001 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31002 .code
31003 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31004 .endd
31005 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31006 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31007 nicely, however.
31008
31009 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31010 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31011 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31012 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31013 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31014 configuration as follows (example):
31015 .code
31016 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31017 .endd
31018
31019 .new
31020 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31021 on TCP port 11333)
31022 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31023 .code
31024 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31025 .endd
31026 .wen
31027
31028 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31029 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31030 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31031 .code
31032 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31033 .endd
31034 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31035 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31036 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31037 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31038 .code
31039 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31040 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31041 192.168.2.12 783
31042 .endd
31043 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31044 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31045 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31046 condition defers.
31047
31048 .new
31049 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31050 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31051 and changeable in the usual way.
31052
31053 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31054 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31055 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31056 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31057
31058 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31059 are options.
31060 The supported option are:
31061 .code
31062 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31063 weight=<value> Selection bias
31064 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31065 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31066 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31067 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31068 .endd
31069
31070 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31071 higher values being tried first.
31072 The deafult priority is 1.
31073
31074 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31075 Within a priority set
31076 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31077 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31078
31079 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31080 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31081 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31082 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31083
31084 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31085 are the usual Exim time interval standard, eg. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31086
31087 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31088 The default value is two minutes.
31089
31090 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31091 a failed connect is made.
31092 The default is to not retry.
31093 .wen
31094
31095 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31096 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31097 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31098 expansion.
31099
31100 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31101 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31102 .code
31103 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31104 spam = joe
31105 .endd
31106 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31107 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31108 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31109 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31110 .new
31111 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31112 right-hand side.
31113 .wen
31114
31115 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31116 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31117 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31118 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
31119 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31120 are not set.
31121 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31122 (eg. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31123 after the first),
31124 or the use of PRDR,
31125 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31126 are needed to use this feature.
31127
31128 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31129 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31130 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31131
31132
31133 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31134 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31135 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31136 example:
31137 .code
31138 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31139 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31140 spam = nobody
31141 .endd
31142
31143 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31144 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31145 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31146 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31147
31148 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31149 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31150 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
31151 available for use at delivery time.
31152
31153 .vlist
31154 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31155 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31156 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31157
31158 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31159 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31160 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31161 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31162 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31163
31164 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31165 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31166 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31167 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31168 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
31169
31170 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31171 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31172 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31173
31174 .new
31175 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31176 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31177 spam score versus threshold.
31178 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31179 .wen
31180
31181 .endlist
31182
31183 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31184 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31185 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31186
31187 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31188 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31189 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31190 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31191 spam condition, like this:
31192 .code
31193 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31194 spam = joe/defer_ok
31195 .endd
31196 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31197
31198 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31199 condition:
31200 .code
31201 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31202 warn spam = nobody:true
31203 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31204 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31205
31206 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31207 # is over threshold
31208 warn spam = nobody
31209 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31210
31211 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31212 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31213 spam = nobody:true
31214 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31215 .endd
31216
31217
31218
31219 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31220 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31221 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31222 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31223 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31224 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31225 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31226 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31227 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31228 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31229 cases.
31230
31231 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31232 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31233 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31234 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31235 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31236 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31237 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31238
31239 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31240 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31241 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31242 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31243 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31244
31245 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31246 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31247 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31248 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31249 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31250 syntax is:
31251 .display
31252 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31253 .endd
31254 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31255 the value can be:
31256
31257 .olist
31258 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31259 .next
31260 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31261 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31262 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31263 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31264 .next
31265 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31266 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31267 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31268 the full path and file name.
31269 .next
31270 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31271 filename, and the default path is then used.
31272 .endlist
31273 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31274 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31275 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31276 .code
31277 decode = $mime_filename
31278 .endd
31279 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31280 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31281 automatically unlinked.
31282
31283 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31284 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31285 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31286 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31287 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31288
31289 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31290 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31291 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31292
31293 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31294 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31295 available in the MIME ACL:
31296
31297 .vlist
31298 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31299 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31300 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31301 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31302 contains the empty string.
31303
31304 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31305 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31306 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31307 .code
31308 us-ascii
31309 gb2312 (Chinese)
31310 iso-8859-1
31311 .endd
31312 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31313 case-insensitively.
31314
31315 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31316 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31317 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31318 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31319 only used for display purposes.
31320
31321 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31322 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31323 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31324
31325 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31326 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31327 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31328
31329 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31330 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31331 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31332 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31333 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31334
31335 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31336 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31337 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31338 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31339
31340 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31341 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31342 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31343 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31344 .code
31345 text/plain
31346 text/html
31347 application/octet-stream
31348 image/jpeg
31349 audio/midi
31350 .endd
31351 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31352 empty string.
31353
31354 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31355 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31356 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31357 containing the decoded data.
31358 .endlist
31359
31360 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31361 .vlist
31362 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31363 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31364 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31365 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31366 RFC2047 or RFC2231 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31367 If no filename was
31368 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31369
31370 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31371 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31372 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31373 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31374
31375 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31376 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31377 follows:
31378
31379 .olist
31380 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31381
31382 .next
31383 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31384 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31385
31386 .next
31387 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31388 and the rest are attachments.
31389
31390 .next
31391 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31392 .endlist olist
31393
31394 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31395 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31396 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31397 .code
31398 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31399 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31400 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31401 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31402 .endd
31403 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31404 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31405 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31406 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31407 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31408
31409 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31410 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31411 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31412 decoding is fully recursive.
31413
31414 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31415 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31416 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31417 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31418 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31419 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31420 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31421 .endlist
31422
31423
31424
31425 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31426 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31427 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31428 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31429 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31430
31431 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31432 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31433 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31434 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31435 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31436
31437 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31438 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31439 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31440 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31441 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31442 32K characters are checked.
31443
31444 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31445 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31446 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31447 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31448 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31449 .code
31450 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31451 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31452 .endd
31453 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31454 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31455 matching regular expression.
31456
31457 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31458 CPU-intensive.
31459
31460
31461
31462
31463 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31464 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31465 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31466 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31467 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31468 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31469 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31470 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31471 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31472 use the &%demime%& condition.
31473
31474 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31475 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31476 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31477 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31478 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31479 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31480
31481 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31482 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31483 example:
31484 .code
31485 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31486 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31487 .endd
31488 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31489 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31490 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31491 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31492
31493 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31494 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31495 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31496
31497 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31498
31499 .vlist
31500 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31501 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31502 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31503 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31504 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31505 zero, no error occurred.
31506
31507 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31508 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31509 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31510 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31511 .endlist
31512
31513 .vlist
31514 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31515 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31516 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31517 extension it found.
31518 .endlist
31519
31520 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31521 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31522
31523 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31524 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31525 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31526 facility:
31527 .code
31528 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31529 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31530 demime = *
31531 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31532
31533 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31534 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31535 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31536 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31537
31538 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31539 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31540 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31541 demime = exe:doc
31542 control = freeze
31543 .endd
31544 .ecindex IIDcosca
31545
31546
31547
31548
31549 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31551
31552 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31553 "Local scan function"
31554 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31555 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31556 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31557 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31558 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31559
31560 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31561 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31562 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31563 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31564 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31565
31566 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31567 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31568 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31569 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31570
31571 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31572 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31573 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31574 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31575
31576 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31577 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31578 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31579 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31580 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31581 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31582 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31583 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31584 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31585
31586
31587
31588 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31589 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31590 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31591 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31592 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31593 directory, so you might set
31594 .code
31595 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31596 .endd
31597 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31598 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31599 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31600 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31601 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31602 _src/local_scan.c_.
31603
31604 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31605 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31606 .code
31607 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31608 .endd
31609 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31610
31611
31612
31613
31614 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31615 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31616 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31617 .code
31618 #include "local_scan.h"
31619 .endd
31620 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31621 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31622 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31623 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31624 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31625 strings and pointers to character strings:
31626 .code
31627 #define CS (char *)
31628 #define CCS (const char *)
31629 #define CSS (char **)
31630 #define US (unsigned char *)
31631 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31632 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31633 .endd
31634 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31635 .code
31636 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31637 .endd
31638 The arguments are as follows:
31639
31640 .ilist
31641 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31642 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31643 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31644
31645 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31646 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31647 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31648 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31649 case this changes in some future version.
31650 .next
31651 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31652 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31653 .endlist
31654
31655 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31656
31657 .vlist
31658 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31659 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31660 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31661 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31662 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31663 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31664
31665 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31666 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31667 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31668
31669 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31670 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31671 queued without immediate delivery.
31672
31673 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31674 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31675 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31676 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31677 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31678 used.
31679
31680 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31681 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31682 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31683 problem"& is used.
31684
31685 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31686 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31687 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31688 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31689 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31690 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31691 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31692
31693 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31694 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31695 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31696 .endlist
31697
31698 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31699 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31700 &%-oe%& command line options.
31701
31702
31703
31704 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31705 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31706 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31707 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31708 want to do this, you must have the line
31709 .code
31710 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31711 .endd
31712 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31713 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31714 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31715 to define them.
31716
31717 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31718 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31719 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31720 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31721 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31722 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31723 .code
31724 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31725 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31726
31727 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31728 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31729 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31730 };
31731
31732 int local_scan_options_count =
31733 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31734 .endd
31735 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31736 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31737 .code
31738 begin local_scan
31739 my_integer = 99
31740 my_string = some string of text...
31741 .endd
31742 The available types of option data are as follows:
31743
31744 .vlist
31745 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31746 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31747 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31748 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31749 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31750 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31751 values.)
31752
31753 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31754 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31755 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31756 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31757
31758 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31759 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31760 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31761 Exim.
31762
31763 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31764 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31765 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31766 printed with the suffix K or M.
31767
31768 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31769 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31770 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31771 always output in octal.
31772
31773 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31774 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31775 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31776
31777 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31778 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31779 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31780 .endlist
31781
31782 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31783 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31784
31785
31786
31787 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31788 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31789 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31790 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31791 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31792 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31793 C variables are as follows:
31794
31795 .vlist
31796 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31797 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31798
31799 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31800 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31801
31802 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31803 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31804 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31805 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31806
31807 .ilist
31808 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31809 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31810 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31811
31812 .next
31813 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31814 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31815 of debugging bits.
31816 .endlist ilist
31817
31818 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31819 selected, you should use code like this:
31820 .code
31821 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31822 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31823 .endd
31824 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31825 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31826 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31827
31828 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31829 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31830 discussed below.
31831
31832 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31833 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31834
31835 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31836 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31837
31838 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31839 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31840 &%-bh%& command line option.
31841
31842 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31843 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31844 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31845
31846 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31847 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31848 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31849 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31850
31851 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31852 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31853 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31854
31855 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31856 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31857
31858 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31859 The number of accepted recipients.
31860
31861 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31862 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31863 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31864 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31865 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31866 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31867 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31868 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31869 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31870 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31871 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31872 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31873
31874 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31875 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31876
31877 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31878 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31879 locally-submitted messages.
31880
31881 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
31882 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
31883 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
31884
31885 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
31886 The name of the sending host, if known.
31887
31888 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
31889 The port on the sending host.
31890
31891 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
31892 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
31893
31894 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
31895 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
31896
31897 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
31898 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
31899 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
31900 .endlist
31901
31902
31903 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
31904 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
31905 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
31906 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
31907 their type to *.
31908
31909
31910 .vlist
31911 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
31912 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
31913
31914 .vitem &*int&~type*&
31915 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
31916 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
31917 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
31918 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
31919 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
31920 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
31921
31922 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
31923 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
31924 internal newlines.
31925
31926 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
31927 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
31928 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
31929 .endlist
31930
31931
31932
31933 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
31934 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
31935
31936 .vlist
31937 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
31938 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
31939
31940 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
31941 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
31942 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
31943 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
31944
31945 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
31946 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
31947 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
31948 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
31949 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
31950 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
31951 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
31952 is NULL for all recipients.
31953 .endlist
31954
31955
31956
31957 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
31958 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
31959 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
31960 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
31961 release:
31962
31963 .vlist
31964 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
31965 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
31966
31967 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
31968 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
31969 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
31970 for the process in &%newumask%&.
31971
31972 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
31973 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
31974 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
31975 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
31976 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
31977
31978 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
31979
31980 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
31981 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
31982 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
31983 return value is as follows:
31984
31985 .ilist
31986 >= 0
31987
31988 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
31989 ending status.
31990
31991 .next
31992 < 0 and > &--256
31993
31994 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
31995 signal number.
31996
31997 .next
31998 &--256
31999
32000 The process timed out.
32001 .next
32002 &--257
32003
32004 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32005 .endlist
32006
32007 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32008 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32009 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32010 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32011 forks a subprocess that is running
32012 .code
32013 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32014 .endd
32015 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32016 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32017 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32018 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32019
32020 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32021 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32022 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32023 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32024
32025
32026 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32027 *sender_authentication)*&
32028 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32029 that it runs is:
32030 .display
32031 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32032 .endd
32033 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32034
32035
32036 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32037 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32038 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32039 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32040 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32041 .code
32042 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32043 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32044 .endd
32045
32046 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32047 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32048 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32049 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32050 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32051 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32052 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32053 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32054
32055 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32056 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32057 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32058 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32059 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32060 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32061
32062 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32063 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32064 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32065 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32066
32067 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32068 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32069 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32070 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32071 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32072 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32073 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32074 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32075 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32076 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32077 .code
32078 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32079 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32080 .endd
32081 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32082 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32083
32084
32085 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32086 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32087 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32088 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32089 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32090
32091
32092 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32093 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32094 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32095 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32096 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32097 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32098 .code
32099 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32100 .endd
32101 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32102 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32103 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32104 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32105 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32106 zero-terminated.
32107
32108 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32109 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32110 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32111 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32112 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32113 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32114 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32115 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32116
32117 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32118 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32119 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32120 .display
32121 &`OK `& match succeeded
32122 &`FAIL `& match failed
32123 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32124 .endd
32125 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32126 inability to contact a database.
32127
32128 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32129 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32130 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32131 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32132 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32133
32134 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32135 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32136 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32137 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32138 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32139
32140 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32141 uschar&~*list)*&"
32142 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32143 expected to be
32144 .code
32145 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32146 .endd
32147 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32148 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32149 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32150 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32151 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32152 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32153 failed.
32154
32155 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32156 *format,&~...)*&"
32157 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32158 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32159 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32160 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32161 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32162 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32163
32164
32165 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32166 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32167 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32168 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32169
32170 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32171 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32172 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32173 value afterwards. For example:
32174 .code
32175 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32176 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32177 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32178 .endd
32179
32180 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32181 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32182 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32183 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32184 address.
32185 .endlist
32186
32187
32188 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32189 .vlist
32190 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32191 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32192 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32193 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32194 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32195 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32196 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32197 binary string is returned with an error message.
32198
32199 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32200 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32201 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32202
32203 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32204 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32205 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32206 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32207 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32208
32209 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32210 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32211 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32212
32213 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32214 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32215 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32216 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32217 with translation.
32218
32219
32220 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32221 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32222 below.
32223
32224 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32225 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32226 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32227 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32228 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32229 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32230 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32231 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32232 is involved.
32233
32234 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32235 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32236
32237 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32238 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32239 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32240 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32241 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32242 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32243 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32244 .code
32245 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32246 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32247 .endd
32248 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32249 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32250 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32251 multiple output lines.
32252
32253 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32254 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32255 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32256 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32257 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32258 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32259 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32260 is an error.
32261
32262 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32263 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32264 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32265 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32266
32267 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32268 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32269 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32270
32271 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32272 See below.
32273
32274 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32275 See below.
32276
32277 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32278 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32279 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32280 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32281 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32282 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32283 more discussion.
32284 .endlist
32285
32286
32287
32288 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32289 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32290 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32291 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32292 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32293 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32294 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32295 terminates.
32296
32297 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32298 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32299 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32300 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32301
32302 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32303 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32304 .code
32305 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32306 .endd
32307 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32308 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32309 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32310 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32311
32312 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32313 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32314 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32315 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32316 &%store_pool%&.
32317 .ecindex IIDlosca
32318
32319
32320
32321
32322 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32323 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32324
32325 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32326 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32327 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32328 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32329 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32330 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32331 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32332 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32333
32334 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32335 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32336 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32337 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32338 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32339
32340 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32341 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32342 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32343 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32344 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32345 prevent it happening on retries.
32346
32347 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32348 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32349 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32350 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32351 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32352 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32353 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32354 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32355
32356
32357 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32358 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32359 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32360 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32361 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32362 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32363 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32364 .code
32365 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32366 system_filter_user = exim
32367 .endd
32368 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32369 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32370 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32371 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32372 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32373 by the &%reply%& command.
32374
32375
32376 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32377 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32378 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32379 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32380
32381 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32382 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32383
32384
32385
32386 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32387 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32388 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32389 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32390 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32391 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32392 they cause errors.
32393
32394 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32395 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32396 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32397 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32398 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32399 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32400 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32401
32402 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32403 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32404 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32405 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32406 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32407
32408 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32409 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32410 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32411 to which users' filter files can refer.
32412
32413
32414
32415 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32416 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32417 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32418 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32419 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32420
32421
32422
32423 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32424 .cindex "freezing messages"
32425 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32426 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32427 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32428 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32429 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32430 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32431 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32432 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32433 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32434 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32435 .code
32436 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32437 .endd
32438 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32439
32440 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32441 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32442 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32443 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32444 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32445 run.
32446
32447 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32448 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32449 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32450 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32451
32452 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32453 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32454 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32455 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32456 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32457 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32458 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32459 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32460 message. For example:
32461 .code
32462 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32463 because it contains attachments that we are \
32464 not prepared to receive."
32465 .endd
32466
32467 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32468 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32469 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32470 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32471 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32472 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32473 use, for example
32474 .code
32475 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32476 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32477 .endd
32478 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32479 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32480 generated by the filter.
32481
32482 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32483 &%defer%&,
32484 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32485 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32486 as
32487 .code
32488 mail ...
32489 freeze
32490 .endd
32491 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32492 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32493 take place.
32494
32495
32496
32497 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32498 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32499 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32500 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32501 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32502 .code
32503 headers add <string>
32504 headers remove <string>
32505 .endd
32506 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32507 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32508 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32509 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32510 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32511
32512 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32513 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32514 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32515 example:
32516 .code
32517 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32518 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32519 X-header-2: ...."
32520 .endd
32521 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32522 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32523 space after input continuations is ignored.
32524
32525 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32526 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32527 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32528 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32529 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32530
32531 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32532 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32533 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32534 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32535 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32536 used for all recipients of the message.
32537
32538 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32539 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32540 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32541 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32542 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32543 until the message is actually being written (see section
32544 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32545
32546 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32547 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32548 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32549 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32550 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32551 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32552 modified more than once.
32553
32554 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32555 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32556 For example:
32557 .code
32558 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32559 headers remove "Subject"
32560 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32561 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32562 .endd
32563
32564
32565
32566 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32567 .cindex "envelope sender"
32568 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32569 .code
32570 errors_to <some address>
32571 .endd
32572 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32573 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32574 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32575 might use
32576 .code
32577 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32578 .endd
32579 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32580 address if its delivery failed.
32581
32582
32583
32584 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32585 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32586 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32587 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32588 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32589 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32590 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32591 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32592 which implements such a filter:
32593 .code
32594 central_filter:
32595 check_local_user
32596 driver = redirect
32597 domains = +local_domains
32598 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32599 no_verify
32600 allow_filter
32601 allow_freeze
32602 .endd
32603 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32604 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32605 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32606 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32607
32608 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32609 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32610 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32611 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32612 normal way.
32613 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32614 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32615 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32616
32617
32618
32619
32620
32621
32622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32623 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32624
32625 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32626 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32627 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32628 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32629 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32630 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32631 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32632 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32633
32634 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32635 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32636 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32637 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32638 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32639
32640 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32641 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32642 loopback interface specially in any way.
32643
32644 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32645 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32646
32647
32648
32649
32650 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32651 .cindex "message" "submission"
32652 .cindex "submission mode"
32653 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32654 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32655 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32656 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32657 .code
32658 control = submission
32659 .endd
32660 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32661 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32662 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32663 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32664 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32665 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32666 .code
32667 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32668 control = submission
32669 .endd
32670 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32671 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32672 is used to separate options. For example:
32673 .code
32674 control = submission/sender_retain
32675 .endd
32676 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32677 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32678 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32679 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32680 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32681 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32682 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32683
32684 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32685 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32686 example:
32687 .code
32688 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32689 .endd
32690 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32691 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32692 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32693 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32694 .code
32695 accept authenticated = *
32696 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32697 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32698 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32699 .endd
32700 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32701 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32702 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32703 .code
32704 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32705 .endd
32706 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32707 line would be:
32708 .code
32709 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32710 .endd
32711 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32712 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32713 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32714 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32715
32716 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32717 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32718 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32719 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32720 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32721 spoof another's address.
32722
32723 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32724 .cindex "line endings"
32725 .cindex "carriage return"
32726 .cindex "linefeed"
32727 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32728 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32729 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32730 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32731 use CRLF or just CR.
32732
32733 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32734 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32735 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32736 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32737 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32738 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32739 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32740 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32741 follows:
32742
32743 .ilist
32744 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32745 .next
32746 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32747 is ignored.
32748 .next
32749 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32750 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32751 terminator.
32752 .next
32753 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32754 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32755 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32756 people trying to play silly games.
32757 .next
32758 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32759 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32760 line.
32761 .endlist
32762
32763
32764
32765
32766
32767 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32768 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32769 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32770 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32771 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32772 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32773 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32774 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32775
32776 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32777 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32778 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32779 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32780 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32781
32782 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32783 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32784 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32785 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32786 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32787 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32788 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32789 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32790
32791
32792
32793
32794 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32795 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32796 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32797 .cindex "sender" "address"
32798 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32799 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32800 .cindex "envelope sender"
32801 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32802 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32803 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32804 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32805 .code
32806 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32807 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32808 .endd
32809 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32810 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32811 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32812 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32813 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32814 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32815 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32816 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32817 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32818
32819 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32820 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32821 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32822 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32823 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32824 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32825 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32826
32827 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32828 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32829 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32830
32831 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32832 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32833 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32834 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32835
32836
32837
32838 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32839 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32840 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32841 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32842 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32843 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32844 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32845
32846 .blockquote
32847 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32848 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32849 .endblockquote
32850
32851 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32852 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32853 follows:
32854
32855 .ilist
32856 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32857 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32858 .next
32859 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32860 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32861 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32862 .next
32863 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32864 also removed.
32865 .next
32866 For a locally-submitted message,
32867 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32868 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32869 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32870 included in log lines in this case.
32871 .next
32872 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32873 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32874 .endlist
32875
32876
32877
32878
32879 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32880 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32881 includes the header line:
32882 .code
32883 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
32884 .endd
32885
32886 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
32887 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
32888 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
32889 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
32890 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
32891 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
32892
32893
32894 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
32895 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
32896 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
32897 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
32898 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
32899
32900 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
32901 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
32902 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
32903 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
32904 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
32905 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
32906 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
32907 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
32908 messages.
32909
32910
32911 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
32912 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
32913 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
32914 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
32915 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
32916 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
32917 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
32918 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
32919 messages.
32920
32921
32922 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
32923 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
32924 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32925 .cindex "message" "submission"
32926 .cindex "submission mode"
32927 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
32928 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
32929
32930 .ilist
32931 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
32932 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
32933 .next
32934 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32935 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
32936 .olist
32937 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32938 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32939 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32940 .next
32941 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
32942 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32943 .next
32944 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32945 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32946 .endlist
32947 .endlist
32948
32949 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
32950
32951 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
32952 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
32953 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
32954 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32955 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
32956 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
32957 &%qualify_domain%&.
32958
32959 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
32960 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
32961 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
32962 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32963
32964
32965 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
32966 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
32967 .cindex "message" "submission"
32968 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
32969 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
32970 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
32971 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
32972 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
32973 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
32974 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
32975 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
32976 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
32977 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
32978
32979
32980 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
32981 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
32982 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
32983 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
32984 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
32985
32986 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
32987 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
32988 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
32989 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
32990
32991 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
32992 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
32993 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
32994
32995
32996 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
32997 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
32998 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
32999 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33000 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33001 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33002 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33003 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33004 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33005 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33006 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33007
33008
33009
33010 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33011 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33012 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33013 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33014 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33015 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33016 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33017 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33018
33019
33020
33021 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33022 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33023 .cindex "message" "submission"
33024 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33025 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33026 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33027 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33028 control setting.
33029
33030 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33031 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33032 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33033 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33034 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33035 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33036 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33037 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33038 line is added to the message.
33039
33040 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33041 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33042 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33043 options true at the same time.
33044
33045 .cindex "submission mode"
33046 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33047 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33048 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33049 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33050
33051 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33052 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33053 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33054 created as follows:
33055
33056 .ilist
33057 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33058 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33059 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33060 .next
33061 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33062 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33063 .next
33064 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33065 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33066 .endlist
33067
33068 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33069 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33070 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33071 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33072
33073 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33074 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33075 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33076 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33077
33078
33079
33080 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33081 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33082 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33083 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33084 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33085 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33086 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33087 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33088 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33089
33090 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33091 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33092 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33093 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33094 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33095 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33096
33097 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33098 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33099 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33100
33101 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33102 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33103 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33104 .code
33105 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33106 X-added-second: another added header line
33107 .endd
33108 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33109
33110 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33111 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33112 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33113
33114 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33115 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33116 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33117 not part of the names. For example:
33118 .code
33119 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33120 .endd
33121
33122 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33123 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33124 Each item is separately expanded.
33125 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33126 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33127 will act as list separators.
33128
33129 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33130 items are expanded at routing time,
33131 and then associated with all addresses that are
33132 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33133 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33134 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33135
33136 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33137 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33138 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33139 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33140
33141 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33142 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33143 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33144 requirements.
33145
33146 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33147 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33148 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33149 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33150 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33151 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33152 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33153
33154 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33155 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33156 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33157 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33158
33159 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33160 the following consequences:
33161
33162 .ilist
33163 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33164 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33165 to it, at all times.
33166 .next
33167 Header lines that are added by a router's
33168 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33169 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33170 .next
33171 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33172 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33173 .next
33174 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33175 a later router or by a transport.
33176 .next
33177 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33178 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33179 .code
33180 headers_remove = subject
33181 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33182 .endd
33183 .endlist
33184
33185 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33186 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33187
33188
33189
33190
33191
33192 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33193 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33194 .cindex "constructed address"
33195 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33196 the form
33197 .display
33198 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33199 .endd
33200 For example:
33201 .code
33202 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33203 .endd
33204 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33205 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33206 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33207 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33208 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33209 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33210 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33211 there is no password file entry.
33212
33213 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33214 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33215 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33216 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33217 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33218 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33219 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33220 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33221 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33222
33223
33224
33225 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33226 .cindex "case of local parts"
33227 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33228 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33229 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33230 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33231 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33232 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33233 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33234 router option.
33235
33236 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33237 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33238 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33239 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33240 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33241 .code
33242 correct_case:
33243 driver = redirect
33244 domains = +local_domains
33245 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33246 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33247 @$domain
33248 .endd
33249 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33250 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33251 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33252 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33253 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33254
33255
33256
33257 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33258 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33259 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33260 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33261 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33262 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33263 empty components for compatibility.
33264
33265
33266
33267 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33268 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33269 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33270 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33271 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33272 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33273
33274 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33275 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33276 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33277 example, a header such as
33278 .code
33279 To: hare@teaparty
33280 .endd
33281 might get rewritten as
33282 .code
33283 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33284 .endd
33285 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33286 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33287 been routed.
33288
33289 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33290 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33291 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33292 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33293 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33294 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33295 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33296
33297
33298
33299 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33300 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33301
33302 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33303 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33304 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33305 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33306 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33307 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33308 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33309
33310 .ilist
33311 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33312 .next
33313 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33314 .next
33315 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33316 .endlist
33317
33318 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33319
33320 .ilist
33321 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33322 .next
33323 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33324 &"lmtp"&);
33325 .next
33326 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33327 transport);
33328 .next
33329 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33330 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33331 .endlist
33332
33333 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33334 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33335 used to contain the envelope information.
33336
33337
33338
33339 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33340 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33341 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33342 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33343 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33344 .cindex "EHLO"
33345 .cindex "HELO"
33346 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33347 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33348 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33349 processing is the same in both cases.
33350
33351 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33352 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33353 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33354 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33355 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33356 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33357 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33358 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33359 suppressed.
33360
33361 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33362 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33363 required for the transaction.
33364
33365 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33366 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33367 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33368 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33369 is called for verification.
33370
33371 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33372 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33373 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33374
33375 .cindex "carriage return"
33376 .cindex "linefeed"
33377 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33378 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33379 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33380 line terminator.
33381
33382 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33383 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33384 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33385 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33386 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33387 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33388 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33389 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33390 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33391
33392 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33393 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33394 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33395 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33396
33397 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33398 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33399 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33400 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33401
33402 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33403 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33404 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33405 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33406 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33407 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33408 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33409 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33410 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33411 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33412
33413 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33414 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33415
33416 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33417 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33418 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33419 square bracket of the IP address.
33420
33421
33422
33423
33424 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33425 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33426 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33427 .cindex "host" "error"
33428 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33429 message errors, and recipient errors.
33430
33431 .vlist
33432 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33433 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33434 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33435
33436 .ilist
33437 Connection refused or timed out,
33438 .next
33439 Any error response code on connection,
33440 .next
33441 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33442 .next
33443 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33444 .next
33445 I/O errors at any time,
33446 .next
33447 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33448 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33449 .endlist ilist
33450
33451 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33452 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33453 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33454 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33455 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33456 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33457 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33458 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33459
33460 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33461 .cindex "message" "error"
33462 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33463 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33464 message errors are:
33465
33466 .ilist
33467 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33468 the data,
33469 .next
33470 Timeout after MAIL,
33471 .next
33472 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33473 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33474 connection at any other time.
33475 .endlist ilist
33476
33477 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33478 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33479 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33480 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33481 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33482 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33483 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33484 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33485 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33486 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33487
33488 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33489 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33490 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33491 response to MAIL.
33492
33493 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33494 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33495 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33496 recipient errors are:
33497
33498 .ilist
33499 Any error response to RCPT,
33500 .next
33501 Timeout after RCPT.
33502 .endlist
33503
33504 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33505 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33506 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33507 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33508 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33509 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33510 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33511 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33512 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33513 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33514 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33515 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33516 the retry clock is reset.
33517
33518 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33519 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33520 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33521 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33522 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33523 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33524 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33525 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33526 recipient's retry time.
33527 .endlist
33528
33529 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33530 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33531 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33532 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33533 until the next delivery attempt.
33534
33535 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33536 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33537 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33538 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33539 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33540 is created.
33541
33542 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33543 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33544 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33545 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33546 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33547 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33548 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33549
33550 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33551 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33552 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33553 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33554 then to be treated as a host error.
33555
33556 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33557 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33558 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33559 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33560 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33561
33562
33563
33564
33565 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33566 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33567 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33568 .cindex "inetd"
33569 .cindex "daemon"
33570 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33571 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33572 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33573 .code
33574 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33575 .endd
33576 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33577 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33578 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33579 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33580 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33581 stream and exits with an error code.
33582
33583 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33584 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33585 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33586 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33587
33588 .cindex "carriage return"
33589 .cindex "linefeed"
33590 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33591 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33592 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33593 line terminator.
33594 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33595 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33596 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33597
33598 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33599 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33600 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33601 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33602 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33603 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33604 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33605 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33606
33607 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33608 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33609 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33610 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33611 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33612 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33613 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33614 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33615 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33616
33617 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33618 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33619 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33620
33621 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33622 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33623 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33624 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33625 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33626
33627 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33628 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33629 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33630 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33631 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33632 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33633 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33634
33635 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33636 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33637 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33638 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33639 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33640
33641 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33642 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33643 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33644 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33645 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33646 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33647 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33648 a delivery process.
33649
33650 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33651 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33652 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33653 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33654 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33655
33656 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33657 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33658 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33659 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33660
33661 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33662 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33663 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33664
33665
33666
33667 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33668 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33669 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33670 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33671 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33672 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33673 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33674 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33675
33676
33677 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33678 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33679 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33680 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33681 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33682 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33683 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33684 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33685 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33686 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33687 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33688
33689
33690
33691 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33692 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33693 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33694 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33695 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33696 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33697 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33698 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33699
33700 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33701 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33702 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33703 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33704 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33705 counted.
33706
33707 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33708 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33709 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33710
33711 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33712 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33713 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33714 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33715 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33716
33717
33718
33719
33720 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33721 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33722 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33723 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33724 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33725
33726 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33727 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33728 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33729
33730 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33731 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33732 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33733 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33734 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33735 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33736 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33737 RCPT failures.
33738
33739
33740
33741 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33742 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33743 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33744 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33745 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33746 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33747 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33748
33749 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33750 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33751 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33752 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33753 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33754 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33755 argument. For example,
33756 .code
33757 ETRN #brigadoon
33758 .endd
33759 runs the command
33760 .code
33761 exim -R brigadoon
33762 .endd
33763 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33764 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33765 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33766 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33767 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33768
33769 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33770 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33771 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33772 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33773 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33774 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33775 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33776 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33777
33778 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33779 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33780 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33781 whatever the form of its argument. For
33782 example:
33783 .code
33784 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33785 $sender_host_address
33786 .endd
33787 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33788 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33789 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33790 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33791 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33792 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33793 for it to change them before running the command.
33794
33795
33796
33797 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33798 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33799 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33800 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33801 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33802 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33803 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33804 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33805 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33806 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33807 runs for RCPT commands:
33808 .code
33809 accept hosts = :
33810 .endd
33811 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33812
33813
33814
33815 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33816 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33817 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33818 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33819 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33820 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33821 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33822 envelope along with the message.
33823
33824 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33825 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33826 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33827 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33828 can be used to specify it.
33829
33830 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33831 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33832 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33833 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33834 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33835
33836 .vindex "&$host$&"
33837 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33838 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33839 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33840 router:
33841 .code
33842 begin routers
33843 route_append:
33844 driver = manualroute
33845 transport = smtp_appendfile
33846 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33847
33848 begin transports
33849 smtp_appendfile:
33850 driver = appendfile
33851 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33852 batch_max = 1000
33853 use_bsmtp
33854 user = exim
33855 .endd
33856 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33857 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33858 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33859
33860
33861
33862 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33863 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33864 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33865 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33866 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33867 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33868 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33869 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33870 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33871 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33872
33873 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33874 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33875
33876 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33877 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33878 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33879 make some use of automatically, for example:
33880 .code
33881 554 Unexpected end of file
33882 Transaction started in line 10
33883 Error detected in line 14
33884 .endd
33885 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
33886 file, for example:
33887 .code
33888 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
33889 The error message was:
33890
33891 501 '>' missing at end of address
33892
33893 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
33894 The error was detected in line 12.
33895 The SMTP command at fault was:
33896
33897 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
33898
33899 1 previous message was successfully processed.
33900 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
33901 .endd
33902 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
33903 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
33904 accepted.
33905 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
33906 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
33907
33908
33909
33910 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33912
33913 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
33914 "Customizing messages"
33915 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
33916 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
33917 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
33918 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
33919 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
33920
33921 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
33922 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
33923 option. Exim also adds the line
33924 .code
33925 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
33926 .endd
33927 to all warning and bounce messages,
33928
33929
33930 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
33931 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
33932 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
33933 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
33934 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
33935 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
33936 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
33937
33938 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
33939 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
33940 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
33941 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
33942 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
33943 item.
33944
33945 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
33946 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
33947 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
33948 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
33949 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
33950 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
33951 option, rounded to a whole number.
33952
33953 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
33954
33955 .ilist
33956 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33957 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33958 .next
33959 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
33960 failing addresses with their error messages.
33961 .next
33962 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
33963 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
33964 .next
33965 .new
33966 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
33967 The fields exist for back-compatibility
33968 .wen
33969 .endlist
33970
33971 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
33972 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
33973 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
33974 .code
33975 Subject: Mail delivery failed
33976 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33977 {: returning message to sender}}
33978 ****
33979 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33980
33981 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33982 {that you sent }{sent by
33983
33984 <$sender_address>
33985
33986 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
33987 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
33988 ****
33989 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
33990 ****
33991 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
33992 ------
33993 ****
33994 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
33995 only the first
33996 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
33997 ****
33998 .endd
33999 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34000 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34001 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34002 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34003 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34004 text sections:
34005
34006 .ilist
34007 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34008 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34009 .next
34010 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34011 the delayed addresses.
34012 .next
34013 The third item then ends the message.
34014 .endlist
34015
34016 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34017 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34018 .code
34019 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34020 $warn_message_delay
34021 ****
34022 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34023
34024 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34025 {that you sent }{sent by
34026
34027 <$sender_address>
34028
34029 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34030 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34031
34032 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34033 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34034 The date of the message is: $h_date
34035
34036 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34037 ****
34038 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34039 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34040 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34041 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34042 the message will be returned to you.
34043 .endd
34044 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34045 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34046 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34047 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34048 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34049 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34050 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34051 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34052 handled them.
34053
34054
34055
34056
34057 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34058 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34059
34060 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34061 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34062 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34063
34064
34065
34066 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34067 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34068 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34069 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34070 routing explicitly:
34071 .code
34072 send_to_smart_host:
34073 driver = manualroute
34074 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34075 transport = remote_smtp
34076 .endd
34077 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34078 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34079 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34080 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34081 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34082
34083
34084
34085
34086 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34087 .cindex "mailing lists"
34088 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34089 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34090 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34091
34092 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34093 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34094 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34095 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34096 .code
34097 lists:
34098 driver = redirect
34099 domains = lists.example
34100 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34101 forbid_pipe
34102 forbid_file
34103 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34104 no_more
34105 .endd
34106 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34107 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34108 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34109 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34110
34111 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34112 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34113 a mailing list.
34114
34115 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34116 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34117 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34118 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34119 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34120
34121 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34122 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34123 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34124 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34125 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34126 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34127 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34128 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34129 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34130
34131
34132
34133 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34134 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34135 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34136 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34137 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34138 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34139 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34140
34141 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34142 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34143 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34144 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34145 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34146
34147
34148
34149 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34150 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34151 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34152 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34153 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34154 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34155 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34156 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34157 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34158 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34159
34160 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34161 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34162 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34163 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34164 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34165 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34166 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34167 pre-existing messages.
34168
34169 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34170 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34171 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34172 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34173 one level of expansion anyway.
34174
34175
34176
34177 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34178 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34179 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34180 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34181 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34182 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34183
34184 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34185 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34186 .code
34187 lists_request:
34188 driver = redirect
34189 domains = lists.example
34190 local_part_suffix = -request
34191 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34192 no_more
34193
34194 lists_post:
34195 driver = redirect
34196 domains = lists.example
34197 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34198 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34199 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34200 forbid_pipe
34201 forbid_file
34202 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34203 no_more
34204
34205 lists_closed:
34206 driver = redirect
34207 domains = lists.example
34208 allow_fail
34209 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34210 .endd
34211 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34212 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34213 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34214 mailing list.
34215
34216 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34217 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34218 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34219 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34220 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34221 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34222 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34223 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34224 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34225
34226 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34227 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34228 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34229
34230
34231
34232
34233 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34234 .cindex "VERP"
34235 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34236 .cindex "envelope sender"
34237 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34238 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34239 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34240 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34241 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34242 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34243
34244 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34245 .oindex &%return_path%&
34246 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34247 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34248 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34249 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34250 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34251 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34252 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34253 .code
34254 verp_smtp:
34255 driver = smtp
34256 max_rcpt = 1
34257 return_path = \
34258 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34259 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34260 .endd
34261 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34262 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34263 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34264 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34265 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34266 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34267 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34268 rewritten as
34269 .code
34270 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34271 .endd
34272 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34273 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34274 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34275 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34276 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34277 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34278
34279 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34280 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34281 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34282 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34283 .code
34284 dnslookup:
34285 driver = dnslookup
34286 domains = ! +local_domains
34287 transport = \
34288 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34289 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34290 no_more
34291 .endd
34292 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34293 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34294 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34295 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34296 address.
34297
34298 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34299 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34300 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34301 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34302 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34303 .code
34304 verp_dnslookup:
34305 driver = dnslookup
34306 domains = ! +local_domains
34307 transport = remote_smtp
34308 errors_to = \
34309 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34310 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34311 no_more
34312 .endd
34313 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34314 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34315 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34316 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34317 them.
34318
34319 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34320 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34321 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34322 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34323 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34324 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34325 used).
34326
34327
34328
34329
34330
34331
34332 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34333 .cindex "virtual domains"
34334 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34335 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34336 meanings:
34337
34338 .ilist
34339 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34340 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34341 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34342 .next
34343 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34344 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34345 have login accounts on that host.
34346 .endlist
34347
34348 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34349 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34350 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34351 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34352 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34353 to a router of this form:
34354 .code
34355 virtual:
34356 driver = redirect
34357 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34358 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34359 no_more
34360 .endd
34361 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34362 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34363 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34364 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34365 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34366 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34367
34368 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34369 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34370 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34371 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34372
34373 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34374 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34375 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34376 .code
34377 my_domains:
34378 driver = accept
34379 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34380 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34381 transport = my_mailboxes
34382 .endd
34383 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34384 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34385 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34386 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34387 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34388 follows:
34389 .code
34390 my_mailboxes:
34391 driver = appendfile
34392 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34393 user = mail
34394 .endd
34395 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34396 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34397
34398 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34399 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34400 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34401 information about the domains.
34402
34403
34404
34405 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34406 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34407 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34408 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34409 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34410 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34411 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34412 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34413 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34414 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34415 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34416 example, consider this router:
34417 .code
34418 userforward:
34419 driver = redirect
34420 check_local_user
34421 file = $home/.forward
34422 local_part_suffix = -*
34423 local_part_suffix_optional
34424 allow_filter
34425 .endd
34426 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34427 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34428 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34429 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34430 .code
34431 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34432 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34433 endif
34434 .endd
34435 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34436 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34437 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34438 control over which suffixes are valid.
34439
34440 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34441 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34442 another MTA:
34443 .code
34444 userforward:
34445 driver = redirect
34446 check_local_user
34447 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34448 local_part_suffix = -*
34449 local_part_suffix_optional
34450 allow_filter
34451 .endd
34452 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34453 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34454 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34455 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34456 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34457
34458
34459
34460 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34461 .cindex "vacation processing"
34462 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34463 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34464 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34465 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34466 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34467
34468 .ilist
34469 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34470 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34471 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34472 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34473 .code
34474 spqr, vacation-spqr
34475 .endd
34476 .next
34477 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34478 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34479 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34480 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34481 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34482 message.
34483 .endlist
34484
34485 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34486 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34487
34488
34489
34490 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34491 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34492 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34493 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34494 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34495 each day's messages.
34496
34497 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34498 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34499 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34500 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34501
34502
34503
34504 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34505 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34506 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34507 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34508 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34509 permanently connected.
34510
34511 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34512 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34513 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34514
34515
34516 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34517 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34518 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34519 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34520 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34521 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34522 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34523 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34524
34525 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34526 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34527 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34528 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34529 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34530 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34531 if required.
34532
34533 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34534 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34535 intermittent host. For example:
34536 .code
34537 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34538 .endd
34539 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34540 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34541 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34542 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34543 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34544 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34545 immediately.
34546
34547 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34548 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34549 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34550 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34551 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34552 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34553 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34554
34555
34556
34557 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34558 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34559 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34560 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34561 delivered immediately.
34562
34563 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34564 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34565 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34566 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34567 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34568 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34569 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34570 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34571 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34572 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34573 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34574 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34575 single SMTP connection.
34576
34577
34578
34579 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34580 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34581
34582 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34583 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34584 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34585 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34586 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34587 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34588 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34589 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34590 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34591 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34592 messages this way.
34593
34594 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34595 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34596 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34597 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34598 email is not desirable.
34599
34600 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34601 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34602 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34603 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34604 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34605 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34606 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34607
34608 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34609 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34610 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34611 before sending a message to the smart host.
34612
34613 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34614 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34615 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34616
34617 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34618 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34619 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34620 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34621 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34622 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34623 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34624
34625 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34626 following ways:
34627
34628 .ilist
34629 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34630 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34631 .next
34632 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34633 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34634 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34635 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34636 successful, a zero return code is given.
34637 .next
34638 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34639 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34640 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34641 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34642 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34643 are.
34644 .next
34645 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34646 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34647 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34648 .next
34649 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34650 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34651 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34652 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34653 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34654 .next
34655 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34656 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34657 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34658 .next
34659 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34660 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34661 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34662 are ever generated.
34663 .next
34664 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34665 .next
34666 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34667 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34668 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34669 .endlist
34670
34671 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34672 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34673 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34674 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34675 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34676 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34677
34678
34679
34680
34681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34683
34684 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34685 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34686 .cindex "log" "types of"
34687 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34688 and the panic log:
34689
34690 .ilist
34691 .cindex "main log"
34692 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34693 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34694 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34695 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34696 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34697 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34698 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34699 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34700 .next
34701 .cindex "reject log"
34702 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34703 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34704 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34705 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34706 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34707 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34708 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34709 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34710 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34711 false.
34712 .next
34713 .cindex "panic log"
34714 .cindex "system log"
34715 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34716 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34717 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34718 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34719 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34720 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34721 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34722 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34723 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34724 .endlist
34725
34726 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34727 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34728 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34729 .code
34730 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34731 by QUIT
34732 .endd
34733 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34734 ways of changing this:
34735
34736 .ilist
34737 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34738 you set
34739 .code
34740 timezone = UTC
34741 .endd
34742 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34743 .next
34744 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34745 example:
34746 .code
34747 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34748 .endd
34749 .endlist
34750
34751 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34752 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34753 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34754 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34755 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34756 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34757
34758
34759
34760
34761 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34762 .cindex "log" "destination"
34763 .cindex "log" "to file"
34764 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34765 .cindex "syslog"
34766 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34767 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34768 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34769 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34770 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34771 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34772 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34773
34774 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34775 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34776 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34777 references to the host name:
34778 .code
34779 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34780 .endd
34781 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34782 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34783 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34784 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34785 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34786 log at all.
34787
34788 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34789 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34790 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34791 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34792 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34793 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34794 implying the use of a default path.
34795
34796 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34797 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34798 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34799 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34800 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34801 equivalent to the setting:
34802 .code
34803 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34804 .endd
34805 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34806 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34807 that is where the logs are written.
34808
34809 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34810 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34811
34812 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34813 .display
34814 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34815 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34816 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34817 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34818 .endd
34819 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34820 error is logged.
34821
34822
34823
34824 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34825 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34826 .cindex "cycling logs"
34827 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34828 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34829 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34830 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34831 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34832 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34833 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34834
34835 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34836 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34837 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34838 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34839 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34840 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34841 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34842 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34843 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34844 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34845 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34846 renamed.
34847
34848
34849
34850 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34851 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34852 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34853 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34854 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34855 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34856 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34857 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34858 .code
34859 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34860 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34861 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34862 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34863 .endd
34864 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34865 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34866 .code
34867 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34868 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34869 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34870 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34871 .endd
34872 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34873 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34874 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34875 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34876
34877 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34878 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34879 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34880 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34881 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34882 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34883 log names:
34884 .code
34885 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34886 /var/log/exim-panic.log
34887 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34888 /var/log/exim/panic
34889 .endd
34890
34891
34892 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
34893 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
34894 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
34895 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
34896 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
34897 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
34898 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
34899 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
34900 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
34901 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
34902 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
34903 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
34904 the time and host name to each line.
34905 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
34906
34907 .ilist
34908 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
34909 .next
34910 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
34911 .next
34912 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
34913 .endlist
34914
34915 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
34916 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
34917 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
34918 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
34919
34920 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
34921 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
34922 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
34923 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
34924 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
34925 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
34926 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
34927 RFC 3164, you should set
34928 .code
34929 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
34930 .endd
34931 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
34932 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
34933
34934 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
34935 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
34936 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
34937 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
34938 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
34939 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
34940 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
34941 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
34942 name, and pid as added by syslog:
34943 .code
34944 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
34945 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
34946 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
34947 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
34948 [5/5] mple>)
34949 .endd
34950 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
34951 (LOG_NOTICE):
34952 .code
34953 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
34954 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
34955 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
34956 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
34957 [5\18] .example>)
34958 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
34959 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
34960 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
34961 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
34962 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
34963 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
34964 [12\18] F From: <>
34965 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
34966 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
34967 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
34968 [16\18] le>
34969 [17\18] B Bcc:
34970 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
34971 .endd
34972 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
34973 without modification.
34974
34975 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
34976 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
34977 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
34978 where it is.
34979
34980
34981
34982 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
34983 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
34984 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
34985 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
34986 timestamp. The flags are:
34987 .display
34988 &`<=`& message arrival
34989 &`=>`& normal message delivery
34990 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
34991 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
34992 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
34993 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
34994 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
34995 .endd
34996
34997
34998 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
34999 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35000 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35001 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35002 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35003 .code
35004 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35005 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35006 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35007 .endd
35008 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35009 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35010 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35011 .code
35012 R=<message id>
35013 .endd
35014 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35015
35016 .cindex "HELO"
35017 .cindex "EHLO"
35018 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35019 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35020 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35021 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35022 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35023 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35024 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35025 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35026 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35027 name in parentheses.
35028
35029 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35030 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35031 the log containing text like these examples:
35032 .code
35033 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35034 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35035 .endd
35036 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35037 on.
35038
35039 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35040 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35041 of Exim.
35042
35043 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35044 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35045 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35046 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35047 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35048 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35049 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35050 suite that was used.
35051
35052 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35053 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35054 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35055 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35056 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35057 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35058 authenticator name.
35059
35060 .cindex "size" "of message"
35061 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35062 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35063 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35064 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35065 other).
35066
35067 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35068 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35069
35070
35071
35072 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35073 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35074 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35075 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35076 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35077 to fit it on the page:
35078 .code
35079 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35080 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35081 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35082 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35083 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35084 .endd
35085 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35086 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35087 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35088 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35089 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35090
35091 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35092 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35093 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35094 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35095
35096 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35097 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35098 .display
35099 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35100 .endd
35101 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35102 parentheses afterwards.
35103
35104 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35105 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35106 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35107 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35108 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35109 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35110
35111 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35112 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35113 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35114 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35115 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35116
35117 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35118 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35119
35120 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35121 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35122
35123
35124 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35125 .cindex "discarded messages"
35126 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35127 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35128 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35129 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35130 .code
35131 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35132 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35133 .endd
35134 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35135 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35136 .code
35137 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35138 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35139 .endd
35140
35141
35142 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35143 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35144 .code
35145 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35146 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35147 .endd
35148 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35149 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35150 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35151 .code
35152 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35153 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35154 .endd
35155 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35156 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35157 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35158
35159
35160
35161 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35162 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35163 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35164 following form is logged:
35165 .code
35166 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35167 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35168 .endd
35169 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35170 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35171 .code
35172 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35173 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35174 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35175 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35176 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35177 .endd
35178 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35179 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35180 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35181 flagged with &`**`&.
35182
35183
35184
35185 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35186 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35187 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35188 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35189 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35190
35191
35192
35193 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35194 A line of the form
35195 .code
35196 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35197 .endd
35198 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35199 at the end of its processing.
35200
35201
35202
35203
35204 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35205 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35206 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35207 the following table:
35208 .display
35209 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35210 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35211 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35212 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35213 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35214 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35215 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35216 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35217 &`H `& host name and IP address
35218 &`I `& local interface used
35219 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35220 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35221 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35222 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35223 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35224 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35225 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35226 &`S `& size of message
35227 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35228 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35229 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35230 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35231 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35232 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35233 .endd
35234
35235
35236 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35237 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35238 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35239
35240 .ilist
35241 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35242 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35243 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35244 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35245 during the first delivery attempt.
35246 .next
35247 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35248 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35249 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35250 .next
35251 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35252 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35253 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35254 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35255 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35256 doing.
35257 .next
35258 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35259 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35260 message:
35261 .olist
35262 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35263 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35264 .next
35265 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35266 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35267 .next
35268 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35269 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35270 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35271 .code
35272 errors_to = <>
35273 .endd
35274 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35275 .endlist olist
35276 .endlist ilist
35277
35278
35279
35280
35281
35282 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35283 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35284 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35285 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35286 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35287 example:
35288 .code
35289 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35290 .endd
35291 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35292 selection marked by asterisks:
35293 .display
35294 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35295 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35296 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35297 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35298 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35299 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35300 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35301 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35302 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35303 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35304 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35305 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35306 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35307 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35308 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35309 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35310 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35311 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35312 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35313 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35314 &` pid `& Exim process id
35315 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35316 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35317 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35318 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35319 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35320 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35321 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35322 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35323 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35324 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35325 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
35326 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35327 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35328 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35329 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35330 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35331 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35332 .new
35333 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35334 .wen
35335 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35336 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35337 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35338 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35339
35340 &` all `& all of the above
35341 .endd
35342 More details on each of these items follows:
35343
35344 .ilist
35345 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35346 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35347 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35348 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35349 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35350 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35351 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35352 .next
35353 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35354 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35355 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35356 this log selector is set.
35357 .next
35358 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35359 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35360 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35361 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35362 such users cannot access the log).
35363 .next
35364 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35365 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35366 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35367 parentheses between them.
35368 .next
35369 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35370 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35371 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35372 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35373 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35374 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35375 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35376 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35377 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35378 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35379 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35380 between the caller and Exim.
35381 .next
35382 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35383 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35384 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35385 .next
35386 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35387 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35388 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35389 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35390 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35391 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35392 .next
35393 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35394 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35395 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35396 .next
35397 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35398 .cindex "size" "of message"
35399 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35400 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35401 .next
35402 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35403 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35404 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35405 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35406 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35407 .next
35408 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35409 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35410 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35411 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35412 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35413 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35414 .next
35415 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35416 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35417 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35418 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35419 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35420 .next
35421 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35422 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35423 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35424 client's ident port times out.
35425 .next
35426 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35427 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35428 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35429 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35430 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35431 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35432 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35433 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35434 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"& and to
35435 rejection lines
35436 and (despite the name) the local interface is added to &"=>"& lines..
35437 .next
35438 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35439 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35440 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35441 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35442 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35443 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35444 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35445 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35446 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35447 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35448 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35449 .next
35450 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35451 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35452 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35453 .next
35454 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35455 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35456 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35457 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35458 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
35459 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
35460 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
35461 .next
35462 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35463 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35464 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35465 immediately after the time and date.
35466 .next
35467 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35468 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35469 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35470 .next
35471 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35472 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35473 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35474 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35475 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35476 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35477 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35478 message has been successfully received.
35479 .next
35480 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35481 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35482 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35483 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35484 .next
35485 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35486 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35487 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35488 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35489 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35490 has taken place.
35491 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35492 in the list.
35493 .next
35494 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35495 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35496 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35497 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35498 .next
35499 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35500 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35501 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35502 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35503 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35504 .next
35505 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35506 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35507 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35508 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35509 attempt.
35510 .next
35511 .cindex "log" "return path"
35512 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35513 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35514 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35515 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35516 .next
35517 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35518 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35519 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35520 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35521 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35522 .next
35523 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35524 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35525 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35526 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35527 detail is lost.
35528 .next
35529 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35530 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35531 it is too big.
35532 .next
35533 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35534 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35535 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35536 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35537 it.
35538 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35539 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35540 .next
35541 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35542 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35543 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35544 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35545 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35546 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35547 response.
35548 .next
35549 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35550 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35551 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
35552 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35553 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35554 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35555 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35556 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35557 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35558 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35559
35560 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35561 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35562 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35563 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35564 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35565 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35566 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35567 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35568 .next
35569 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35570 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35571 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35572 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35573 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35574 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35575 .next
35576 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35577 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35578 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35579 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35580 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35581 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35582 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35583 already have their own log lines.
35584
35585 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35586 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35587 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35588 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35589 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35590 the same logging options.
35591
35592 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35593 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35594 .code
35595 C=EHLO,QUIT
35596 .endd
35597 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35598 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35599 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35600 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35601 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35602 .next
35603 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35604 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35605 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35606 was accepted or used.
35607 .next
35608 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35609 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35610 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35611 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35612 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35613 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35614 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35615 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35616 .next
35617 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35618 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35619 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35620 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35621 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35622 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35623 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35624 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35625 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35626 .next
35627 .cindex "log" "subject"
35628 .cindex "subject, logging"
35629 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35630 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35631 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35632 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35633 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35634 .next
35635 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35636 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35637 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35638 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35639 .next
35640 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35641 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35642 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35643 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35644 .next
35645 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35646 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35647 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35648 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35649 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35650 .next
35651 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35652 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35653 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35654 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35655 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35656 .next
35657 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35658 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35659 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35660 .endlist
35661
35662
35663 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35664 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35665 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35666 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35667 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35668 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35669 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35670 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35671 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35672 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35673 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35674 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35675 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35676
35677 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35678 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35679 &%message_logs%& option false.
35680 .ecindex IIDloggen
35681
35682
35683
35684
35685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35687
35688 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35689 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35690 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35691 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35692 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35693
35694 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35695 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35696 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35697 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35698 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35699 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35700 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35701 various criteria"
35702 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35703 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35704 "extract statistics from the log"
35705 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35706 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35707 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35708 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35709 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35710 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35711 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35712 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35713 .endtable
35714
35715 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35716 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35717 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35718
35719
35720
35721
35722 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35723 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35724 .cindex "process, querying"
35725 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35726 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35727 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35728 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35729 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35730 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35731 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35732 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35733 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35734
35735 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35736 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35737 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35738
35739
35740 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35741 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35742 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35743 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35744 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35745 options:
35746 .display
35747 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35748 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35749 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35750 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35751 .endd
35752 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35753 .code
35754 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35755 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35756 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35757 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35758 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35759 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35760 .endd
35761 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35762 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35763
35764
35765
35766 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35767 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35768 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35769 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35770 .code
35771 exim -bpu
35772 .endd
35773 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35774 .code
35775 exim -bp
35776 .endd
35777 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35778 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35779
35780 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35781 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35782
35783 .vlist
35784 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35785 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35786 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35787 .code
35788 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35789 .endd
35790 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35791 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
35792 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35793
35794 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35795 Match against the size field.
35796
35797 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35798 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35799
35800 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35801 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35802
35803 .vitem &*-z*&
35804 Match only frozen messages.
35805
35806 .vitem &*-x*&
35807 Match only non-frozen messages.
35808 .endlist
35809
35810 The following options control the format of the output:
35811
35812 .vlist
35813 .vitem &*-c*&
35814 Display only the count of matching messages.
35815
35816 .vitem &*-l*&
35817 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35818 the default.
35819
35820 .vitem &*-i*&
35821 Display message ids only.
35822
35823 .vitem &*-b*&
35824 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35825
35826 .vitem &*-R*&
35827 Display messages in reverse order.
35828
35829 .vitem &*-a*&
35830 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35831 .endlist
35832
35833 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35834
35835
35836
35837 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35838 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35839 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35840 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35841 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35842 running a command such as
35843 .code
35844 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35845 .endd
35846 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35847 it, as in the following example:
35848 .code
35849 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35850 .endd
35851 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35852 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35853 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35854 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35855
35856 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35857 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35858 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35859 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35860 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
35861 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
35862 sender.
35863
35864 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
35865 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
35866 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
35867 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
35868 level"& addresses).
35869
35870
35871
35872
35873 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
35874 "SECTextspeinf"
35875 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
35876 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
35877 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
35878 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
35879 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
35880 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
35881 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
35882 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
35883 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
35884 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
35885 .display
35886 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
35887 .endd
35888 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
35889
35890 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
35891 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
35892 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
35893
35894 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
35895 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
35896 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
35897 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
35898 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
35899
35900 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
35901 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
35902 regular expression.
35903
35904 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
35905 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
35906
35907 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
35908 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
35909 normally.
35910
35911 Example of &%-M%&:
35912 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
35913 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
35914 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
35915 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
35916 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
35917 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
35918 search term.
35919
35920 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
35921 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
35922 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
35923 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
35924 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
35925
35926
35927 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
35928 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
35929 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
35930 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
35931 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
35932 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
35933 the &%--help%& option.
35934
35935
35936 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
35937 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35938 .cindex "cycling logs"
35939 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35940 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
35941 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
35942 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
35943 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
35944 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
35945 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
35946 .ilist
35947 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
35948 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
35949 .next
35950 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
35951 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
35952 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
35953 configuration.
35954 .endlist
35955
35956 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
35957 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
35958 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
35959 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
35960 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
35961 logs are handled similarly.
35962
35963 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
35964 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
35965 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
35966 any existing log files.
35967
35968 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
35969 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
35970 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
35971 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
35972 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
35973 .code
35974 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
35975 .endd
35976 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
35977 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
35978
35979
35980
35981 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
35982 .cindex "statistics"
35983 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
35984 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
35985 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
35986 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
35987 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
35988
35989 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
35990 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
35991 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
35992 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
35993 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
35994 .code
35995 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
35996 .endd
35997 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
35998 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
35999 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36000 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36001 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36002 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36003 also produced per user.
36004
36005 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36006 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36007 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36008 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36009 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36010
36011 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36012 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36013 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36014 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36015 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36016 an entirely separate message.
36017
36018 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36019 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36020 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36021 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36022 least one address that failed.
36023
36024 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36025 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36026 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36027 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36028 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36029 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36030 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36031
36032 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36033 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36034 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36035
36036 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36037 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36038 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36039 .code
36040 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36041 .endd
36042
36043 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36044 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36045 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36046 .cindex "checking access"
36047 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36048 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36049 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36050 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36051 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36052 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36053
36054 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36055 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36056 .code
36057 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36058 .endd
36059 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36060 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36061 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36062 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36063 .code
36064 Rejected:
36065 550 Relay not permitted
36066 .endd
36067 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36068 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36069 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36070 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36071 you can use:
36072 .code
36073 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36074 -f himself@there.example
36075 .endd
36076 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36077 mandatory arguments.
36078
36079 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36080 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36081 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36082
36083
36084
36085 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36086 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36087 .cindex "building DBM files"
36088 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36089 .cindex "lower casing"
36090 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36091 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36092 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36093 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36094 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36095 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36096
36097 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36098 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36099 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36100 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36101 files.
36102
36103 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36104 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36105 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36106 well.
36107
36108 .cindex "USE_DB"
36109 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36110 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36111 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36112 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36113 .code
36114 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36115 .endd
36116 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36117 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36118
36119 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36120 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36121 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36122 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36123 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36124 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36125
36126 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36127 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36128 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36129 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36130 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36131 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36132 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36133 return code is 2.
36134
36135
36136
36137
36138 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36139 .cindex "retry" "times"
36140 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36141 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36142 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36143 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36144 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36145 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36146 output. For example:
36147 .code
36148 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36149 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36150 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36151 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36152 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36153 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36154 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36155 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36156 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36157 past final cutoff time
36158 .endd
36159 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36160 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36161 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36162 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36163 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36164 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36165 run very often.
36166
36167 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36168 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36169 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36170 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36171 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36172 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36173
36174
36175
36176 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36177 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36178 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36179 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36180 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36181 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36182 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36183
36184 .ilist
36185 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36186 .next
36187 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36188 for remote hosts
36189 .next
36190 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36191 .next
36192 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36193 .next
36194 &'misc'&: other hints data
36195 .endlist
36196
36197 The &'misc'& database is used for
36198
36199 .ilist
36200 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36201 .next
36202 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36203 &(smtp)& transport)
36204 .endlist
36205
36206
36207
36208 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36209 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36210 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36211 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36212 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36213 .code
36214 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36215 .endd
36216 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36217 .code
36218 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36219 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36220 .endd
36221 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36222 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36223 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36224 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36225 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36226 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36227 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36228 and a textual description of the error.
36229
36230 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36231 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36232 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36233 exceeded.
36234
36235 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36236 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36237 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36238 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36239 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36240 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36241 cross-references.
36242
36243
36244
36245 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36246 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36247 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36248 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36249 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36250 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36251 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36252 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36253 updated sufficiently often.
36254
36255 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36256 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36257 the retry database:
36258 .code
36259 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36260 .endd
36261 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36262 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36263 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36264 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36265 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36266 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36267 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36268 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36269 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36270 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36271 whenever it removes information from the database.
36272
36273 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36274 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36275 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36276 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36277 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36278
36279 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36280 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36281 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36282 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36283 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36284 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36285 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36286 tidied.
36287
36288 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36289 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36290
36291
36292
36293
36294 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36295 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36296 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36297 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36298 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36299 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36300 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36301 displayed.
36302
36303 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36304 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36305 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36306 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36307 by new data, for example:
36308 .code
36309 > 4 951102:1000
36310 .endd
36311 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36312 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36313 used as optional separators.
36314
36315
36316
36317
36318 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36319 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36320 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36321 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36322 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36323 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36324 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36325 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36326 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36327 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36328 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36329 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36330 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36331
36332 .vlist
36333 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36334 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36335
36336 .vitem &%-flock%&
36337 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36338 supports it.
36339
36340 .vitem &%-interval%&
36341 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36342 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36343
36344 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36345 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36346
36347 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36348 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36349
36350 .vitem &%-q%&
36351 Suppress verification output.
36352
36353 .vitem &%-retries%&
36354 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36355 the lock (default 10).
36356
36357 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36358 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36359 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36360 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36361 subsequently sees.
36362
36363 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36364 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36365 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36366 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36367
36368 .vitem &%-v%&
36369 Generate verbose output.
36370 .endlist
36371
36372 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36373 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36374 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36375 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36376 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36377 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36378 more than 30 minutes old.
36379
36380 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36381 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36382 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36383 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36384 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36385 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36386
36387 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36388 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36389 suppresses all output except error messages.
36390
36391 A command such as
36392 .code
36393 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36394 .endd
36395 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36396 .display
36397 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36398 <&'some commands'&>
36399 &`End`&
36400 .endd
36401 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36402 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36403 such as
36404 .code
36405 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36406 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36407 .endd
36408 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36409 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36410 .ecindex IIDutils
36411
36412
36413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36414 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36415
36416 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36417 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36418 .cindex "X-windows"
36419 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36420 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36421 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36422 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36423 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36424 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36425 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36426 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36427
36428
36429
36430 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36431 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36432 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36433 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36434 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36435 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36436 parameters are for.
36437
36438 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36439 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36440 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36441 .code
36442 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36443 .endd
36444 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36445 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36446 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36447 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36448 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36449
36450 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36451 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36452 .code
36453 Eximon*background: gray94
36454 .endd
36455 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36456 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36457 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36458 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36459 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36460 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36461 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36462 .code
36463 xrdb -merge <<End
36464 Eximon*highlight: gray
36465 End
36466 .endd
36467 .cindex "admin user"
36468 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36469 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36470
36471 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36472 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36473 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36474 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36475 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36476
36477 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36478 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36479 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36480 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36481 different parts of the display.
36482
36483
36484
36485
36486 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36487 .cindex "stripchart"
36488 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36489 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36490 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36491 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36492 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36493 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36494 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36495 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36496 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36497
36498 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36499 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36500 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36501 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36502
36503 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36504 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36505 to a single partition.
36506
36507 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36508 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36509 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36510 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36511 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36512 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36513 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36514
36515
36516
36517
36518 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36519 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36520 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36521 .cindex "window size"
36522 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36523 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36524 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36525 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36526 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36527 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36528
36529 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36530 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36531 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36532 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36533
36534 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36535 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36536 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36537 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36538 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36539 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36540
36541 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36542 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36543 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36544
36545
36546
36547 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36548 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36549 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36550 the main log is maintained.
36551 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36552 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36553 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36554 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36555 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36556
36557 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36558 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36559 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36560 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36561 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36562 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36563 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36564 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36565 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36566 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36567 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36568
36569 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36570 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36571 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36572 It cannot go further back up the log.
36573
36574 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36575 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36576 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36577 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36578 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36579 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36580
36581 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36582 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36583 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36584 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36585 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36586 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36587
36588 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36589 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36590 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36591 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36592 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36593 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36594 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36595 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36596 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36597 window.
36598
36599
36600
36601 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36602 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36603 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36604 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36605 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36606 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36607 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36608 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36609 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36610 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36611
36612 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36613 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36614 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36615 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36616 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36617 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36618 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36619
36620 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36621 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36622 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36623 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36624 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36625 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36626 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36627
36628 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36629 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36630 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36631 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36632
36633 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36634 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36635 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36636 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36637 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36638 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36639 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36640 not shown.
36641
36642 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36643 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36644
36645 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36646 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36647 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36648 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36649 display is updated.
36650
36651
36652
36653 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36654 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36655 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36656 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36657 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36658 any selected text.
36659
36660 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36661 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36662 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36663 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36664 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36665 .code
36666 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36667 .endd
36668 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36669 follows:
36670
36671 .ilist
36672 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36673 in a new text window.
36674 .next
36675 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36676 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36677 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36678 .next
36679 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36680 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36681 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36682 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36683 .next
36684 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36685 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36686 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36687 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36688 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36689 .next
36690 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36691 that the message be frozen.
36692 .next
36693 .cindex "thawing messages"
36694 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36695 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36696 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36697 that the message be thawed.
36698 .next
36699 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36700 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36701 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36702 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36703 .next
36704 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36705 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36706 message.
36707 .next
36708 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36709 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36710 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36711 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36712 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36713 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36714 which case no action is taken.
36715 .next
36716 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36717 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36718 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36719 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36720 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36721 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36722 case no action is taken.
36723 .next
36724 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36725 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36726 .next
36727 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36728 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36729 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36730 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36731 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36732 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36733 the address is qualified with that domain.
36734 .endlist
36735
36736 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36737 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36738 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36739 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36740 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36741 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36742 if no output is generated.
36743
36744 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36745 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36746 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36747 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36748
36749 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36750 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36751 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36752 .ecindex IIDeximon
36753
36754
36755
36756
36757
36758 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36759 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36760
36761 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36762 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36763 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36764 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36765
36766 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36767 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36768 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36769 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36770 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36771 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36772
36773 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36774 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36775 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36776 as soon as possible.
36777
36778
36779 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36780 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36781 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36782 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36783 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36784 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36785
36786 .ilist
36787 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36788 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36789 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36790 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36791 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36792 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36793
36794 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36795 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36796 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36797 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36798 .next
36799
36800 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36801 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36802 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36803 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36804 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36805 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36806 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36807 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36808 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36809 separate commands.
36810
36811 .next
36812 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36813 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36814 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36815 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36816 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36817 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36818 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36819 .next
36820 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36821 is disabled.
36822 .next
36823 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36824 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36825 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36826 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36827 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36828 .endlist
36829
36830
36831
36832 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36833 .cindex "setuid"
36834 .cindex "root privilege"
36835 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36836 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36837 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36838 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36839 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36840 is required for two things:
36841
36842 .ilist
36843 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36844 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36845 not required.
36846 .next
36847 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36848 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36849 configuration.
36850 .endlist
36851
36852 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36853 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36854 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36855 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36856 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36857 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36858 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
36859 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
36860
36861 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
36862 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
36863 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
36864
36865 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
36866 uid and gid in the following cases:
36867
36868 .ilist
36869 .oindex "&%-C%&"
36870 .oindex "&%-D%&"
36871 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
36872 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
36873 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
36874 the calling process.
36875 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
36876 option may not be used at all.
36877 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
36878 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
36879 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
36880 .next
36881 .oindex "&%-be%&"
36882 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
36883 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
36884 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
36885 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
36886 calling process.
36887 .next
36888 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
36889 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
36890 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
36891 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
36892 testing address verification
36893 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
36894 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
36895 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
36896 option).
36897 .next
36898 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
36899 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
36900 .endlist
36901
36902 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
36903
36904 .ilist
36905 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
36906 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
36907 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
36908 will be used during message reception.
36909 .next
36910 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
36911 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
36912 .next
36913 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
36914 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
36915 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
36916 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
36917 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
36918 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
36919 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
36920 generating bounce and warning messages.
36921
36922 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
36923 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
36924 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
36925 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
36926 .next
36927 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
36928 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
36929 .endlist
36930
36931
36932
36933
36934 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
36935 .cindex "privilege, running without"
36936 .cindex "unprivileged running"
36937 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
36938 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
36939 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
36940 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
36941 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
36942 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
36943 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
36944 to any other uid.
36945
36946 .cindex SIGHUP
36947 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
36948 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
36949 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
36950 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
36951
36952 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
36953 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
36954 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
36955 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
36956 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
36957
36958 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
36959 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
36960 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
36961 effect.
36962
36963 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
36964 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
36965 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
36966
36967 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
36968 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
36969 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
36970 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
36971 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
36972 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
36973 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
36974 address this problem at this time.
36975
36976 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
36977 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
36978 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
36979 be used in the most straightforward way.
36980
36981 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
36982 number of restrictions on what you can do:
36983
36984 .ilist
36985 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
36986 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
36987 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
36988 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
36989 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
36990 .next
36991 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
36992 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
36993 .next
36994 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
36995 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
36996 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
36997 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
36998 .next
36999 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37000 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37001
37002 .olist
37003 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37004 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37005 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37006 .next
37007 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37008 owned by the Exim user.
37009 .next
37010 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37011 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37012 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37013 .endlist olist
37014 .endlist ilist
37015
37016
37017 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37018 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37019 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37020 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37021
37022 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37023 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37024
37025
37026
37027
37028 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37029 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37030 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37031
37032
37033
37034 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37035 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37036 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37037 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37038 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37039 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37040 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37041
37042 .ilist
37043 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37044 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37045 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37046 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37047 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37048 .next
37049 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37050 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37051 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37052 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37053 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37054 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37055 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37056 .next
37057 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37058 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37059 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37060 .next
37061 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37062 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37063 .next
37064 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
37065 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37066 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37067 .next
37068 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37069 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37070 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37071 of opaque strings.
37072 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37073 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37074 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37075 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37076 .endlist
37077
37078
37079
37080
37081 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37082 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37083 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37084 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37085 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37086 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37087 are some issues to be aware of:
37088
37089 .ilist
37090 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37091 .next
37092 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37093 .next
37094 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37095 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37096 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37097 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37098 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37099 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37100 data.
37101 .next
37102 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37103 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37104 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37105 .next
37106 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37107 expected to yield one result.
37108 .endlist
37109
37110
37111
37112
37113 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37114 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37115 .cindex "IP source routing"
37116 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37117 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37118 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37119 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37120
37121
37122
37123 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37124 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37125 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37126
37127
37128
37129
37130 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37131 .cindex "trusted users"
37132 .cindex "admin user"
37133 .cindex "privileged user"
37134 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37135 .cindex "user" "admin"
37136 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37137 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37138 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37139 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37140 permit a remote host to be specified.
37141
37142 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37143 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37144 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37145 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37146 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37147 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37148 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37149
37150 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37151 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37152 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37153 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37154 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37155
37156 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37157 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37158 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37159 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37160 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37161
37162 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37163 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37164 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37165 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37166 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37167 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37168 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37169 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37170
37171 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37172 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37173 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37174 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37175 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37176 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37177 files.
37178
37179
37180
37181 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37182 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37183 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37184 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37185 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37186 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37187
37188
37189
37190 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37191 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37192 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37193 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37194 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37195 this.
37196
37197
37198
37199 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37200 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37201 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37202 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37203 converted output.
37204
37205
37206
37207 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37208 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37209 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37210 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37211 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37212
37213
37214
37215 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37216 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37217 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37218 loading it.
37219
37220
37221 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37222 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37223 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37224 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37225 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37226 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37227 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37228
37229 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37230 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37231 string.
37232
37233
37234
37235 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37236 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37237 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37238 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37239
37240
37241
37242 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37243 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37244 enough to hold the result.
37245 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37246
37247
37248
37249
37250 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37251 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37252
37253 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37254 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37255 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37256 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37257 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37258 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37259 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37260 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37261 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37262 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37263 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37264 themselves are recoverable.
37265
37266 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37267 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37268 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37269
37270 .ilist
37271 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37272 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37273 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37274 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37275 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37276 .next
37277 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37278 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37279 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37280 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37281 will always be the case.
37282 .next
37283 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37284 .next
37285 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37286 signature.
37287 .endlist
37288 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37289
37290 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37291 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37292 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37293 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37294 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37295 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37296 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37297 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37298 attempt.
37299
37300 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37301 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37302 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37303 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37304 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37305 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37306 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37307 normally the Exim user.
37308
37309 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37310 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37311 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37312 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37313 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37314 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37315 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37316 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37317
37318 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37319 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37320 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37321 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37322
37323 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37324 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37325
37326 .vlist
37327 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37328 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37329 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37330 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37331 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37332 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37333 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37334 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37335 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37336 newlines.
37337
37338 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37339 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37340 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37341 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37342 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37343 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37344
37345 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37346 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37347 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37348 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37349 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37350 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37351
37352 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37353 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37354 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37355
37356 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37357 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37358 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37359 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37360 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37361
37362 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37363 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37364 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37365 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37366 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37367
37368 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37369 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37370 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37371
37372 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37373 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37374 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37375
37376 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37377 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37378 present.
37379
37380 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37381 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37382 present if the number is greater than zero.
37383
37384 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37385 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37386 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37387
37388 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37389 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37390 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37391
37392 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37393 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37394 command.
37395
37396 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37397 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37398 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37399 messages.
37400
37401 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37402 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37403 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37404 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37405
37406 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37407 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37408 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37409
37410 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37411 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37412 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37413 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37414 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37415 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37416
37417 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37418 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37419 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37420 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37421 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37422
37423 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37424 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37425 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37426 generated messages.
37427
37428 .vitem &%-local%&
37429 The message is from a local sender.
37430
37431 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37432 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37433
37434 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37435 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37436 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37437 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37438
37439 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37440 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37441 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37442
37443 .vitem &%-N%&
37444 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37445 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37446 &%-N%& is assumed.
37447
37448 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37449 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37450 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37451
37452 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37453 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37454 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37455
37456 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37457 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37458 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37459
37460 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37461 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37462 certificate was verified by the server.
37463
37464 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37465 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37466 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37467
37468 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37469 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37470 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37471 certificate.
37472 .endlist
37473
37474 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37475 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37476 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37477 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37478 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37479 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37480 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37481 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37482 addresses are complete.
37483
37484 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37485 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37486 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37487 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37488 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37489 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37490 .code
37491 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37492 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37493 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37494 .endd
37495 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37496 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37497 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37498 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37499 example:
37500 .code
37501 4
37502 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37503 darcy@austen.fict.example
37504 rdo@foundation
37505 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37506 .endd
37507 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37508 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37509 line is of the following form:
37510 .display
37511 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37512 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37513 .endd
37514 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37515 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37516 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37517 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37518 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37519 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37520 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37521 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37522
37523
37524 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37525 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37526 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37527 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37528 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37529 following:
37530
37531 .table2 50pt
37532 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37533 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37534 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37535 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37536 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37537 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37538 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37539 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37540 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37541 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37542 .endtable
37543
37544 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37545 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37546 typical set of headers:
37547 .code
37548 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37549 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37550 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37551 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37552 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37553 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37554 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37555 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37556 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37557 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37558 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37559 .endd
37560 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37561 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37562 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37563 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37564 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37565 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37566
37567 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37569
37570 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37571 "DKIM Support"
37572 .cindex "DKIM"
37573
37574 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37575 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37576 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37577 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37578
37579 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37580 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37581
37582 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37583 .olist
37584 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37585 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37586 (including transport filters)
37587 except cutthrough delivery.
37588 .next
37589 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37590 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37591 different signature contexts.
37592 .endlist
37593
37594 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37595 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37596 Exim's standard controls.
37597
37598 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37599 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37600 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37601 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37602 .code
37603 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37604 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37605 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37606 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37607 .endd
37608 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37609 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37610 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37611 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37612 senders).
37613
37614
37615 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37616 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37617
37618 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37619 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37620
37621 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37622 MANDATORY:
37623 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37624 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37625
37626 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37627 MANDATORY:
37628 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37629 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37630 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37631 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37632
37633 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37634 MANDATORY:
37635 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37636 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37637 The result can either
37638 .ilist
37639 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37640 .next
37641 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37642 the private key.
37643 .next
37644 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37645 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37646 is set.
37647 .endlist
37648
37649 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37650 OPTIONAL:
37651 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37652 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37653 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37654 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37655
37656 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37657 OPTIONAL:
37658 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37659 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37660 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37661 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37662 variables here.
37663
37664 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37665 OPTIONAL:
37666 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37667 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37668 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37669 used.
37670
37671
37672 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37673 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37674
37675 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37676 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37677 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37678 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37679 If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
37680 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37681 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37682
37683 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37684 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37685 runtime of the ACL.
37686
37687 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37688 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37689 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37690 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37691
37692 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37693 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37694 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37695 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37696 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37697 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37698 it defaults as:
37699 .code
37700 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37701 .endd
37702 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37703 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37704 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37705 .code
37706 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37707 .endd
37708 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37709 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37710 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37711 .code
37712 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37713 .endd
37714
37715 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37716 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37717
37718
37719 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37720 available (from most to least important):
37721
37722
37723 .vlist
37724 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37725 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37726 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37727 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37728 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37729 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37730 .ilist
37731 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37732 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37733 .next
37734 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37735 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37736 .next
37737 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37738 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37739 .next
37740 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37741 .endlist
37742 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37743 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37744 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37745 .ilist
37746 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37747 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37748 .next
37749 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37750 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37751 .next
37752 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37753 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37754 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37755 .next
37756 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37757 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37758 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37759 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37760 .endlist
37761 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37762 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37763 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37764 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37765 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37766 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37767 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37768 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37769 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37770 The key record selector string.
37771 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37772 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37773 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37774 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37775 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37776 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37777 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37778 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37779 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37780 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37781 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37782 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37783 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37784 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37785 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37786 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37787 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37788 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37789 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37790 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37791 integer size comparisons against this value.
37792 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37793 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37794 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37795 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37796 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37797 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37798 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37799 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37800 in the key record.
37801 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37802 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37803 in the key record.
37804 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37805 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37806 .endlist
37807
37808 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37809
37810 .vlist
37811 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37812 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37813 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37814 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37815 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37816
37817 .code
37818 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37819 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37820 sender_domains = gmail.com
37821 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37822 dkim_status = none
37823 .endd
37824
37825 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37826 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37827 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37828 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37829
37830 .code
37831 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37832 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37833 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37834 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37835 .endd
37836
37837 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37838 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37839 for more information of what they mean.
37840 .endlist
37841
37842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37844
37845 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37846 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37847 .cindex "adding drivers"
37848 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37849 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37850 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37851 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37852
37853 .olist
37854 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37855 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37856 .next
37857 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37858 .display
37859 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
37860 .endd
37861 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
37862 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
37863 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
37864 .next
37865 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
37866 .code
37867 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
37868 .endd
37869 .next
37870 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
37871 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
37872 .next
37873 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
37874 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
37875 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
37876 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
37877 simple form that most lookups have.
37878 .next
37879 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
37880 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
37881 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
37882 .next
37883 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
37884 &_src_&.
37885 .next
37886 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
37887 as for other drivers and lookups.
37888 .endlist
37889
37890 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
37891 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
37892 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
37893 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
37894 searched using a binary chop procedure.
37895
37896 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
37897 the interface that is expected.
37898
37899
37900
37901
37902 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37903 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37904
37905 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37906 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
37907 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
37908 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
37909 . processors.
37910 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37911
37912 .literal xml
37913 <?sdop
37914 format="newpage"
37915 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
37916 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
37917 ?>
37918 .literal off
37919
37920 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
37921 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
37922 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
37923
37924
37925 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37926 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////